dwarf2out.c revision 259269
1/* Output Dwarf2 format symbol table information from GCC.
2   Copyright (C) 1992, 1993, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002,
3   2003, 2004, 2005, 2006 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4   Contributed by Gary Funck (gary@intrepid.com).
5   Derived from DWARF 1 implementation of Ron Guilmette (rfg@monkeys.com).
6   Extensively modified by Jason Merrill (jason@cygnus.com).
7
8This file is part of GCC.
9
10GCC is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
11the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free
12Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) any later
13version.
14
15GCC is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
16WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
17FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the GNU General Public License
18for more details.
19
20You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
21along with GCC; see the file COPYING.  If not, write to the Free
22Software Foundation, 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA
2302110-1301, USA.  */
24
25/* TODO: Emit .debug_line header even when there are no functions, since
26	   the file numbers are used by .debug_info.  Alternately, leave
27	   out locations for types and decls.
28	 Avoid talking about ctors and op= for PODs.
29	 Factor out common prologue sequences into multiple CIEs.  */
30
31/* The first part of this file deals with the DWARF 2 frame unwind
32   information, which is also used by the GCC efficient exception handling
33   mechanism.  The second part, controlled only by an #ifdef
34   DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO, deals with the other DWARF 2 debugging
35   information.  */
36
37#include "config.h"
38#include "system.h"
39#include "coretypes.h"
40#include "tm.h"
41#include "tree.h"
42#include "version.h"
43#include "flags.h"
44#include "real.h"
45#include "rtl.h"
46#include "hard-reg-set.h"
47#include "regs.h"
48#include "insn-config.h"
49#include "reload.h"
50#include "function.h"
51#include "output.h"
52#include "expr.h"
53#include "libfuncs.h"
54#include "except.h"
55#include "dwarf2.h"
56#include "dwarf2out.h"
57#include "dwarf2asm.h"
58#include "toplev.h"
59#include "varray.h"
60#include "ggc.h"
61#include "md5.h"
62#include "tm_p.h"
63#include "diagnostic.h"
64#include "debug.h"
65#include "target.h"
66#include "langhooks.h"
67#include "hashtab.h"
68#include "cgraph.h"
69#include "input.h"
70
71#ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
72static void dwarf2out_source_line (unsigned int, const char *);
73#endif
74
75/* DWARF2 Abbreviation Glossary:
76   CFA = Canonical Frame Address
77	   a fixed address on the stack which identifies a call frame.
78	   We define it to be the value of SP just before the call insn.
79	   The CFA register and offset, which may change during the course
80	   of the function, are used to calculate its value at runtime.
81   CFI = Call Frame Instruction
82	   an instruction for the DWARF2 abstract machine
83   CIE = Common Information Entry
84	   information describing information common to one or more FDEs
85   DIE = Debugging Information Entry
86   FDE = Frame Description Entry
87	   information describing the stack call frame, in particular,
88	   how to restore registers
89
90   DW_CFA_... = DWARF2 CFA call frame instruction
91   DW_TAG_... = DWARF2 DIE tag */
92
93#ifndef DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
94# ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
95#  define DWARF2_FRAME_INFO \
96  (write_symbols == DWARF2_DEBUG || write_symbols == VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG)
97# else
98#  define DWARF2_FRAME_INFO 0
99# endif
100#endif
101
102/* Map register numbers held in the call frame info that gcc has
103   collected using DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM to those that should be output in
104   .debug_frame and .eh_frame.  */
105#ifndef DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT
106#define DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT(REGNO, FOR_EH) (REGNO)
107#endif
108
109/* Decide whether we want to emit frame unwind information for the current
110   translation unit.  */
111
112int
113dwarf2out_do_frame (void)
114{
115  /* We want to emit correct CFA location expressions or lists, so we
116     have to return true if we're going to output debug info, even if
117     we're not going to output frame or unwind info.  */
118  return (write_symbols == DWARF2_DEBUG
119	  || write_symbols == VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG
120	  || DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
121#ifdef DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
122	  || (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
123	      && (flag_unwind_tables
124		  || (flag_exceptions && ! USING_SJLJ_EXCEPTIONS)))
125#endif
126	  );
127}
128
129/* The size of the target's pointer type.  */
130#ifndef PTR_SIZE
131#define PTR_SIZE (POINTER_SIZE / BITS_PER_UNIT)
132#endif
133
134/* Array of RTXes referenced by the debugging information, which therefore
135   must be kept around forever.  */
136static GTY(()) VEC(rtx,gc) *used_rtx_array;
137
138/* A pointer to the base of a list of incomplete types which might be
139   completed at some later time.  incomplete_types_list needs to be a
140   VEC(tree,gc) because we want to tell the garbage collector about
141   it.  */
142static GTY(()) VEC(tree,gc) *incomplete_types;
143
144/* A pointer to the base of a table of references to declaration
145   scopes.  This table is a display which tracks the nesting
146   of declaration scopes at the current scope and containing
147   scopes.  This table is used to find the proper place to
148   define type declaration DIE's.  */
149static GTY(()) VEC(tree,gc) *decl_scope_table;
150
151/* Pointers to various DWARF2 sections.  */
152static GTY(()) section *debug_info_section;
153static GTY(()) section *debug_abbrev_section;
154static GTY(()) section *debug_aranges_section;
155static GTY(()) section *debug_macinfo_section;
156static GTY(()) section *debug_line_section;
157static GTY(()) section *debug_loc_section;
158static GTY(()) section *debug_pubnames_section;
159static GTY(()) section *debug_str_section;
160static GTY(()) section *debug_ranges_section;
161static GTY(()) section *debug_frame_section;
162
163/* How to start an assembler comment.  */
164#ifndef ASM_COMMENT_START
165#define ASM_COMMENT_START ";#"
166#endif
167
168typedef struct dw_cfi_struct *dw_cfi_ref;
169typedef struct dw_fde_struct *dw_fde_ref;
170typedef union  dw_cfi_oprnd_struct *dw_cfi_oprnd_ref;
171
172/* Call frames are described using a sequence of Call Frame
173   Information instructions.  The register number, offset
174   and address fields are provided as possible operands;
175   their use is selected by the opcode field.  */
176
177enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type {
178  dw_cfi_oprnd_unused,
179  dw_cfi_oprnd_reg_num,
180  dw_cfi_oprnd_offset,
181  dw_cfi_oprnd_addr,
182  dw_cfi_oprnd_loc
183};
184
185typedef union dw_cfi_oprnd_struct GTY(())
186{
187  unsigned int GTY ((tag ("dw_cfi_oprnd_reg_num"))) dw_cfi_reg_num;
188  HOST_WIDE_INT GTY ((tag ("dw_cfi_oprnd_offset"))) dw_cfi_offset;
189  const char * GTY ((tag ("dw_cfi_oprnd_addr"))) dw_cfi_addr;
190  struct dw_loc_descr_struct * GTY ((tag ("dw_cfi_oprnd_loc"))) dw_cfi_loc;
191}
192dw_cfi_oprnd;
193
194typedef struct dw_cfi_struct GTY(())
195{
196  dw_cfi_ref dw_cfi_next;
197  enum dwarf_call_frame_info dw_cfi_opc;
198  dw_cfi_oprnd GTY ((desc ("dw_cfi_oprnd1_desc (%1.dw_cfi_opc)")))
199    dw_cfi_oprnd1;
200  dw_cfi_oprnd GTY ((desc ("dw_cfi_oprnd2_desc (%1.dw_cfi_opc)")))
201    dw_cfi_oprnd2;
202}
203dw_cfi_node;
204
205/* This is how we define the location of the CFA. We use to handle it
206   as REG + OFFSET all the time,  but now it can be more complex.
207   It can now be either REG + CFA_OFFSET or *(REG + BASE_OFFSET) + CFA_OFFSET.
208   Instead of passing around REG and OFFSET, we pass a copy
209   of this structure.  */
210typedef struct cfa_loc GTY(())
211{
212  HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
213  HOST_WIDE_INT base_offset;
214  unsigned int reg;
215  int indirect;            /* 1 if CFA is accessed via a dereference.  */
216} dw_cfa_location;
217
218/* All call frame descriptions (FDE's) in the GCC generated DWARF
219   refer to a single Common Information Entry (CIE), defined at
220   the beginning of the .debug_frame section.  This use of a single
221   CIE obviates the need to keep track of multiple CIE's
222   in the DWARF generation routines below.  */
223
224typedef struct dw_fde_struct GTY(())
225{
226  tree decl;
227  const char *dw_fde_begin;
228  const char *dw_fde_current_label;
229  const char *dw_fde_end;
230  const char *dw_fde_hot_section_label;
231  const char *dw_fde_hot_section_end_label;
232  const char *dw_fde_unlikely_section_label;
233  const char *dw_fde_unlikely_section_end_label;
234  bool dw_fde_switched_sections;
235  dw_cfi_ref dw_fde_cfi;
236  unsigned funcdef_number;
237  unsigned all_throwers_are_sibcalls : 1;
238  unsigned nothrow : 1;
239  unsigned uses_eh_lsda : 1;
240}
241dw_fde_node;
242
243/* Maximum size (in bytes) of an artificially generated label.  */
244#define MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES	30
245
246/* The size of addresses as they appear in the Dwarf 2 data.
247   Some architectures use word addresses to refer to code locations,
248   but Dwarf 2 info always uses byte addresses.  On such machines,
249   Dwarf 2 addresses need to be larger than the architecture's
250   pointers.  */
251#ifndef DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
252#define DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE (POINTER_SIZE / BITS_PER_UNIT)
253#endif
254
255/* The size in bytes of a DWARF field indicating an offset or length
256   relative to a debug info section, specified to be 4 bytes in the
257   DWARF-2 specification.  The SGI/MIPS ABI defines it to be the same
258   as PTR_SIZE.  */
259
260#ifndef DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE
261#define DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE 4
262#endif
263
264/* According to the (draft) DWARF 3 specification, the initial length
265   should either be 4 or 12 bytes.  When it's 12 bytes, the first 4
266   bytes are 0xffffffff, followed by the length stored in the next 8
267   bytes.
268
269   However, the SGI/MIPS ABI uses an initial length which is equal to
270   DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE.  It is defined (elsewhere) accordingly.  */
271
272#ifndef DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE
273#define DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 ? 4 : 12)
274#endif
275
276#define DWARF_VERSION 2
277
278/* Round SIZE up to the nearest BOUNDARY.  */
279#define DWARF_ROUND(SIZE,BOUNDARY) \
280  ((((SIZE) + (BOUNDARY) - 1) / (BOUNDARY)) * (BOUNDARY))
281
282/* Offsets recorded in opcodes are a multiple of this alignment factor.  */
283#ifndef DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT
284#ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
285#define DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT (-((int) UNITS_PER_WORD))
286#else
287#define DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT ((int) UNITS_PER_WORD)
288#endif
289#endif
290
291/* CIE identifier.  */
292#if HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= 64
293#define DWARF_CIE_ID \
294  (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 ? DW_CIE_ID : DW64_CIE_ID)
295#else
296#define DWARF_CIE_ID DW_CIE_ID
297#endif
298
299/* A pointer to the base of a table that contains frame description
300   information for each routine.  */
301static GTY((length ("fde_table_allocated"))) dw_fde_ref fde_table;
302
303/* Number of elements currently allocated for fde_table.  */
304static GTY(()) unsigned fde_table_allocated;
305
306/* Number of elements in fde_table currently in use.  */
307static GTY(()) unsigned fde_table_in_use;
308
309/* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
310   fde_table.  */
311#define FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT 256
312
313/* A list of call frame insns for the CIE.  */
314static GTY(()) dw_cfi_ref cie_cfi_head;
315
316#if defined (DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO) || defined (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO)
317/* Some DWARF extensions (e.g., MIPS/SGI) implement a subprogram
318   attribute that accelerates the lookup of the FDE associated
319   with the subprogram.  This variable holds the table index of the FDE
320   associated with the current function (body) definition.  */
321static unsigned current_funcdef_fde;
322#endif
323
324struct indirect_string_node GTY(())
325{
326  const char *str;
327  unsigned int refcount;
328  unsigned int form;
329  char *label;
330};
331
332static GTY ((param_is (struct indirect_string_node))) htab_t debug_str_hash;
333
334static GTY(()) int dw2_string_counter;
335static GTY(()) unsigned long dwarf2out_cfi_label_num;
336
337#if defined (DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO) || defined (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO)
338
339/* Forward declarations for functions defined in this file.  */
340
341static char *stripattributes (const char *);
342static const char *dwarf_cfi_name (unsigned);
343static dw_cfi_ref new_cfi (void);
344static void add_cfi (dw_cfi_ref *, dw_cfi_ref);
345static void add_fde_cfi (const char *, dw_cfi_ref);
346static void lookup_cfa_1 (dw_cfi_ref, dw_cfa_location *);
347static void lookup_cfa (dw_cfa_location *);
348static void reg_save (const char *, unsigned, unsigned, HOST_WIDE_INT);
349static void initial_return_save (rtx);
350static HOST_WIDE_INT stack_adjust_offset (rtx);
351static void output_cfi (dw_cfi_ref, dw_fde_ref, int);
352static void output_call_frame_info (int);
353static void dwarf2out_stack_adjust (rtx, bool);
354static void flush_queued_reg_saves (void);
355static bool clobbers_queued_reg_save (rtx);
356static void dwarf2out_frame_debug_expr (rtx, const char *);
357
358/* Support for complex CFA locations.  */
359static void output_cfa_loc (dw_cfi_ref);
360static void get_cfa_from_loc_descr (dw_cfa_location *,
361				    struct dw_loc_descr_struct *);
362static struct dw_loc_descr_struct *build_cfa_loc
363  (dw_cfa_location *, HOST_WIDE_INT);
364static void def_cfa_1 (const char *, dw_cfa_location *);
365
366/* How to start an assembler comment.  */
367#ifndef ASM_COMMENT_START
368#define ASM_COMMENT_START ";#"
369#endif
370
371/* Data and reference forms for relocatable data.  */
372#define DW_FORM_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 8 ? DW_FORM_data8 : DW_FORM_data4)
373#define DW_FORM_ref (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 8 ? DW_FORM_ref8 : DW_FORM_ref4)
374
375#ifndef DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION
376#define DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION	".debug_frame"
377#endif
378
379#ifndef FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL
380#define FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL	"LFB"
381#endif
382
383#ifndef FUNC_END_LABEL
384#define FUNC_END_LABEL		"LFE"
385#endif
386
387#ifndef FRAME_BEGIN_LABEL
388#define FRAME_BEGIN_LABEL	"Lframe"
389#endif
390#define CIE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL	"LSCIE"
391#define CIE_END_LABEL		"LECIE"
392#define FDE_LABEL		"LSFDE"
393#define FDE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL	"LASFDE"
394#define FDE_END_LABEL		"LEFDE"
395#define LINE_NUMBER_BEGIN_LABEL	"LSLT"
396#define LINE_NUMBER_END_LABEL	"LELT"
397#define LN_PROLOG_AS_LABEL	"LASLTP"
398#define LN_PROLOG_END_LABEL	"LELTP"
399#define DIE_LABEL_PREFIX	"DW"
400
401/* The DWARF 2 CFA column which tracks the return address.  Normally this
402   is the column for PC, or the first column after all of the hard
403   registers.  */
404#ifndef DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN
405#ifdef PC_REGNUM
406#define DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN	DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (PC_REGNUM)
407#else
408#define DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN	DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
409#endif
410#endif
411
412/* The mapping from gcc register number to DWARF 2 CFA column number.  By
413   default, we just provide columns for all registers.  */
414#ifndef DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM
415#define DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM(REG) DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (REG)
416#endif
417
418/* Hook used by __throw.  */
419
420rtx
421expand_builtin_dwarf_sp_column (void)
422{
423  unsigned int dwarf_regnum = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
424  return GEN_INT (DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (dwarf_regnum, 1));
425}
426
427/* Return a pointer to a copy of the section string name S with all
428   attributes stripped off, and an asterisk prepended (for assemble_name).  */
429
430static inline char *
431stripattributes (const char *s)
432{
433  char *stripped = XNEWVEC (char, strlen (s) + 2);
434  char *p = stripped;
435
436  *p++ = '*';
437
438  while (*s && *s != ',')
439    *p++ = *s++;
440
441  *p = '\0';
442  return stripped;
443}
444
445/* Generate code to initialize the register size table.  */
446
447void
448expand_builtin_init_dwarf_reg_sizes (tree address)
449{
450  unsigned int i;
451  enum machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (char_type_node);
452  rtx addr = expand_normal (address);
453  rtx mem = gen_rtx_MEM (BLKmode, addr);
454  bool wrote_return_column = false;
455
456  for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
457    {
458      int rnum = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (i), 1);
459
460      if (rnum < DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS)
461	{
462	  HOST_WIDE_INT offset = rnum * GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
463	  enum machine_mode save_mode = reg_raw_mode[i];
464	  HOST_WIDE_INT size;
465
466	  if (HARD_REGNO_CALL_PART_CLOBBERED (i, save_mode))
467	    save_mode = choose_hard_reg_mode (i, 1, true);
468	  if (DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (i) == DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN)
469	    {
470	      if (save_mode == VOIDmode)
471		continue;
472	      wrote_return_column = true;
473	    }
474	  size = GET_MODE_SIZE (save_mode);
475	  if (offset < 0)
476	    continue;
477
478	  emit_move_insn (adjust_address (mem, mode, offset),
479			  gen_int_mode (size, mode));
480	}
481    }
482
483#ifdef DWARF_ALT_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN
484  gcc_assert (wrote_return_column);
485  i = DWARF_ALT_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN;
486  wrote_return_column = false;
487#else
488  i = DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN;
489#endif
490
491  if (! wrote_return_column)
492    {
493      enum machine_mode save_mode = Pmode;
494      HOST_WIDE_INT offset = i * GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
495      HOST_WIDE_INT size = GET_MODE_SIZE (save_mode);
496      emit_move_insn (adjust_address (mem, mode, offset), GEN_INT (size));
497    }
498}
499
500/* Convert a DWARF call frame info. operation to its string name */
501
502static const char *
503dwarf_cfi_name (unsigned int cfi_opc)
504{
505  switch (cfi_opc)
506    {
507    case DW_CFA_advance_loc:
508      return "DW_CFA_advance_loc";
509    case DW_CFA_offset:
510      return "DW_CFA_offset";
511    case DW_CFA_restore:
512      return "DW_CFA_restore";
513    case DW_CFA_nop:
514      return "DW_CFA_nop";
515    case DW_CFA_set_loc:
516      return "DW_CFA_set_loc";
517    case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
518      return "DW_CFA_advance_loc1";
519    case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
520      return "DW_CFA_advance_loc2";
521    case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
522      return "DW_CFA_advance_loc4";
523    case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
524      return "DW_CFA_offset_extended";
525    case DW_CFA_restore_extended:
526      return "DW_CFA_restore_extended";
527    case DW_CFA_undefined:
528      return "DW_CFA_undefined";
529    case DW_CFA_same_value:
530      return "DW_CFA_same_value";
531    case DW_CFA_register:
532      return "DW_CFA_register";
533    case DW_CFA_remember_state:
534      return "DW_CFA_remember_state";
535    case DW_CFA_restore_state:
536      return "DW_CFA_restore_state";
537    case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
538      return "DW_CFA_def_cfa";
539    case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
540      return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_register";
541    case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
542      return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset";
543
544    /* DWARF 3 */
545    case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
546      return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression";
547    case DW_CFA_expression:
548      return "DW_CFA_expression";
549    case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
550      return "DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf";
551    case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
552      return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf";
553    case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
554      return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf";
555
556    /* SGI/MIPS specific */
557    case DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8:
558      return "DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8";
559
560    /* GNU extensions */
561    case DW_CFA_GNU_window_save:
562      return "DW_CFA_GNU_window_save";
563    case DW_CFA_GNU_args_size:
564      return "DW_CFA_GNU_args_size";
565    case DW_CFA_GNU_negative_offset_extended:
566      return "DW_CFA_GNU_negative_offset_extended";
567
568    default:
569      return "DW_CFA_<unknown>";
570    }
571}
572
573/* Return a pointer to a newly allocated Call Frame Instruction.  */
574
575static inline dw_cfi_ref
576new_cfi (void)
577{
578  dw_cfi_ref cfi = ggc_alloc (sizeof (dw_cfi_node));
579
580  cfi->dw_cfi_next = NULL;
581  cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = 0;
582  cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_reg_num = 0;
583
584  return cfi;
585}
586
587/* Add a Call Frame Instruction to list of instructions.  */
588
589static inline void
590add_cfi (dw_cfi_ref *list_head, dw_cfi_ref cfi)
591{
592  dw_cfi_ref *p;
593
594  /* Find the end of the chain.  */
595  for (p = list_head; (*p) != NULL; p = &(*p)->dw_cfi_next)
596    ;
597
598  *p = cfi;
599}
600
601/* Generate a new label for the CFI info to refer to.  */
602
603char *
604dwarf2out_cfi_label (void)
605{
606  static char label[20];
607
608  ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "LCFI", dwarf2out_cfi_label_num++);
609  ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, label);
610  return label;
611}
612
613/* Add CFI to the current fde at the PC value indicated by LABEL if specified,
614   or to the CIE if LABEL is NULL.  */
615
616static void
617add_fde_cfi (const char *label, dw_cfi_ref cfi)
618{
619  if (label)
620    {
621      dw_fde_ref fde = &fde_table[fde_table_in_use - 1];
622
623      if (*label == 0)
624	label = dwarf2out_cfi_label ();
625
626      if (fde->dw_fde_current_label == NULL
627	  || strcmp (label, fde->dw_fde_current_label) != 0)
628	{
629	  dw_cfi_ref xcfi;
630
631	  label = xstrdup (label);
632
633	  /* Set the location counter to the new label.  */
634	  xcfi = new_cfi ();
635	  /* If we have a current label, advance from there, otherwise
636	     set the location directly using set_loc.  */
637	  xcfi->dw_cfi_opc = fde->dw_fde_current_label
638			     ? DW_CFA_advance_loc4
639			     : DW_CFA_set_loc;
640	  xcfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr = label;
641	  add_cfi (&fde->dw_fde_cfi, xcfi);
642
643	  fde->dw_fde_current_label = label;
644	}
645
646      add_cfi (&fde->dw_fde_cfi, cfi);
647    }
648
649  else
650    add_cfi (&cie_cfi_head, cfi);
651}
652
653/* Subroutine of lookup_cfa.  */
654
655static void
656lookup_cfa_1 (dw_cfi_ref cfi, dw_cfa_location *loc)
657{
658  switch (cfi->dw_cfi_opc)
659    {
660    case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
661      loc->offset = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset;
662      break;
663    case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
664      loc->offset
665	= cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset * DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT;
666      break;
667    case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
668      loc->reg = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num;
669      break;
670    case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
671      loc->reg = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num;
672      loc->offset = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset;
673      break;
674    case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
675      loc->reg = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num;
676      loc->offset
677	= cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset * DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT;
678      break;
679    case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
680      get_cfa_from_loc_descr (loc, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_loc);
681      break;
682    default:
683      break;
684    }
685}
686
687/* Find the previous value for the CFA.  */
688
689static void
690lookup_cfa (dw_cfa_location *loc)
691{
692  dw_cfi_ref cfi;
693
694  loc->reg = INVALID_REGNUM;
695  loc->offset = 0;
696  loc->indirect = 0;
697  loc->base_offset = 0;
698
699  for (cfi = cie_cfi_head; cfi; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
700    lookup_cfa_1 (cfi, loc);
701
702  if (fde_table_in_use)
703    {
704      dw_fde_ref fde = &fde_table[fde_table_in_use - 1];
705      for (cfi = fde->dw_fde_cfi; cfi; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
706	lookup_cfa_1 (cfi, loc);
707    }
708}
709
710/* The current rule for calculating the DWARF2 canonical frame address.  */
711static dw_cfa_location cfa;
712
713/* The register used for saving registers to the stack, and its offset
714   from the CFA.  */
715static dw_cfa_location cfa_store;
716
717/* The running total of the size of arguments pushed onto the stack.  */
718static HOST_WIDE_INT args_size;
719
720/* The last args_size we actually output.  */
721static HOST_WIDE_INT old_args_size;
722
723/* Entry point to update the canonical frame address (CFA).
724   LABEL is passed to add_fde_cfi.  The value of CFA is now to be
725   calculated from REG+OFFSET.  */
726
727void
728dwarf2out_def_cfa (const char *label, unsigned int reg, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
729{
730  dw_cfa_location loc;
731  loc.indirect = 0;
732  loc.base_offset = 0;
733  loc.reg = reg;
734  loc.offset = offset;
735  def_cfa_1 (label, &loc);
736}
737
738/* Determine if two dw_cfa_location structures define the same data.  */
739
740static bool
741cfa_equal_p (const dw_cfa_location *loc1, const dw_cfa_location *loc2)
742{
743  return (loc1->reg == loc2->reg
744	  && loc1->offset == loc2->offset
745	  && loc1->indirect == loc2->indirect
746	  && (loc1->indirect == 0
747	      || loc1->base_offset == loc2->base_offset));
748}
749
750/* This routine does the actual work.  The CFA is now calculated from
751   the dw_cfa_location structure.  */
752
753static void
754def_cfa_1 (const char *label, dw_cfa_location *loc_p)
755{
756  dw_cfi_ref cfi;
757  dw_cfa_location old_cfa, loc;
758
759  cfa = *loc_p;
760  loc = *loc_p;
761
762  if (cfa_store.reg == loc.reg && loc.indirect == 0)
763    cfa_store.offset = loc.offset;
764
765  loc.reg = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (loc.reg);
766  lookup_cfa (&old_cfa);
767
768  /* If nothing changed, no need to issue any call frame instructions.  */
769  if (cfa_equal_p (&loc, &old_cfa))
770    return;
771
772  cfi = new_cfi ();
773
774  if (loc.reg == old_cfa.reg && !loc.indirect)
775    {
776      /* Construct a "DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset <offset>" instruction, indicating
777	 the CFA register did not change but the offset did.  */
778      if (loc.offset < 0)
779	{
780	  HOST_WIDE_INT f_offset = loc.offset / DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT;
781	  gcc_assert (f_offset * DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT == loc.offset);
782
783	  cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf;
784	  cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset = f_offset;
785	}
786      else
787	{
788	  cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset;
789	  cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset = loc.offset;
790	}
791    }
792
793#ifndef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO  /* SGI dbx thinks this means no offset.  */
794  else if (loc.offset == old_cfa.offset
795	   && old_cfa.reg != INVALID_REGNUM
796	   && !loc.indirect)
797    {
798      /* Construct a "DW_CFA_def_cfa_register <register>" instruction,
799	 indicating the CFA register has changed to <register> but the
800	 offset has not changed.  */
801      cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa_register;
802      cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = loc.reg;
803    }
804#endif
805
806  else if (loc.indirect == 0)
807    {
808      /* Construct a "DW_CFA_def_cfa <register> <offset>" instruction,
809	 indicating the CFA register has changed to <register> with
810	 the specified offset.  */
811      if (loc.offset < 0)
812	{
813	  HOST_WIDE_INT f_offset = loc.offset / DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT;
814	  gcc_assert (f_offset * DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT == loc.offset);
815
816	  cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf;
817	  cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = loc.reg;
818	  cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset = f_offset;
819	}
820      else
821	{
822	  cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa;
823	  cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = loc.reg;
824	  cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset = loc.offset;
825	}
826    }
827  else
828    {
829      /* Construct a DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression instruction to
830	 calculate the CFA using a full location expression since no
831	 register-offset pair is available.  */
832      struct dw_loc_descr_struct *loc_list;
833
834      cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression;
835      loc_list = build_cfa_loc (&loc, 0);
836      cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_loc = loc_list;
837    }
838
839  add_fde_cfi (label, cfi);
840}
841
842/* Add the CFI for saving a register.  REG is the CFA column number.
843   LABEL is passed to add_fde_cfi.
844   If SREG is -1, the register is saved at OFFSET from the CFA;
845   otherwise it is saved in SREG.  */
846
847static void
848reg_save (const char *label, unsigned int reg, unsigned int sreg, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
849{
850  dw_cfi_ref cfi = new_cfi ();
851
852  cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = reg;
853
854  if (sreg == INVALID_REGNUM)
855    {
856      if (reg & ~0x3f)
857	/* The register number won't fit in 6 bits, so we have to use
858	   the long form.  */
859	cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_offset_extended;
860      else
861	cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_offset;
862
863#ifdef ENABLE_CHECKING
864      {
865	/* If we get an offset that is not a multiple of
866	   DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT, there is either a bug in the
867	   definition of DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT, or a bug in the machine
868	   description.  */
869	HOST_WIDE_INT check_offset = offset / DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT;
870
871	gcc_assert (check_offset * DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT == offset);
872      }
873#endif
874      offset /= DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT;
875      if (offset < 0)
876	cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf;
877
878      cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset = offset;
879    }
880  else if (sreg == reg)
881    cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_same_value;
882  else
883    {
884      cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_register;
885      cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_reg_num = sreg;
886    }
887
888  add_fde_cfi (label, cfi);
889}
890
891/* Add the CFI for saving a register window.  LABEL is passed to reg_save.
892   This CFI tells the unwinder that it needs to restore the window registers
893   from the previous frame's window save area.
894
895   ??? Perhaps we should note in the CIE where windows are saved (instead of
896   assuming 0(cfa)) and what registers are in the window.  */
897
898void
899dwarf2out_window_save (const char *label)
900{
901  dw_cfi_ref cfi = new_cfi ();
902
903  cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_GNU_window_save;
904  add_fde_cfi (label, cfi);
905}
906
907/* Add a CFI to update the running total of the size of arguments
908   pushed onto the stack.  */
909
910void
911dwarf2out_args_size (const char *label, HOST_WIDE_INT size)
912{
913  dw_cfi_ref cfi;
914
915  if (size == old_args_size)
916    return;
917
918  old_args_size = size;
919
920  cfi = new_cfi ();
921  cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_GNU_args_size;
922  cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset = size;
923  add_fde_cfi (label, cfi);
924}
925
926/* Entry point for saving a register to the stack.  REG is the GCC register
927   number.  LABEL and OFFSET are passed to reg_save.  */
928
929void
930dwarf2out_reg_save (const char *label, unsigned int reg, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
931{
932  reg_save (label, DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (reg), INVALID_REGNUM, offset);
933}
934
935/* Entry point for saving the return address in the stack.
936   LABEL and OFFSET are passed to reg_save.  */
937
938void
939dwarf2out_return_save (const char *label, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
940{
941  reg_save (label, DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN, INVALID_REGNUM, offset);
942}
943
944/* Entry point for saving the return address in a register.
945   LABEL and SREG are passed to reg_save.  */
946
947void
948dwarf2out_return_reg (const char *label, unsigned int sreg)
949{
950  reg_save (label, DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN, DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (sreg), 0);
951}
952
953/* Record the initial position of the return address.  RTL is
954   INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX.  */
955
956static void
957initial_return_save (rtx rtl)
958{
959  unsigned int reg = INVALID_REGNUM;
960  HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
961
962  switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
963    {
964    case REG:
965      /* RA is in a register.  */
966      reg = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (rtl));
967      break;
968
969    case MEM:
970      /* RA is on the stack.  */
971      rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
972      switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
973	{
974	case REG:
975	  gcc_assert (REGNO (rtl) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
976	  offset = 0;
977	  break;
978
979	case PLUS:
980	  gcc_assert (REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
981	  offset = INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1));
982	  break;
983
984	case MINUS:
985	  gcc_assert (REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
986	  offset = -INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1));
987	  break;
988
989	default:
990	  gcc_unreachable ();
991	}
992
993      break;
994
995    case PLUS:
996      /* The return address is at some offset from any value we can
997	 actually load.  For instance, on the SPARC it is in %i7+8. Just
998	 ignore the offset for now; it doesn't matter for unwinding frames.  */
999      gcc_assert (GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 1)) == CONST_INT);
1000      initial_return_save (XEXP (rtl, 0));
1001      return;
1002
1003    default:
1004      gcc_unreachable ();
1005    }
1006
1007  if (reg != DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN)
1008    reg_save (NULL, DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN, reg, offset - cfa.offset);
1009}
1010
1011/* Given a SET, calculate the amount of stack adjustment it
1012   contains.  */
1013
1014static HOST_WIDE_INT
1015stack_adjust_offset (rtx pattern)
1016{
1017  rtx src = SET_SRC (pattern);
1018  rtx dest = SET_DEST (pattern);
1019  HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
1020  enum rtx_code code;
1021
1022  if (dest == stack_pointer_rtx)
1023    {
1024      /* (set (reg sp) (plus (reg sp) (const_int))) */
1025      code = GET_CODE (src);
1026      if (! (code == PLUS || code == MINUS)
1027	  || XEXP (src, 0) != stack_pointer_rtx
1028	  || GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) != CONST_INT)
1029	return 0;
1030
1031      offset = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
1032      if (code == PLUS)
1033	offset = -offset;
1034    }
1035  else if (MEM_P (dest))
1036    {
1037      /* (set (mem (pre_dec (reg sp))) (foo)) */
1038      src = XEXP (dest, 0);
1039      code = GET_CODE (src);
1040
1041      switch (code)
1042	{
1043	case PRE_MODIFY:
1044	case POST_MODIFY:
1045	  if (XEXP (src, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx)
1046	    {
1047	      rtx val = XEXP (XEXP (src, 1), 1);
1048	      /* We handle only adjustments by constant amount.  */
1049	      gcc_assert (GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) == PLUS
1050			  && GET_CODE (val) == CONST_INT);
1051	      offset = -INTVAL (val);
1052	      break;
1053	    }
1054	  return 0;
1055
1056	case PRE_DEC:
1057	case POST_DEC:
1058	  if (XEXP (src, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx)
1059	    {
1060	      offset = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest));
1061	      break;
1062	    }
1063	  return 0;
1064
1065	case PRE_INC:
1066	case POST_INC:
1067	  if (XEXP (src, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx)
1068	    {
1069	      offset = -GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest));
1070	      break;
1071	    }
1072	  return 0;
1073
1074	default:
1075	  return 0;
1076	}
1077    }
1078  else
1079    return 0;
1080
1081  return offset;
1082}
1083
1084/* Check INSN to see if it looks like a push or a stack adjustment, and
1085   make a note of it if it does.  EH uses this information to find out how
1086   much extra space it needs to pop off the stack.  */
1087
1088static void
1089dwarf2out_stack_adjust (rtx insn, bool after_p)
1090{
1091  HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
1092  const char *label;
1093  int i;
1094
1095  /* Don't handle epilogues at all.  Certainly it would be wrong to do so
1096     with this function.  Proper support would require all frame-related
1097     insns to be marked, and to be able to handle saving state around
1098     epilogues textually in the middle of the function.  */
1099  if (prologue_epilogue_contains (insn) || sibcall_epilogue_contains (insn))
1100    return;
1101
1102  /* If only calls can throw, and we have a frame pointer,
1103     save up adjustments until we see the CALL_INSN.  */
1104  if (!flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables && cfa.reg != STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1105    {
1106      if (CALL_P (insn) && !after_p)
1107	{
1108	  /* Extract the size of the args from the CALL rtx itself.  */
1109	  insn = PATTERN (insn);
1110	  if (GET_CODE (insn) == PARALLEL)
1111	    insn = XVECEXP (insn, 0, 0);
1112	  if (GET_CODE (insn) == SET)
1113	    insn = SET_SRC (insn);
1114	  gcc_assert (GET_CODE (insn) == CALL);
1115	  dwarf2out_args_size ("", INTVAL (XEXP (insn, 1)));
1116	}
1117      return;
1118    }
1119
1120  if (CALL_P (insn) && !after_p)
1121    {
1122      if (!flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables)
1123	dwarf2out_args_size ("", args_size);
1124      return;
1125    }
1126  else if (BARRIER_P (insn))
1127    {
1128      /* When we see a BARRIER, we know to reset args_size to 0.  Usually
1129	 the compiler will have already emitted a stack adjustment, but
1130	 doesn't bother for calls to noreturn functions.  */
1131#ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
1132      offset = -args_size;
1133#else
1134      offset = args_size;
1135#endif
1136    }
1137  else if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == SET)
1138    offset = stack_adjust_offset (PATTERN (insn));
1139  else if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == PARALLEL
1140	   || GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == SEQUENCE)
1141    {
1142      /* There may be stack adjustments inside compound insns.  Search
1143	 for them.  */
1144      for (offset = 0, i = XVECLEN (PATTERN (insn), 0) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
1145	if (GET_CODE (XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0, i)) == SET)
1146	  offset += stack_adjust_offset (XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0, i));
1147    }
1148  else
1149    return;
1150
1151  if (offset == 0)
1152    return;
1153
1154  if (cfa.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1155    cfa.offset += offset;
1156
1157#ifndef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
1158  offset = -offset;
1159#endif
1160
1161  args_size += offset;
1162  if (args_size < 0)
1163    args_size = 0;
1164
1165  label = dwarf2out_cfi_label ();
1166  def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
1167  if (flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables)
1168    dwarf2out_args_size (label, args_size);
1169}
1170
1171#endif
1172
1173/* We delay emitting a register save until either (a) we reach the end
1174   of the prologue or (b) the register is clobbered.  This clusters
1175   register saves so that there are fewer pc advances.  */
1176
1177struct queued_reg_save GTY(())
1178{
1179  struct queued_reg_save *next;
1180  rtx reg;
1181  HOST_WIDE_INT cfa_offset;
1182  rtx saved_reg;
1183};
1184
1185static GTY(()) struct queued_reg_save *queued_reg_saves;
1186
1187/* The caller's ORIG_REG is saved in SAVED_IN_REG.  */
1188struct reg_saved_in_data GTY(()) {
1189  rtx orig_reg;
1190  rtx saved_in_reg;
1191};
1192
1193/* A list of registers saved in other registers.
1194   The list intentionally has a small maximum capacity of 4; if your
1195   port needs more than that, you might consider implementing a
1196   more efficient data structure.  */
1197static GTY(()) struct reg_saved_in_data regs_saved_in_regs[4];
1198static GTY(()) size_t num_regs_saved_in_regs;
1199
1200#if defined (DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO) || defined (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO)
1201static const char *last_reg_save_label;
1202
1203/* Add an entry to QUEUED_REG_SAVES saying that REG is now saved at
1204   SREG, or if SREG is NULL then it is saved at OFFSET to the CFA.  */
1205
1206static void
1207queue_reg_save (const char *label, rtx reg, rtx sreg, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
1208{
1209  struct queued_reg_save *q;
1210
1211  /* Duplicates waste space, but it's also necessary to remove them
1212     for correctness, since the queue gets output in reverse
1213     order.  */
1214  for (q = queued_reg_saves; q != NULL; q = q->next)
1215    if (REGNO (q->reg) == REGNO (reg))
1216      break;
1217
1218  if (q == NULL)
1219    {
1220      q = ggc_alloc (sizeof (*q));
1221      q->next = queued_reg_saves;
1222      queued_reg_saves = q;
1223    }
1224
1225  q->reg = reg;
1226  q->cfa_offset = offset;
1227  q->saved_reg = sreg;
1228
1229  last_reg_save_label = label;
1230}
1231
1232/* Output all the entries in QUEUED_REG_SAVES.  */
1233
1234static void
1235flush_queued_reg_saves (void)
1236{
1237  struct queued_reg_save *q;
1238
1239  for (q = queued_reg_saves; q; q = q->next)
1240    {
1241      size_t i;
1242      unsigned int reg, sreg;
1243
1244      for (i = 0; i < num_regs_saved_in_regs; i++)
1245	if (REGNO (regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg) == REGNO (q->reg))
1246	  break;
1247      if (q->saved_reg && i == num_regs_saved_in_regs)
1248	{
1249	  gcc_assert (i != ARRAY_SIZE (regs_saved_in_regs));
1250	  num_regs_saved_in_regs++;
1251	}
1252      if (i != num_regs_saved_in_regs)
1253	{
1254	  regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg = q->reg;
1255	  regs_saved_in_regs[i].saved_in_reg = q->saved_reg;
1256	}
1257
1258      reg = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (q->reg));
1259      if (q->saved_reg)
1260	sreg = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (q->saved_reg));
1261      else
1262	sreg = INVALID_REGNUM;
1263      reg_save (last_reg_save_label, reg, sreg, q->cfa_offset);
1264    }
1265
1266  queued_reg_saves = NULL;
1267  last_reg_save_label = NULL;
1268}
1269
1270/* Does INSN clobber any register which QUEUED_REG_SAVES lists a saved
1271   location for?  Or, does it clobber a register which we've previously
1272   said that some other register is saved in, and for which we now
1273   have a new location for?  */
1274
1275static bool
1276clobbers_queued_reg_save (rtx insn)
1277{
1278  struct queued_reg_save *q;
1279
1280  for (q = queued_reg_saves; q; q = q->next)
1281    {
1282      size_t i;
1283      if (modified_in_p (q->reg, insn))
1284	return true;
1285      for (i = 0; i < num_regs_saved_in_regs; i++)
1286	if (REGNO (q->reg) == REGNO (regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg)
1287	    && modified_in_p (regs_saved_in_regs[i].saved_in_reg, insn))
1288	  return true;
1289    }
1290
1291  return false;
1292}
1293
1294/* Entry point for saving the first register into the second.  */
1295
1296void
1297dwarf2out_reg_save_reg (const char *label, rtx reg, rtx sreg)
1298{
1299  size_t i;
1300  unsigned int regno, sregno;
1301
1302  for (i = 0; i < num_regs_saved_in_regs; i++)
1303    if (REGNO (regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg) == REGNO (reg))
1304      break;
1305  if (i == num_regs_saved_in_regs)
1306    {
1307      gcc_assert (i != ARRAY_SIZE (regs_saved_in_regs));
1308      num_regs_saved_in_regs++;
1309    }
1310  regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg = reg;
1311  regs_saved_in_regs[i].saved_in_reg = sreg;
1312
1313  regno = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (reg));
1314  sregno = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (sreg));
1315  reg_save (label, regno, sregno, 0);
1316}
1317
1318/* What register, if any, is currently saved in REG?  */
1319
1320static rtx
1321reg_saved_in (rtx reg)
1322{
1323  unsigned int regn = REGNO (reg);
1324  size_t i;
1325  struct queued_reg_save *q;
1326
1327  for (q = queued_reg_saves; q; q = q->next)
1328    if (q->saved_reg && regn == REGNO (q->saved_reg))
1329      return q->reg;
1330
1331  for (i = 0; i < num_regs_saved_in_regs; i++)
1332    if (regs_saved_in_regs[i].saved_in_reg
1333	&& regn == REGNO (regs_saved_in_regs[i].saved_in_reg))
1334      return regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg;
1335
1336  return NULL_RTX;
1337}
1338
1339
1340/* A temporary register holding an integral value used in adjusting SP
1341   or setting up the store_reg.  The "offset" field holds the integer
1342   value, not an offset.  */
1343static dw_cfa_location cfa_temp;
1344
1345/* Record call frame debugging information for an expression EXPR,
1346   which either sets SP or FP (adjusting how we calculate the frame
1347   address) or saves a register to the stack or another register.
1348   LABEL indicates the address of EXPR.
1349
1350   This function encodes a state machine mapping rtxes to actions on
1351   cfa, cfa_store, and cfa_temp.reg.  We describe these rules so
1352   users need not read the source code.
1353
1354  The High-Level Picture
1355
1356  Changes in the register we use to calculate the CFA: Currently we
1357  assume that if you copy the CFA register into another register, we
1358  should take the other one as the new CFA register; this seems to
1359  work pretty well.  If it's wrong for some target, it's simple
1360  enough not to set RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P on the insn in question.
1361
1362  Changes in the register we use for saving registers to the stack:
1363  This is usually SP, but not always.  Again, we deduce that if you
1364  copy SP into another register (and SP is not the CFA register),
1365  then the new register is the one we will be using for register
1366  saves.  This also seems to work.
1367
1368  Register saves: There's not much guesswork about this one; if
1369  RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P is set on an insn which modifies memory, it's a
1370  register save, and the register used to calculate the destination
1371  had better be the one we think we're using for this purpose.
1372  It's also assumed that a copy from a call-saved register to another
1373  register is saving that register if RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P is set on
1374  that instruction.  If the copy is from a call-saved register to
1375  the *same* register, that means that the register is now the same
1376  value as in the caller.
1377
1378  Except: If the register being saved is the CFA register, and the
1379  offset is nonzero, we are saving the CFA, so we assume we have to
1380  use DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression.  If the offset is 0, we assume that
1381  the intent is to save the value of SP from the previous frame.
1382
1383  In addition, if a register has previously been saved to a different
1384  register,
1385
1386  Invariants / Summaries of Rules
1387
1388  cfa	       current rule for calculating the CFA.  It usually
1389	       consists of a register and an offset.
1390  cfa_store    register used by prologue code to save things to the stack
1391	       cfa_store.offset is the offset from the value of
1392	       cfa_store.reg to the actual CFA
1393  cfa_temp     register holding an integral value.  cfa_temp.offset
1394	       stores the value, which will be used to adjust the
1395	       stack pointer.  cfa_temp is also used like cfa_store,
1396	       to track stores to the stack via fp or a temp reg.
1397
1398  Rules  1- 4: Setting a register's value to cfa.reg or an expression
1399	       with cfa.reg as the first operand changes the cfa.reg and its
1400	       cfa.offset.  Rule 1 and 4 also set cfa_temp.reg and
1401	       cfa_temp.offset.
1402
1403  Rules  6- 9: Set a non-cfa.reg register value to a constant or an
1404	       expression yielding a constant.  This sets cfa_temp.reg
1405	       and cfa_temp.offset.
1406
1407  Rule 5:      Create a new register cfa_store used to save items to the
1408	       stack.
1409
1410  Rules 10-14: Save a register to the stack.  Define offset as the
1411	       difference of the original location and cfa_store's
1412	       location (or cfa_temp's location if cfa_temp is used).
1413
1414  The Rules
1415
1416  "{a,b}" indicates a choice of a xor b.
1417  "<reg>:cfa.reg" indicates that <reg> must equal cfa.reg.
1418
1419  Rule 1:
1420  (set <reg1> <reg2>:cfa.reg)
1421  effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
1422	   cfa.offset unchanged
1423	   cfa_temp.reg = <reg1>
1424	   cfa_temp.offset = cfa.offset
1425
1426  Rule 2:
1427  (set sp ({minus,plus,losum} {sp,fp}:cfa.reg
1428			      {<const_int>,<reg>:cfa_temp.reg}))
1429  effects: cfa.reg = sp if fp used
1430	   cfa.offset += {+/- <const_int>, cfa_temp.offset} if cfa.reg==sp
1431	   cfa_store.offset += {+/- <const_int>, cfa_temp.offset}
1432	     if cfa_store.reg==sp
1433
1434  Rule 3:
1435  (set fp ({minus,plus,losum} <reg>:cfa.reg <const_int>))
1436  effects: cfa.reg = fp
1437	   cfa_offset += +/- <const_int>
1438
1439  Rule 4:
1440  (set <reg1> ({plus,losum} <reg2>:cfa.reg <const_int>))
1441  constraints: <reg1> != fp
1442	       <reg1> != sp
1443  effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
1444	   cfa_temp.reg = <reg1>
1445	   cfa_temp.offset = cfa.offset
1446
1447  Rule 5:
1448  (set <reg1> (plus <reg2>:cfa_temp.reg sp:cfa.reg))
1449  constraints: <reg1> != fp
1450	       <reg1> != sp
1451  effects: cfa_store.reg = <reg1>
1452	   cfa_store.offset = cfa.offset - cfa_temp.offset
1453
1454  Rule 6:
1455  (set <reg> <const_int>)
1456  effects: cfa_temp.reg = <reg>
1457	   cfa_temp.offset = <const_int>
1458
1459  Rule 7:
1460  (set <reg1>:cfa_temp.reg (ior <reg2>:cfa_temp.reg <const_int>))
1461  effects: cfa_temp.reg = <reg1>
1462	   cfa_temp.offset |= <const_int>
1463
1464  Rule 8:
1465  (set <reg> (high <exp>))
1466  effects: none
1467
1468  Rule 9:
1469  (set <reg> (lo_sum <exp> <const_int>))
1470  effects: cfa_temp.reg = <reg>
1471	   cfa_temp.offset = <const_int>
1472
1473  Rule 10:
1474  (set (mem (pre_modify sp:cfa_store (???? <reg1> <const_int>))) <reg2>)
1475  effects: cfa_store.offset -= <const_int>
1476	   cfa.offset = cfa_store.offset if cfa.reg == sp
1477	   cfa.reg = sp
1478	   cfa.base_offset = -cfa_store.offset
1479
1480  Rule 11:
1481  (set (mem ({pre_inc,pre_dec} sp:cfa_store.reg)) <reg>)
1482  effects: cfa_store.offset += -/+ mode_size(mem)
1483	   cfa.offset = cfa_store.offset if cfa.reg == sp
1484	   cfa.reg = sp
1485	   cfa.base_offset = -cfa_store.offset
1486
1487  Rule 12:
1488  (set (mem ({minus,plus,losum} <reg1>:{cfa_store,cfa_temp} <const_int>))
1489
1490       <reg2>)
1491  effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
1492	   cfa.base_offset = -/+ <const_int> - {cfa_store,cfa_temp}.offset
1493
1494  Rule 13:
1495  (set (mem <reg1>:{cfa_store,cfa_temp}) <reg2>)
1496  effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
1497	   cfa.base_offset = -{cfa_store,cfa_temp}.offset
1498
1499  Rule 14:
1500  (set (mem (postinc <reg1>:cfa_temp <const_int>)) <reg2>)
1501  effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
1502	   cfa.base_offset = -cfa_temp.offset
1503	   cfa_temp.offset -= mode_size(mem)
1504
1505  Rule 15:
1506  (set <reg> {unspec, unspec_volatile})
1507  effects: target-dependent  */
1508
1509static void
1510dwarf2out_frame_debug_expr (rtx expr, const char *label)
1511{
1512  rtx src, dest;
1513  HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
1514
1515  /* If RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P is set on a PARALLEL, process each member of
1516     the PARALLEL independently. The first element is always processed if
1517     it is a SET. This is for backward compatibility.   Other elements
1518     are processed only if they are SETs and the RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P
1519     flag is set in them.  */
1520  if (GET_CODE (expr) == PARALLEL || GET_CODE (expr) == SEQUENCE)
1521    {
1522      int par_index;
1523      int limit = XVECLEN (expr, 0);
1524
1525      for (par_index = 0; par_index < limit; par_index++)
1526	if (GET_CODE (XVECEXP (expr, 0, par_index)) == SET
1527	    && (RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (XVECEXP (expr, 0, par_index))
1528		|| par_index == 0))
1529	  dwarf2out_frame_debug_expr (XVECEXP (expr, 0, par_index), label);
1530
1531      return;
1532    }
1533
1534  gcc_assert (GET_CODE (expr) == SET);
1535
1536  src = SET_SRC (expr);
1537  dest = SET_DEST (expr);
1538
1539  if (REG_P (src))
1540    {
1541      rtx rsi = reg_saved_in (src);
1542      if (rsi)
1543	src = rsi;
1544    }
1545
1546  switch (GET_CODE (dest))
1547    {
1548    case REG:
1549      switch (GET_CODE (src))
1550	{
1551	  /* Setting FP from SP.  */
1552	case REG:
1553	  if (cfa.reg == (unsigned) REGNO (src))
1554	    {
1555	      /* Rule 1 */
1556	      /* Update the CFA rule wrt SP or FP.  Make sure src is
1557		 relative to the current CFA register.
1558
1559		 We used to require that dest be either SP or FP, but the
1560		 ARM copies SP to a temporary register, and from there to
1561		 FP.  So we just rely on the backends to only set
1562		 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P on appropriate insns.  */
1563	      cfa.reg = REGNO (dest);
1564	      cfa_temp.reg = cfa.reg;
1565	      cfa_temp.offset = cfa.offset;
1566	    }
1567	  else
1568	    {
1569	      /* Saving a register in a register.  */
1570	      gcc_assert (!fixed_regs [REGNO (dest)]
1571			  /* For the SPARC and its register window.  */
1572			  || (DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (src))
1573			      == DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN));
1574	      queue_reg_save (label, src, dest, 0);
1575	    }
1576	  break;
1577
1578	case PLUS:
1579	case MINUS:
1580	case LO_SUM:
1581	  if (dest == stack_pointer_rtx)
1582	    {
1583	      /* Rule 2 */
1584	      /* Adjusting SP.  */
1585	      switch (GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)))
1586		{
1587		case CONST_INT:
1588		  offset = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
1589		  break;
1590		case REG:
1591		  gcc_assert ((unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (src, 1))
1592			      == cfa_temp.reg);
1593		  offset = cfa_temp.offset;
1594		  break;
1595		default:
1596		  gcc_unreachable ();
1597		}
1598
1599	      if (XEXP (src, 0) == hard_frame_pointer_rtx)
1600		{
1601		  /* Restoring SP from FP in the epilogue.  */
1602		  gcc_assert (cfa.reg == (unsigned) HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM);
1603		  cfa.reg = STACK_POINTER_REGNUM;
1604		}
1605	      else if (GET_CODE (src) == LO_SUM)
1606		/* Assume we've set the source reg of the LO_SUM from sp.  */
1607		;
1608	      else
1609		gcc_assert (XEXP (src, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx);
1610
1611	      if (GET_CODE (src) != MINUS)
1612		offset = -offset;
1613	      if (cfa.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1614		cfa.offset += offset;
1615	      if (cfa_store.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1616		cfa_store.offset += offset;
1617	    }
1618	  else if (dest == hard_frame_pointer_rtx)
1619	    {
1620	      /* Rule 3 */
1621	      /* Either setting the FP from an offset of the SP,
1622		 or adjusting the FP */
1623	      gcc_assert (frame_pointer_needed);
1624
1625	      gcc_assert (REG_P (XEXP (src, 0))
1626			  && (unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (src, 0)) == cfa.reg
1627			  && GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) == CONST_INT);
1628	      offset = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
1629	      if (GET_CODE (src) != MINUS)
1630		offset = -offset;
1631	      cfa.offset += offset;
1632	      cfa.reg = HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM;
1633	    }
1634	  else
1635	    {
1636	      gcc_assert (GET_CODE (src) != MINUS);
1637
1638	      /* Rule 4 */
1639	      if (REG_P (XEXP (src, 0))
1640		  && REGNO (XEXP (src, 0)) == cfa.reg
1641		  && GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) == CONST_INT)
1642		{
1643		  /* Setting a temporary CFA register that will be copied
1644		     into the FP later on.  */
1645		  offset = - INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
1646		  cfa.offset += offset;
1647		  cfa.reg = REGNO (dest);
1648		  /* Or used to save regs to the stack.  */
1649		  cfa_temp.reg = cfa.reg;
1650		  cfa_temp.offset = cfa.offset;
1651		}
1652
1653	      /* Rule 5 */
1654	      else if (REG_P (XEXP (src, 0))
1655		       && REGNO (XEXP (src, 0)) == cfa_temp.reg
1656		       && XEXP (src, 1) == stack_pointer_rtx)
1657		{
1658		  /* Setting a scratch register that we will use instead
1659		     of SP for saving registers to the stack.  */
1660		  gcc_assert (cfa.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
1661		  cfa_store.reg = REGNO (dest);
1662		  cfa_store.offset = cfa.offset - cfa_temp.offset;
1663		}
1664
1665	      /* Rule 9 */
1666	      else if (GET_CODE (src) == LO_SUM
1667		       && GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) == CONST_INT)
1668		{
1669		  cfa_temp.reg = REGNO (dest);
1670		  cfa_temp.offset = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
1671		}
1672	      else
1673		gcc_unreachable ();
1674	    }
1675	  break;
1676
1677	  /* Rule 6 */
1678	case CONST_INT:
1679	  cfa_temp.reg = REGNO (dest);
1680	  cfa_temp.offset = INTVAL (src);
1681	  break;
1682
1683	  /* Rule 7 */
1684	case IOR:
1685	  gcc_assert (REG_P (XEXP (src, 0))
1686		      && (unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (src, 0)) == cfa_temp.reg
1687		      && GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) == CONST_INT);
1688
1689	  if ((unsigned) REGNO (dest) != cfa_temp.reg)
1690	    cfa_temp.reg = REGNO (dest);
1691	  cfa_temp.offset |= INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
1692	  break;
1693
1694	  /* Skip over HIGH, assuming it will be followed by a LO_SUM,
1695	     which will fill in all of the bits.  */
1696	  /* Rule 8 */
1697	case HIGH:
1698	  break;
1699
1700	  /* Rule 15 */
1701	case UNSPEC:
1702	case UNSPEC_VOLATILE:
1703	  gcc_assert (targetm.dwarf_handle_frame_unspec);
1704	  targetm.dwarf_handle_frame_unspec (label, expr, XINT (src, 1));
1705	  return;
1706
1707	default:
1708	  gcc_unreachable ();
1709	}
1710
1711      def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
1712      break;
1713
1714    case MEM:
1715      gcc_assert (REG_P (src));
1716
1717      /* Saving a register to the stack.  Make sure dest is relative to the
1718	 CFA register.  */
1719      switch (GET_CODE (XEXP (dest, 0)))
1720	{
1721	  /* Rule 10 */
1722	  /* With a push.  */
1723	case PRE_MODIFY:
1724	  /* We can't handle variable size modifications.  */
1725	  gcc_assert (GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 1), 1))
1726		      == CONST_INT);
1727	  offset = -INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 1), 1));
1728
1729	  gcc_assert (REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0)) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
1730		      && cfa_store.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
1731
1732	  cfa_store.offset += offset;
1733	  if (cfa.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1734	    cfa.offset = cfa_store.offset;
1735
1736	  offset = -cfa_store.offset;
1737	  break;
1738
1739	  /* Rule 11 */
1740	case PRE_INC:
1741	case PRE_DEC:
1742	  offset = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest));
1743	  if (GET_CODE (XEXP (dest, 0)) == PRE_INC)
1744	    offset = -offset;
1745
1746	  gcc_assert (REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0)) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
1747		      && cfa_store.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
1748
1749	  cfa_store.offset += offset;
1750	  if (cfa.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1751	    cfa.offset = cfa_store.offset;
1752
1753	  offset = -cfa_store.offset;
1754	  break;
1755
1756	  /* Rule 12 */
1757	  /* With an offset.  */
1758	case PLUS:
1759	case MINUS:
1760	case LO_SUM:
1761	  {
1762	    int regno;
1763
1764	    gcc_assert (GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 1)) == CONST_INT
1765			&& REG_P (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0)));
1766	    offset = INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 1));
1767	    if (GET_CODE (XEXP (dest, 0)) == MINUS)
1768	      offset = -offset;
1769
1770	    regno = REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0));
1771
1772	    if (cfa_store.reg == (unsigned) regno)
1773	      offset -= cfa_store.offset;
1774	    else
1775	      {
1776		gcc_assert (cfa_temp.reg == (unsigned) regno);
1777		offset -= cfa_temp.offset;
1778	      }
1779	  }
1780	  break;
1781
1782	  /* Rule 13 */
1783	  /* Without an offset.  */
1784	case REG:
1785	  {
1786	    int regno = REGNO (XEXP (dest, 0));
1787
1788	    if (cfa_store.reg == (unsigned) regno)
1789	      offset = -cfa_store.offset;
1790	    else
1791	      {
1792		gcc_assert (cfa_temp.reg == (unsigned) regno);
1793		offset = -cfa_temp.offset;
1794	      }
1795	  }
1796	  break;
1797
1798	  /* Rule 14 */
1799	case POST_INC:
1800	  gcc_assert (cfa_temp.reg
1801		      == (unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0)));
1802	  offset = -cfa_temp.offset;
1803	  cfa_temp.offset -= GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest));
1804	  break;
1805
1806	default:
1807	  gcc_unreachable ();
1808	}
1809
1810      if (REGNO (src) != STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
1811	  && REGNO (src) != HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
1812	  && (unsigned) REGNO (src) == cfa.reg)
1813	{
1814	  /* We're storing the current CFA reg into the stack.  */
1815
1816	  if (cfa.offset == 0)
1817	    {
1818	      /* If the source register is exactly the CFA, assume
1819		 we're saving SP like any other register; this happens
1820		 on the ARM.  */
1821	      def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
1822	      queue_reg_save (label, stack_pointer_rtx, NULL_RTX, offset);
1823	      break;
1824	    }
1825	  else
1826	    {
1827	      /* Otherwise, we'll need to look in the stack to
1828		 calculate the CFA.  */
1829	      rtx x = XEXP (dest, 0);
1830
1831	      if (!REG_P (x))
1832		x = XEXP (x, 0);
1833	      gcc_assert (REG_P (x));
1834
1835	      cfa.reg = REGNO (x);
1836	      cfa.base_offset = offset;
1837	      cfa.indirect = 1;
1838	      def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
1839	      break;
1840	    }
1841	}
1842
1843      def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
1844      queue_reg_save (label, src, NULL_RTX, offset);
1845      break;
1846
1847    default:
1848      gcc_unreachable ();
1849    }
1850}
1851
1852/* Record call frame debugging information for INSN, which either
1853   sets SP or FP (adjusting how we calculate the frame address) or saves a
1854   register to the stack.  If INSN is NULL_RTX, initialize our state.
1855
1856   If AFTER_P is false, we're being called before the insn is emitted,
1857   otherwise after.  Call instructions get invoked twice.  */
1858
1859void
1860dwarf2out_frame_debug (rtx insn, bool after_p)
1861{
1862  const char *label;
1863  rtx src;
1864
1865  if (insn == NULL_RTX)
1866    {
1867      size_t i;
1868
1869      /* Flush any queued register saves.  */
1870      flush_queued_reg_saves ();
1871
1872      /* Set up state for generating call frame debug info.  */
1873      lookup_cfa (&cfa);
1874      gcc_assert (cfa.reg
1875		  == (unsigned long)DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (STACK_POINTER_REGNUM));
1876
1877      cfa.reg = STACK_POINTER_REGNUM;
1878      cfa_store = cfa;
1879      cfa_temp.reg = -1;
1880      cfa_temp.offset = 0;
1881
1882      for (i = 0; i < num_regs_saved_in_regs; i++)
1883	{
1884	  regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg = NULL_RTX;
1885	  regs_saved_in_regs[i].saved_in_reg = NULL_RTX;
1886	}
1887      num_regs_saved_in_regs = 0;
1888      return;
1889    }
1890
1891  if (!NONJUMP_INSN_P (insn) || clobbers_queued_reg_save (insn))
1892    flush_queued_reg_saves ();
1893
1894  if (! RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (insn))
1895    {
1896      if (!ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS)
1897	dwarf2out_stack_adjust (insn, after_p);
1898      return;
1899    }
1900
1901  label = dwarf2out_cfi_label ();
1902  src = find_reg_note (insn, REG_FRAME_RELATED_EXPR, NULL_RTX);
1903  if (src)
1904    insn = XEXP (src, 0);
1905  else
1906    insn = PATTERN (insn);
1907
1908  dwarf2out_frame_debug_expr (insn, label);
1909}
1910
1911#endif
1912
1913/* Describe for the GTY machinery what parts of dw_cfi_oprnd1 are used.  */
1914static enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type dw_cfi_oprnd1_desc
1915 (enum dwarf_call_frame_info cfi);
1916
1917static enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type
1918dw_cfi_oprnd1_desc (enum dwarf_call_frame_info cfi)
1919{
1920  switch (cfi)
1921    {
1922    case DW_CFA_nop:
1923    case DW_CFA_GNU_window_save:
1924      return dw_cfi_oprnd_unused;
1925
1926    case DW_CFA_set_loc:
1927    case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
1928    case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
1929    case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
1930    case DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8:
1931      return dw_cfi_oprnd_addr;
1932
1933    case DW_CFA_offset:
1934    case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
1935    case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
1936    case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
1937    case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
1938    case DW_CFA_restore_extended:
1939    case DW_CFA_undefined:
1940    case DW_CFA_same_value:
1941    case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
1942    case DW_CFA_register:
1943      return dw_cfi_oprnd_reg_num;
1944
1945    case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
1946    case DW_CFA_GNU_args_size:
1947    case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
1948      return dw_cfi_oprnd_offset;
1949
1950    case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
1951    case DW_CFA_expression:
1952      return dw_cfi_oprnd_loc;
1953
1954    default:
1955      gcc_unreachable ();
1956    }
1957}
1958
1959/* Describe for the GTY machinery what parts of dw_cfi_oprnd2 are used.  */
1960static enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type dw_cfi_oprnd2_desc
1961 (enum dwarf_call_frame_info cfi);
1962
1963static enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type
1964dw_cfi_oprnd2_desc (enum dwarf_call_frame_info cfi)
1965{
1966  switch (cfi)
1967    {
1968    case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
1969    case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
1970    case DW_CFA_offset:
1971    case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
1972    case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
1973      return dw_cfi_oprnd_offset;
1974
1975    case DW_CFA_register:
1976      return dw_cfi_oprnd_reg_num;
1977
1978    default:
1979      return dw_cfi_oprnd_unused;
1980    }
1981}
1982
1983#if defined (DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO) || defined (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO)
1984
1985/* Switch to eh_frame_section.  If we don't have an eh_frame_section,
1986   switch to the data section instead, and write out a synthetic label
1987   for collect2.  */
1988
1989static void
1990switch_to_eh_frame_section (void)
1991{
1992  tree label;
1993
1994#ifdef EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME
1995  if (eh_frame_section == 0)
1996    {
1997      int flags;
1998
1999      if (EH_TABLES_CAN_BE_READ_ONLY)
2000	{
2001	  int fde_encoding;
2002	  int per_encoding;
2003	  int lsda_encoding;
2004
2005	  fde_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/1,
2006						       /*global=*/0);
2007	  per_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/2,
2008						       /*global=*/1);
2009	  lsda_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/0,
2010							/*global=*/0);
2011	  flags = ((! flag_pic
2012		    || ((fde_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_absptr
2013			&& (fde_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_aligned
2014			&& (per_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_absptr
2015			&& (per_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_aligned
2016			&& (lsda_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_absptr
2017			&& (lsda_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_aligned))
2018		   ? 0 : SECTION_WRITE);
2019	}
2020      else
2021	flags = SECTION_WRITE;
2022      eh_frame_section = get_section (EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME, flags, NULL);
2023    }
2024#endif
2025
2026  if (eh_frame_section)
2027    switch_to_section (eh_frame_section);
2028  else
2029    {
2030      /* We have no special eh_frame section.  Put the information in
2031	 the data section and emit special labels to guide collect2.  */
2032      switch_to_section (data_section);
2033      label = get_file_function_name ('F');
2034      ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file, floor_log2 (PTR_SIZE));
2035      targetm.asm_out.globalize_label (asm_out_file,
2036				       IDENTIFIER_POINTER (label));
2037      ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (label));
2038    }
2039}
2040
2041/* Output a Call Frame Information opcode and its operand(s).  */
2042
2043static void
2044output_cfi (dw_cfi_ref cfi, dw_fde_ref fde, int for_eh)
2045{
2046  unsigned long r;
2047  if (cfi->dw_cfi_opc == DW_CFA_advance_loc)
2048    dw2_asm_output_data (1, (cfi->dw_cfi_opc
2049			     | (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset & 0x3f)),
2050			 "DW_CFA_advance_loc " HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_HEX,
2051			 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset);
2052  else if (cfi->dw_cfi_opc == DW_CFA_offset)
2053    {
2054      r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
2055      dw2_asm_output_data (1, (cfi->dw_cfi_opc | (r & 0x3f)),
2056			   "DW_CFA_offset, column 0x%lx", r);
2057      dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset, NULL);
2058    }
2059  else if (cfi->dw_cfi_opc == DW_CFA_restore)
2060    {
2061      r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
2062      dw2_asm_output_data (1, (cfi->dw_cfi_opc | (r & 0x3f)),
2063			   "DW_CFA_restore, column 0x%lx", r);
2064    }
2065  else
2066    {
2067      dw2_asm_output_data (1, cfi->dw_cfi_opc,
2068			   "%s", dwarf_cfi_name (cfi->dw_cfi_opc));
2069
2070      switch (cfi->dw_cfi_opc)
2071	{
2072	case DW_CFA_set_loc:
2073	  if (for_eh)
2074	    dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (
2075		ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/1, /*global=*/0),
2076		gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr),
2077		false, NULL);
2078	  else
2079	    dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
2080				 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr, NULL);
2081	  fde->dw_fde_current_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
2082	  break;
2083
2084	case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
2085	  dw2_asm_output_delta (1, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr,
2086				fde->dw_fde_current_label, NULL);
2087	  fde->dw_fde_current_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
2088	  break;
2089
2090	case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
2091	  dw2_asm_output_delta (2, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr,
2092				fde->dw_fde_current_label, NULL);
2093	  fde->dw_fde_current_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
2094	  break;
2095
2096	case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
2097	  dw2_asm_output_delta (4, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr,
2098				fde->dw_fde_current_label, NULL);
2099	  fde->dw_fde_current_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
2100	  break;
2101
2102	case DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8:
2103	  dw2_asm_output_delta (8, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr,
2104				fde->dw_fde_current_label, NULL);
2105	  fde->dw_fde_current_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
2106	  break;
2107
2108	case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
2109	case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
2110	  r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
2111	  dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
2112	  dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset, NULL);
2113	  break;
2114
2115	case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
2116	case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
2117	  r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
2118	  dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
2119	  dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset, NULL);
2120	  break;
2121
2122	case DW_CFA_restore_extended:
2123	case DW_CFA_undefined:
2124	case DW_CFA_same_value:
2125	case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
2126	  r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
2127	  dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
2128	  break;
2129
2130	case DW_CFA_register:
2131	  r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
2132	  dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
2133	  r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
2134	  dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
2135	  break;
2136
2137	case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
2138	case DW_CFA_GNU_args_size:
2139	  dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset, NULL);
2140	  break;
2141
2142	case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
2143	  dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset, NULL);
2144	  break;
2145
2146	case DW_CFA_GNU_window_save:
2147	  break;
2148
2149	case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
2150	case DW_CFA_expression:
2151	  output_cfa_loc (cfi);
2152	  break;
2153
2154	case DW_CFA_GNU_negative_offset_extended:
2155	  /* Obsoleted by DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf.  */
2156	  gcc_unreachable ();
2157
2158	default:
2159	  break;
2160	}
2161    }
2162}
2163
2164/* Output the call frame information used to record information
2165   that relates to calculating the frame pointer, and records the
2166   location of saved registers.  */
2167
2168static void
2169output_call_frame_info (int for_eh)
2170{
2171  unsigned int i;
2172  dw_fde_ref fde;
2173  dw_cfi_ref cfi;
2174  char l1[20], l2[20], section_start_label[20];
2175  bool any_lsda_needed = false;
2176  char augmentation[6];
2177  int augmentation_size;
2178  int fde_encoding = DW_EH_PE_absptr;
2179  int per_encoding = DW_EH_PE_absptr;
2180  int lsda_encoding = DW_EH_PE_absptr;
2181  int return_reg;
2182
2183  /* Don't emit a CIE if there won't be any FDEs.  */
2184  if (fde_table_in_use == 0)
2185    return;
2186
2187  /* If we make FDEs linkonce, we may have to emit an empty label for
2188     an FDE that wouldn't otherwise be emitted.  We want to avoid
2189     having an FDE kept around when the function it refers to is
2190     discarded.  Example where this matters: a primary function
2191     template in C++ requires EH information, but an explicit
2192     specialization doesn't.  */
2193  if (TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO
2194      && ! flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables
2195      && for_eh)
2196    for (i = 0; i < fde_table_in_use; i++)
2197      if ((fde_table[i].nothrow || fde_table[i].all_throwers_are_sibcalls)
2198          && !fde_table[i].uses_eh_lsda
2199	  && ! DECL_WEAK (fde_table[i].decl))
2200	targetm.asm_out.unwind_label (asm_out_file, fde_table[i].decl,
2201				      for_eh, /* empty */ 1);
2202
2203  /* If we don't have any functions we'll want to unwind out of, don't
2204     emit any EH unwind information.  Note that if exceptions aren't
2205     enabled, we won't have collected nothrow information, and if we
2206     asked for asynchronous tables, we always want this info.  */
2207  if (for_eh)
2208    {
2209      bool any_eh_needed = !flag_exceptions || flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables;
2210
2211      for (i = 0; i < fde_table_in_use; i++)
2212	if (fde_table[i].uses_eh_lsda)
2213	  any_eh_needed = any_lsda_needed = true;
2214        else if (TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO && DECL_WEAK (fde_table[i].decl))
2215	  any_eh_needed = true;
2216	else if (! fde_table[i].nothrow
2217		 && ! fde_table[i].all_throwers_are_sibcalls)
2218	  any_eh_needed = true;
2219
2220      if (! any_eh_needed)
2221	return;
2222    }
2223
2224  /* We're going to be generating comments, so turn on app.  */
2225  if (flag_debug_asm)
2226    app_enable ();
2227
2228  if (for_eh)
2229    switch_to_eh_frame_section ();
2230  else
2231    {
2232      if (!debug_frame_section)
2233	debug_frame_section = get_section (DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION,
2234					   SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
2235      switch_to_section (debug_frame_section);
2236    }
2237
2238  ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (section_start_label, FRAME_BEGIN_LABEL, for_eh);
2239  ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, section_start_label);
2240
2241  /* Output the CIE.  */
2242  ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, CIE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL, for_eh);
2243  ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, CIE_END_LABEL, for_eh);
2244  if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 && !for_eh)
2245    dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
2246      "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
2247  dw2_asm_output_delta (for_eh ? 4 : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
2248			"Length of Common Information Entry");
2249  ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
2250
2251  /* Now that the CIE pointer is PC-relative for EH,
2252     use 0 to identify the CIE.  */
2253  dw2_asm_output_data ((for_eh ? 4 : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE),
2254		       (for_eh ? 0 : DWARF_CIE_ID),
2255		       "CIE Identifier Tag");
2256
2257  dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_CIE_VERSION, "CIE Version");
2258
2259  augmentation[0] = 0;
2260  augmentation_size = 0;
2261  if (for_eh)
2262    {
2263      char *p;
2264
2265      /* Augmentation:
2266	 z	Indicates that a uleb128 is present to size the
2267		augmentation section.
2268	 L	Indicates the encoding (and thus presence) of
2269		an LSDA pointer in the FDE augmentation.
2270	 R	Indicates a non-default pointer encoding for
2271		FDE code pointers.
2272	 P	Indicates the presence of an encoding + language
2273		personality routine in the CIE augmentation.  */
2274
2275      fde_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/1, /*global=*/0);
2276      per_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/2, /*global=*/1);
2277      lsda_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/0, /*global=*/0);
2278
2279      p = augmentation + 1;
2280      if (eh_personality_libfunc)
2281	{
2282	  *p++ = 'P';
2283	  augmentation_size += 1 + size_of_encoded_value (per_encoding);
2284	}
2285      if (any_lsda_needed)
2286	{
2287	  *p++ = 'L';
2288	  augmentation_size += 1;
2289	}
2290      if (fde_encoding != DW_EH_PE_absptr)
2291	{
2292	  *p++ = 'R';
2293	  augmentation_size += 1;
2294	}
2295      if (p > augmentation + 1)
2296	{
2297	  augmentation[0] = 'z';
2298	  *p = '\0';
2299	}
2300
2301      /* Ug.  Some platforms can't do unaligned dynamic relocations at all.  */
2302      if (eh_personality_libfunc && per_encoding == DW_EH_PE_aligned)
2303	{
2304	  int offset = (  4		/* Length */
2305			+ 4		/* CIE Id */
2306			+ 1		/* CIE version */
2307			+ strlen (augmentation) + 1	/* Augmentation */
2308			+ size_of_uleb128 (1)		/* Code alignment */
2309			+ size_of_sleb128 (DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT)
2310			+ 1		/* RA column */
2311			+ 1		/* Augmentation size */
2312			+ 1		/* Personality encoding */ );
2313	  int pad = -offset & (PTR_SIZE - 1);
2314
2315	  augmentation_size += pad;
2316
2317	  /* Augmentations should be small, so there's scarce need to
2318	     iterate for a solution.  Die if we exceed one uleb128 byte.  */
2319	  gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (augmentation_size) == 1);
2320	}
2321    }
2322
2323  dw2_asm_output_nstring (augmentation, -1, "CIE Augmentation");
2324  dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1, "CIE Code Alignment Factor");
2325  dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT,
2326			       "CIE Data Alignment Factor");
2327
2328  return_reg = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN, for_eh);
2329  if (DW_CIE_VERSION == 1)
2330    dw2_asm_output_data (1, return_reg, "CIE RA Column");
2331  else
2332    dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (return_reg, "CIE RA Column");
2333
2334  if (augmentation[0])
2335    {
2336      dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (augmentation_size, "Augmentation size");
2337      if (eh_personality_libfunc)
2338	{
2339	  dw2_asm_output_data (1, per_encoding, "Personality (%s)",
2340			       eh_data_format_name (per_encoding));
2341	  dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (per_encoding,
2342					   eh_personality_libfunc,
2343					   true, NULL);
2344	}
2345
2346      if (any_lsda_needed)
2347	dw2_asm_output_data (1, lsda_encoding, "LSDA Encoding (%s)",
2348			     eh_data_format_name (lsda_encoding));
2349
2350      if (fde_encoding != DW_EH_PE_absptr)
2351	dw2_asm_output_data (1, fde_encoding, "FDE Encoding (%s)",
2352			     eh_data_format_name (fde_encoding));
2353    }
2354
2355  for (cfi = cie_cfi_head; cfi != NULL; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
2356    output_cfi (cfi, NULL, for_eh);
2357
2358  /* Pad the CIE out to an address sized boundary.  */
2359  ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file,
2360		    floor_log2 (for_eh ? PTR_SIZE : DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE));
2361  ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
2362
2363  /* Loop through all of the FDE's.  */
2364  for (i = 0; i < fde_table_in_use; i++)
2365    {
2366      fde = &fde_table[i];
2367
2368      /* Don't emit EH unwind info for leaf functions that don't need it.  */
2369      if (for_eh && !flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables && flag_exceptions
2370	  && (fde->nothrow || fde->all_throwers_are_sibcalls)
2371	  && ! (TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO && DECL_WEAK (fde_table[i].decl))
2372	  && !fde->uses_eh_lsda)
2373	continue;
2374
2375      targetm.asm_out.unwind_label (asm_out_file, fde->decl, for_eh, /* empty */ 0);
2376      targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, FDE_LABEL, for_eh + i * 2);
2377      ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, FDE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL, for_eh + i * 2);
2378      ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, FDE_END_LABEL, for_eh + i * 2);
2379      if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 && !for_eh)
2380	dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
2381			     "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
2382      dw2_asm_output_delta (for_eh ? 4 : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
2383			    "FDE Length");
2384      ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
2385
2386      if (for_eh)
2387	dw2_asm_output_delta (4, l1, section_start_label, "FDE CIE offset");
2388      else
2389	dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, section_start_label,
2390			       debug_frame_section, "FDE CIE offset");
2391
2392      if (for_eh)
2393	{
2394	  rtx sym_ref = gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, fde->dw_fde_begin);
2395	  SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS (sym_ref) |= SYMBOL_FLAG_LOCAL;
2396	  dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (fde_encoding,
2397					   sym_ref,
2398					   false,
2399					   "FDE initial location");
2400	  if (fde->dw_fde_switched_sections)
2401	    {
2402	      rtx sym_ref2 = gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode,
2403				      fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_label);
2404	      rtx sym_ref3= gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode,
2405				      fde->dw_fde_hot_section_label);
2406	      SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS (sym_ref2) |= SYMBOL_FLAG_LOCAL;
2407	      SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS (sym_ref3) |= SYMBOL_FLAG_LOCAL;
2408	      dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (fde_encoding, sym_ref3, false,
2409					       "FDE initial location");
2410	      dw2_asm_output_delta (size_of_encoded_value (fde_encoding),
2411				    fde->dw_fde_hot_section_end_label,
2412				    fde->dw_fde_hot_section_label,
2413				    "FDE address range");
2414	      dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (fde_encoding, sym_ref2, false,
2415					       "FDE initial location");
2416	      dw2_asm_output_delta (size_of_encoded_value (fde_encoding),
2417				    fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_end_label,
2418				    fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_label,
2419				    "FDE address range");
2420	    }
2421	  else
2422	    dw2_asm_output_delta (size_of_encoded_value (fde_encoding),
2423				  fde->dw_fde_end, fde->dw_fde_begin,
2424				  "FDE address range");
2425	}
2426      else
2427	{
2428	  dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, fde->dw_fde_begin,
2429			       "FDE initial location");
2430	  if (fde->dw_fde_switched_sections)
2431	    {
2432	      dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
2433				   fde->dw_fde_hot_section_label,
2434				   "FDE initial location");
2435	      dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
2436				    fde->dw_fde_hot_section_end_label,
2437				    fde->dw_fde_hot_section_label,
2438				    "FDE address range");
2439	      dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
2440				   fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_label,
2441				   "FDE initial location");
2442	      dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
2443				    fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_end_label,
2444				    fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_label,
2445				    "FDE address range");
2446	    }
2447	  else
2448	    dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
2449				  fde->dw_fde_end, fde->dw_fde_begin,
2450				  "FDE address range");
2451	}
2452
2453      if (augmentation[0])
2454	{
2455	  if (any_lsda_needed)
2456	    {
2457	      int size = size_of_encoded_value (lsda_encoding);
2458
2459	      if (lsda_encoding == DW_EH_PE_aligned)
2460		{
2461		  int offset = (  4		/* Length */
2462				+ 4		/* CIE offset */
2463				+ 2 * size_of_encoded_value (fde_encoding)
2464				+ 1		/* Augmentation size */ );
2465		  int pad = -offset & (PTR_SIZE - 1);
2466
2467		  size += pad;
2468		  gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (size) == 1);
2469		}
2470
2471	      dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (size, "Augmentation size");
2472
2473	      if (fde->uses_eh_lsda)
2474		{
2475		  ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, "LLSDA",
2476					       fde->funcdef_number);
2477		  dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (
2478			lsda_encoding, gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, l1),
2479			false, "Language Specific Data Area");
2480		}
2481	      else
2482		{
2483		  if (lsda_encoding == DW_EH_PE_aligned)
2484		    ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file, floor_log2 (PTR_SIZE));
2485		  dw2_asm_output_data
2486		    (size_of_encoded_value (lsda_encoding), 0,
2487		     "Language Specific Data Area (none)");
2488		}
2489	    }
2490	  else
2491	    dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, "Augmentation size");
2492	}
2493
2494      /* Loop through the Call Frame Instructions associated with
2495	 this FDE.  */
2496      fde->dw_fde_current_label = fde->dw_fde_begin;
2497      for (cfi = fde->dw_fde_cfi; cfi != NULL; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
2498	output_cfi (cfi, fde, for_eh);
2499
2500      /* Pad the FDE out to an address sized boundary.  */
2501      ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file,
2502			floor_log2 ((for_eh ? PTR_SIZE : DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)));
2503      ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
2504    }
2505
2506  if (for_eh && targetm.terminate_dw2_eh_frame_info)
2507    dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0, "End of Table");
2508#ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
2509  /* Work around Irix 6 assembler bug whereby labels at the end of a section
2510     get a value of 0.  Putting .align 0 after the label fixes it.  */
2511  ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file, 0);
2512#endif
2513
2514  /* Turn off app to make assembly quicker.  */
2515  if (flag_debug_asm)
2516    app_disable ();
2517}
2518
2519/* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the beginning of a function, before
2520   the prologue.  */
2521
2522void
2523dwarf2out_begin_prologue (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2524			  const char *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
2525{
2526  char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
2527  char * dup_label;
2528  dw_fde_ref fde;
2529
2530  current_function_func_begin_label = NULL;
2531
2532#ifdef TARGET_UNWIND_INFO
2533  /* ??? current_function_func_begin_label is also used by except.c
2534     for call-site information.  We must emit this label if it might
2535     be used.  */
2536  if ((! flag_exceptions || USING_SJLJ_EXCEPTIONS)
2537      && ! dwarf2out_do_frame ())
2538    return;
2539#else
2540  if (! dwarf2out_do_frame ())
2541    return;
2542#endif
2543
2544  switch_to_section (function_section (current_function_decl));
2545  ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL,
2546			       current_function_funcdef_no);
2547  ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL,
2548			  current_function_funcdef_no);
2549  dup_label = xstrdup (label);
2550  current_function_func_begin_label = dup_label;
2551
2552#ifdef TARGET_UNWIND_INFO
2553  /* We can elide the fde allocation if we're not emitting debug info.  */
2554  if (! dwarf2out_do_frame ())
2555    return;
2556#endif
2557
2558  /* Expand the fde table if necessary.  */
2559  if (fde_table_in_use == fde_table_allocated)
2560    {
2561      fde_table_allocated += FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
2562      fde_table = ggc_realloc (fde_table,
2563			       fde_table_allocated * sizeof (dw_fde_node));
2564      memset (fde_table + fde_table_in_use, 0,
2565	      FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT * sizeof (dw_fde_node));
2566    }
2567
2568  /* Record the FDE associated with this function.  */
2569  current_funcdef_fde = fde_table_in_use;
2570
2571  /* Add the new FDE at the end of the fde_table.  */
2572  fde = &fde_table[fde_table_in_use++];
2573  fde->decl = current_function_decl;
2574  fde->dw_fde_begin = dup_label;
2575  fde->dw_fde_current_label = dup_label;
2576  fde->dw_fde_hot_section_label = NULL;
2577  fde->dw_fde_hot_section_end_label = NULL;
2578  fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_label = NULL;
2579  fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_end_label = NULL;
2580  fde->dw_fde_switched_sections = false;
2581  fde->dw_fde_end = NULL;
2582  fde->dw_fde_cfi = NULL;
2583  fde->funcdef_number = current_function_funcdef_no;
2584  fde->nothrow = TREE_NOTHROW (current_function_decl);
2585  fde->uses_eh_lsda = cfun->uses_eh_lsda;
2586  fde->all_throwers_are_sibcalls = cfun->all_throwers_are_sibcalls;
2587
2588  args_size = old_args_size = 0;
2589
2590  /* We only want to output line number information for the genuine dwarf2
2591     prologue case, not the eh frame case.  */
2592#ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
2593  if (file)
2594    dwarf2out_source_line (line, file);
2595#endif
2596}
2597
2598/* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the absolute end of the generated code
2599   for a function definition.  This gets called *after* the epilogue code has
2600   been generated.  */
2601
2602void
2603dwarf2out_end_epilogue (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2604			const char *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
2605{
2606  dw_fde_ref fde;
2607  char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
2608
2609  /* Output a label to mark the endpoint of the code generated for this
2610     function.  */
2611  ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, FUNC_END_LABEL,
2612			       current_function_funcdef_no);
2613  ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, label);
2614  fde = &fde_table[fde_table_in_use - 1];
2615  fde->dw_fde_end = xstrdup (label);
2616}
2617
2618void
2619dwarf2out_frame_init (void)
2620{
2621  /* Allocate the initial hunk of the fde_table.  */
2622  fde_table = ggc_alloc_cleared (FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT * sizeof (dw_fde_node));
2623  fde_table_allocated = FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
2624  fde_table_in_use = 0;
2625
2626  /* Generate the CFA instructions common to all FDE's.  Do it now for the
2627     sake of lookup_cfa.  */
2628
2629  /* On entry, the Canonical Frame Address is at SP.  */
2630  dwarf2out_def_cfa (NULL, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM, INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET);
2631
2632#ifdef DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
2633  if (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO)
2634    initial_return_save (INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX);
2635#endif
2636}
2637
2638void
2639dwarf2out_frame_finish (void)
2640{
2641  /* Output call frame information.  */
2642  if (DWARF2_FRAME_INFO)
2643    output_call_frame_info (0);
2644
2645#ifndef TARGET_UNWIND_INFO
2646  /* Output another copy for the unwinder.  */
2647  if (! USING_SJLJ_EXCEPTIONS && (flag_unwind_tables || flag_exceptions))
2648    output_call_frame_info (1);
2649#endif
2650}
2651#endif
2652
2653/* And now, the subset of the debugging information support code necessary
2654   for emitting location expressions.  */
2655
2656/* Data about a single source file.  */
2657struct dwarf_file_data GTY(())
2658{
2659  const char * filename;
2660  int emitted_number;
2661};
2662
2663/* We need some way to distinguish DW_OP_addr with a direct symbol
2664   relocation from DW_OP_addr with a dtp-relative symbol relocation.  */
2665#define INTERNAL_DW_OP_tls_addr		(0x100 + DW_OP_addr)
2666
2667
2668typedef struct dw_val_struct *dw_val_ref;
2669typedef struct die_struct *dw_die_ref;
2670typedef struct dw_loc_descr_struct *dw_loc_descr_ref;
2671typedef struct dw_loc_list_struct *dw_loc_list_ref;
2672
2673/* Each DIE may have a series of attribute/value pairs.  Values
2674   can take on several forms.  The forms that are used in this
2675   implementation are listed below.  */
2676
2677enum dw_val_class
2678{
2679  dw_val_class_addr,
2680  dw_val_class_offset,
2681  dw_val_class_loc,
2682  dw_val_class_loc_list,
2683  dw_val_class_range_list,
2684  dw_val_class_const,
2685  dw_val_class_unsigned_const,
2686  dw_val_class_long_long,
2687  dw_val_class_vec,
2688  dw_val_class_flag,
2689  dw_val_class_die_ref,
2690  dw_val_class_fde_ref,
2691  dw_val_class_lbl_id,
2692  dw_val_class_lineptr,
2693  dw_val_class_str,
2694  dw_val_class_macptr,
2695  dw_val_class_file
2696};
2697
2698/* Describe a double word constant value.  */
2699/* ??? Every instance of long_long in the code really means CONST_DOUBLE.  */
2700
2701typedef struct dw_long_long_struct GTY(())
2702{
2703  unsigned long hi;
2704  unsigned long low;
2705}
2706dw_long_long_const;
2707
2708/* Describe a floating point constant value, or a vector constant value.  */
2709
2710typedef struct dw_vec_struct GTY(())
2711{
2712  unsigned char * GTY((length ("%h.length"))) array;
2713  unsigned length;
2714  unsigned elt_size;
2715}
2716dw_vec_const;
2717
2718/* The dw_val_node describes an attribute's value, as it is
2719   represented internally.  */
2720
2721typedef struct dw_val_struct GTY(())
2722{
2723  enum dw_val_class val_class;
2724  union dw_val_struct_union
2725    {
2726      rtx GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_addr"))) val_addr;
2727      unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_offset"))) val_offset;
2728      dw_loc_list_ref GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_loc_list"))) val_loc_list;
2729      dw_loc_descr_ref GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_loc"))) val_loc;
2730      HOST_WIDE_INT GTY ((default)) val_int;
2731      unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_unsigned_const"))) val_unsigned;
2732      dw_long_long_const GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_long_long"))) val_long_long;
2733      dw_vec_const GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_vec"))) val_vec;
2734      struct dw_val_die_union
2735	{
2736	  dw_die_ref die;
2737	  int external;
2738	} GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_die_ref"))) val_die_ref;
2739      unsigned GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_fde_ref"))) val_fde_index;
2740      struct indirect_string_node * GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_str"))) val_str;
2741      char * GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_lbl_id"))) val_lbl_id;
2742      unsigned char GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_flag"))) val_flag;
2743      struct dwarf_file_data * GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_file"))) val_file;
2744    }
2745  GTY ((desc ("%1.val_class"))) v;
2746}
2747dw_val_node;
2748
2749/* Locations in memory are described using a sequence of stack machine
2750   operations.  */
2751
2752typedef struct dw_loc_descr_struct GTY(())
2753{
2754  dw_loc_descr_ref dw_loc_next;
2755  enum dwarf_location_atom dw_loc_opc;
2756  dw_val_node dw_loc_oprnd1;
2757  dw_val_node dw_loc_oprnd2;
2758  int dw_loc_addr;
2759}
2760dw_loc_descr_node;
2761
2762/* Location lists are ranges + location descriptions for that range,
2763   so you can track variables that are in different places over
2764   their entire life.  */
2765typedef struct dw_loc_list_struct GTY(())
2766{
2767  dw_loc_list_ref dw_loc_next;
2768  const char *begin; /* Label for begin address of range */
2769  const char *end;  /* Label for end address of range */
2770  char *ll_symbol; /* Label for beginning of location list.
2771		      Only on head of list */
2772  const char *section; /* Section this loclist is relative to */
2773  dw_loc_descr_ref expr;
2774} dw_loc_list_node;
2775
2776#if defined (DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO) || defined (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO)
2777
2778static const char *dwarf_stack_op_name (unsigned);
2779static dw_loc_descr_ref new_loc_descr (enum dwarf_location_atom,
2780				       unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
2781static void add_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref *, dw_loc_descr_ref);
2782static unsigned long size_of_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref);
2783static unsigned long size_of_locs (dw_loc_descr_ref);
2784static void output_loc_operands (dw_loc_descr_ref);
2785static void output_loc_sequence (dw_loc_descr_ref);
2786
2787/* Convert a DWARF stack opcode into its string name.  */
2788
2789static const char *
2790dwarf_stack_op_name (unsigned int op)
2791{
2792  switch (op)
2793    {
2794    case DW_OP_addr:
2795    case INTERNAL_DW_OP_tls_addr:
2796      return "DW_OP_addr";
2797    case DW_OP_deref:
2798      return "DW_OP_deref";
2799    case DW_OP_const1u:
2800      return "DW_OP_const1u";
2801    case DW_OP_const1s:
2802      return "DW_OP_const1s";
2803    case DW_OP_const2u:
2804      return "DW_OP_const2u";
2805    case DW_OP_const2s:
2806      return "DW_OP_const2s";
2807    case DW_OP_const4u:
2808      return "DW_OP_const4u";
2809    case DW_OP_const4s:
2810      return "DW_OP_const4s";
2811    case DW_OP_const8u:
2812      return "DW_OP_const8u";
2813    case DW_OP_const8s:
2814      return "DW_OP_const8s";
2815    case DW_OP_constu:
2816      return "DW_OP_constu";
2817    case DW_OP_consts:
2818      return "DW_OP_consts";
2819    case DW_OP_dup:
2820      return "DW_OP_dup";
2821    case DW_OP_drop:
2822      return "DW_OP_drop";
2823    case DW_OP_over:
2824      return "DW_OP_over";
2825    case DW_OP_pick:
2826      return "DW_OP_pick";
2827    case DW_OP_swap:
2828      return "DW_OP_swap";
2829    case DW_OP_rot:
2830      return "DW_OP_rot";
2831    case DW_OP_xderef:
2832      return "DW_OP_xderef";
2833    case DW_OP_abs:
2834      return "DW_OP_abs";
2835    case DW_OP_and:
2836      return "DW_OP_and";
2837    case DW_OP_div:
2838      return "DW_OP_div";
2839    case DW_OP_minus:
2840      return "DW_OP_minus";
2841    case DW_OP_mod:
2842      return "DW_OP_mod";
2843    case DW_OP_mul:
2844      return "DW_OP_mul";
2845    case DW_OP_neg:
2846      return "DW_OP_neg";
2847    case DW_OP_not:
2848      return "DW_OP_not";
2849    case DW_OP_or:
2850      return "DW_OP_or";
2851    case DW_OP_plus:
2852      return "DW_OP_plus";
2853    case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
2854      return "DW_OP_plus_uconst";
2855    case DW_OP_shl:
2856      return "DW_OP_shl";
2857    case DW_OP_shr:
2858      return "DW_OP_shr";
2859    case DW_OP_shra:
2860      return "DW_OP_shra";
2861    case DW_OP_xor:
2862      return "DW_OP_xor";
2863    case DW_OP_bra:
2864      return "DW_OP_bra";
2865    case DW_OP_eq:
2866      return "DW_OP_eq";
2867    case DW_OP_ge:
2868      return "DW_OP_ge";
2869    case DW_OP_gt:
2870      return "DW_OP_gt";
2871    case DW_OP_le:
2872      return "DW_OP_le";
2873    case DW_OP_lt:
2874      return "DW_OP_lt";
2875    case DW_OP_ne:
2876      return "DW_OP_ne";
2877    case DW_OP_skip:
2878      return "DW_OP_skip";
2879    case DW_OP_lit0:
2880      return "DW_OP_lit0";
2881    case DW_OP_lit1:
2882      return "DW_OP_lit1";
2883    case DW_OP_lit2:
2884      return "DW_OP_lit2";
2885    case DW_OP_lit3:
2886      return "DW_OP_lit3";
2887    case DW_OP_lit4:
2888      return "DW_OP_lit4";
2889    case DW_OP_lit5:
2890      return "DW_OP_lit5";
2891    case DW_OP_lit6:
2892      return "DW_OP_lit6";
2893    case DW_OP_lit7:
2894      return "DW_OP_lit7";
2895    case DW_OP_lit8:
2896      return "DW_OP_lit8";
2897    case DW_OP_lit9:
2898      return "DW_OP_lit9";
2899    case DW_OP_lit10:
2900      return "DW_OP_lit10";
2901    case DW_OP_lit11:
2902      return "DW_OP_lit11";
2903    case DW_OP_lit12:
2904      return "DW_OP_lit12";
2905    case DW_OP_lit13:
2906      return "DW_OP_lit13";
2907    case DW_OP_lit14:
2908      return "DW_OP_lit14";
2909    case DW_OP_lit15:
2910      return "DW_OP_lit15";
2911    case DW_OP_lit16:
2912      return "DW_OP_lit16";
2913    case DW_OP_lit17:
2914      return "DW_OP_lit17";
2915    case DW_OP_lit18:
2916      return "DW_OP_lit18";
2917    case DW_OP_lit19:
2918      return "DW_OP_lit19";
2919    case DW_OP_lit20:
2920      return "DW_OP_lit20";
2921    case DW_OP_lit21:
2922      return "DW_OP_lit21";
2923    case DW_OP_lit22:
2924      return "DW_OP_lit22";
2925    case DW_OP_lit23:
2926      return "DW_OP_lit23";
2927    case DW_OP_lit24:
2928      return "DW_OP_lit24";
2929    case DW_OP_lit25:
2930      return "DW_OP_lit25";
2931    case DW_OP_lit26:
2932      return "DW_OP_lit26";
2933    case DW_OP_lit27:
2934      return "DW_OP_lit27";
2935    case DW_OP_lit28:
2936      return "DW_OP_lit28";
2937    case DW_OP_lit29:
2938      return "DW_OP_lit29";
2939    case DW_OP_lit30:
2940      return "DW_OP_lit30";
2941    case DW_OP_lit31:
2942      return "DW_OP_lit31";
2943    case DW_OP_reg0:
2944      return "DW_OP_reg0";
2945    case DW_OP_reg1:
2946      return "DW_OP_reg1";
2947    case DW_OP_reg2:
2948      return "DW_OP_reg2";
2949    case DW_OP_reg3:
2950      return "DW_OP_reg3";
2951    case DW_OP_reg4:
2952      return "DW_OP_reg4";
2953    case DW_OP_reg5:
2954      return "DW_OP_reg5";
2955    case DW_OP_reg6:
2956      return "DW_OP_reg6";
2957    case DW_OP_reg7:
2958      return "DW_OP_reg7";
2959    case DW_OP_reg8:
2960      return "DW_OP_reg8";
2961    case DW_OP_reg9:
2962      return "DW_OP_reg9";
2963    case DW_OP_reg10:
2964      return "DW_OP_reg10";
2965    case DW_OP_reg11:
2966      return "DW_OP_reg11";
2967    case DW_OP_reg12:
2968      return "DW_OP_reg12";
2969    case DW_OP_reg13:
2970      return "DW_OP_reg13";
2971    case DW_OP_reg14:
2972      return "DW_OP_reg14";
2973    case DW_OP_reg15:
2974      return "DW_OP_reg15";
2975    case DW_OP_reg16:
2976      return "DW_OP_reg16";
2977    case DW_OP_reg17:
2978      return "DW_OP_reg17";
2979    case DW_OP_reg18:
2980      return "DW_OP_reg18";
2981    case DW_OP_reg19:
2982      return "DW_OP_reg19";
2983    case DW_OP_reg20:
2984      return "DW_OP_reg20";
2985    case DW_OP_reg21:
2986      return "DW_OP_reg21";
2987    case DW_OP_reg22:
2988      return "DW_OP_reg22";
2989    case DW_OP_reg23:
2990      return "DW_OP_reg23";
2991    case DW_OP_reg24:
2992      return "DW_OP_reg24";
2993    case DW_OP_reg25:
2994      return "DW_OP_reg25";
2995    case DW_OP_reg26:
2996      return "DW_OP_reg26";
2997    case DW_OP_reg27:
2998      return "DW_OP_reg27";
2999    case DW_OP_reg28:
3000      return "DW_OP_reg28";
3001    case DW_OP_reg29:
3002      return "DW_OP_reg29";
3003    case DW_OP_reg30:
3004      return "DW_OP_reg30";
3005    case DW_OP_reg31:
3006      return "DW_OP_reg31";
3007    case DW_OP_breg0:
3008      return "DW_OP_breg0";
3009    case DW_OP_breg1:
3010      return "DW_OP_breg1";
3011    case DW_OP_breg2:
3012      return "DW_OP_breg2";
3013    case DW_OP_breg3:
3014      return "DW_OP_breg3";
3015    case DW_OP_breg4:
3016      return "DW_OP_breg4";
3017    case DW_OP_breg5:
3018      return "DW_OP_breg5";
3019    case DW_OP_breg6:
3020      return "DW_OP_breg6";
3021    case DW_OP_breg7:
3022      return "DW_OP_breg7";
3023    case DW_OP_breg8:
3024      return "DW_OP_breg8";
3025    case DW_OP_breg9:
3026      return "DW_OP_breg9";
3027    case DW_OP_breg10:
3028      return "DW_OP_breg10";
3029    case DW_OP_breg11:
3030      return "DW_OP_breg11";
3031    case DW_OP_breg12:
3032      return "DW_OP_breg12";
3033    case DW_OP_breg13:
3034      return "DW_OP_breg13";
3035    case DW_OP_breg14:
3036      return "DW_OP_breg14";
3037    case DW_OP_breg15:
3038      return "DW_OP_breg15";
3039    case DW_OP_breg16:
3040      return "DW_OP_breg16";
3041    case DW_OP_breg17:
3042      return "DW_OP_breg17";
3043    case DW_OP_breg18:
3044      return "DW_OP_breg18";
3045    case DW_OP_breg19:
3046      return "DW_OP_breg19";
3047    case DW_OP_breg20:
3048      return "DW_OP_breg20";
3049    case DW_OP_breg21:
3050      return "DW_OP_breg21";
3051    case DW_OP_breg22:
3052      return "DW_OP_breg22";
3053    case DW_OP_breg23:
3054      return "DW_OP_breg23";
3055    case DW_OP_breg24:
3056      return "DW_OP_breg24";
3057    case DW_OP_breg25:
3058      return "DW_OP_breg25";
3059    case DW_OP_breg26:
3060      return "DW_OP_breg26";
3061    case DW_OP_breg27:
3062      return "DW_OP_breg27";
3063    case DW_OP_breg28:
3064      return "DW_OP_breg28";
3065    case DW_OP_breg29:
3066      return "DW_OP_breg29";
3067    case DW_OP_breg30:
3068      return "DW_OP_breg30";
3069    case DW_OP_breg31:
3070      return "DW_OP_breg31";
3071    case DW_OP_regx:
3072      return "DW_OP_regx";
3073    case DW_OP_fbreg:
3074      return "DW_OP_fbreg";
3075    case DW_OP_bregx:
3076      return "DW_OP_bregx";
3077    case DW_OP_piece:
3078      return "DW_OP_piece";
3079    case DW_OP_deref_size:
3080      return "DW_OP_deref_size";
3081    case DW_OP_xderef_size:
3082      return "DW_OP_xderef_size";
3083    case DW_OP_nop:
3084      return "DW_OP_nop";
3085    case DW_OP_push_object_address:
3086      return "DW_OP_push_object_address";
3087    case DW_OP_call2:
3088      return "DW_OP_call2";
3089    case DW_OP_call4:
3090      return "DW_OP_call4";
3091    case DW_OP_call_ref:
3092      return "DW_OP_call_ref";
3093    case DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address:
3094      return "DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address";
3095    default:
3096      return "OP_<unknown>";
3097    }
3098}
3099
3100/* Return a pointer to a newly allocated location description.  Location
3101   descriptions are simple expression terms that can be strung
3102   together to form more complicated location (address) descriptions.  */
3103
3104static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
3105new_loc_descr (enum dwarf_location_atom op, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT oprnd1,
3106	       unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT oprnd2)
3107{
3108  dw_loc_descr_ref descr = ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (dw_loc_descr_node));
3109
3110  descr->dw_loc_opc = op;
3111  descr->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_unsigned_const;
3112  descr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned = oprnd1;
3113  descr->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_unsigned_const;
3114  descr->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_unsigned = oprnd2;
3115
3116  return descr;
3117}
3118
3119/* Add a location description term to a location description expression.  */
3120
3121static inline void
3122add_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref *list_head, dw_loc_descr_ref descr)
3123{
3124  dw_loc_descr_ref *d;
3125
3126  /* Find the end of the chain.  */
3127  for (d = list_head; (*d) != NULL; d = &(*d)->dw_loc_next)
3128    ;
3129
3130  *d = descr;
3131}
3132
3133/* Return the size of a location descriptor.  */
3134
3135static unsigned long
3136size_of_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
3137{
3138  unsigned long size = 1;
3139
3140  switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
3141    {
3142    case DW_OP_addr:
3143    case INTERNAL_DW_OP_tls_addr:
3144      size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
3145      break;
3146    case DW_OP_const1u:
3147    case DW_OP_const1s:
3148      size += 1;
3149      break;
3150    case DW_OP_const2u:
3151    case DW_OP_const2s:
3152      size += 2;
3153      break;
3154    case DW_OP_const4u:
3155    case DW_OP_const4s:
3156      size += 4;
3157      break;
3158    case DW_OP_const8u:
3159    case DW_OP_const8s:
3160      size += 8;
3161      break;
3162    case DW_OP_constu:
3163      size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
3164      break;
3165    case DW_OP_consts:
3166      size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int);
3167      break;
3168    case DW_OP_pick:
3169      size += 1;
3170      break;
3171    case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
3172      size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
3173      break;
3174    case DW_OP_skip:
3175    case DW_OP_bra:
3176      size += 2;
3177      break;
3178    case DW_OP_breg0:
3179    case DW_OP_breg1:
3180    case DW_OP_breg2:
3181    case DW_OP_breg3:
3182    case DW_OP_breg4:
3183    case DW_OP_breg5:
3184    case DW_OP_breg6:
3185    case DW_OP_breg7:
3186    case DW_OP_breg8:
3187    case DW_OP_breg9:
3188    case DW_OP_breg10:
3189    case DW_OP_breg11:
3190    case DW_OP_breg12:
3191    case DW_OP_breg13:
3192    case DW_OP_breg14:
3193    case DW_OP_breg15:
3194    case DW_OP_breg16:
3195    case DW_OP_breg17:
3196    case DW_OP_breg18:
3197    case DW_OP_breg19:
3198    case DW_OP_breg20:
3199    case DW_OP_breg21:
3200    case DW_OP_breg22:
3201    case DW_OP_breg23:
3202    case DW_OP_breg24:
3203    case DW_OP_breg25:
3204    case DW_OP_breg26:
3205    case DW_OP_breg27:
3206    case DW_OP_breg28:
3207    case DW_OP_breg29:
3208    case DW_OP_breg30:
3209    case DW_OP_breg31:
3210      size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int);
3211      break;
3212    case DW_OP_regx:
3213      size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
3214      break;
3215    case DW_OP_fbreg:
3216      size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int);
3217      break;
3218    case DW_OP_bregx:
3219      size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
3220      size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int);
3221      break;
3222    case DW_OP_piece:
3223      size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
3224      break;
3225    case DW_OP_deref_size:
3226    case DW_OP_xderef_size:
3227      size += 1;
3228      break;
3229    case DW_OP_call2:
3230      size += 2;
3231      break;
3232    case DW_OP_call4:
3233      size += 4;
3234      break;
3235    case DW_OP_call_ref:
3236      size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
3237      break;
3238    default:
3239      break;
3240    }
3241
3242  return size;
3243}
3244
3245/* Return the size of a series of location descriptors.  */
3246
3247static unsigned long
3248size_of_locs (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
3249{
3250  dw_loc_descr_ref l;
3251  unsigned long size;
3252
3253  /* If there are no skip or bra opcodes, don't fill in the dw_loc_addr
3254     field, to avoid writing to a PCH file.  */
3255  for (size = 0, l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->dw_loc_next)
3256    {
3257      if (l->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_skip || l->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_bra)
3258	break;
3259      size += size_of_loc_descr (l);
3260    }
3261  if (! l)
3262    return size;
3263
3264  for (size = 0, l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->dw_loc_next)
3265    {
3266      l->dw_loc_addr = size;
3267      size += size_of_loc_descr (l);
3268    }
3269
3270  return size;
3271}
3272
3273/* Output location description stack opcode's operands (if any).  */
3274
3275static void
3276output_loc_operands (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
3277{
3278  dw_val_ref val1 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd1;
3279  dw_val_ref val2 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd2;
3280
3281  switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
3282    {
3283#ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
3284    case DW_OP_addr:
3285      dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, val1->v.val_addr, NULL);
3286      break;
3287    case DW_OP_const2u:
3288    case DW_OP_const2s:
3289      dw2_asm_output_data (2, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
3290      break;
3291    case DW_OP_const4u:
3292    case DW_OP_const4s:
3293      dw2_asm_output_data (4, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
3294      break;
3295    case DW_OP_const8u:
3296    case DW_OP_const8s:
3297      gcc_assert (HOST_BITS_PER_LONG >= 64);
3298      dw2_asm_output_data (8, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
3299      break;
3300    case DW_OP_skip:
3301    case DW_OP_bra:
3302      {
3303	int offset;
3304
3305	gcc_assert (val1->val_class == dw_val_class_loc);
3306	offset = val1->v.val_loc->dw_loc_addr - (loc->dw_loc_addr + 3);
3307
3308	dw2_asm_output_data (2, offset, NULL);
3309      }
3310      break;
3311#else
3312    case DW_OP_addr:
3313    case DW_OP_const2u:
3314    case DW_OP_const2s:
3315    case DW_OP_const4u:
3316    case DW_OP_const4s:
3317    case DW_OP_const8u:
3318    case DW_OP_const8s:
3319    case DW_OP_skip:
3320    case DW_OP_bra:
3321      /* We currently don't make any attempt to make sure these are
3322	 aligned properly like we do for the main unwind info, so
3323	 don't support emitting things larger than a byte if we're
3324	 only doing unwinding.  */
3325      gcc_unreachable ();
3326#endif
3327    case DW_OP_const1u:
3328    case DW_OP_const1s:
3329      dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
3330      break;
3331    case DW_OP_constu:
3332      dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
3333      break;
3334    case DW_OP_consts:
3335      dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val1->v.val_int, NULL);
3336      break;
3337    case DW_OP_pick:
3338      dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
3339      break;
3340    case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
3341      dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
3342      break;
3343    case DW_OP_breg0:
3344    case DW_OP_breg1:
3345    case DW_OP_breg2:
3346    case DW_OP_breg3:
3347    case DW_OP_breg4:
3348    case DW_OP_breg5:
3349    case DW_OP_breg6:
3350    case DW_OP_breg7:
3351    case DW_OP_breg8:
3352    case DW_OP_breg9:
3353    case DW_OP_breg10:
3354    case DW_OP_breg11:
3355    case DW_OP_breg12:
3356    case DW_OP_breg13:
3357    case DW_OP_breg14:
3358    case DW_OP_breg15:
3359    case DW_OP_breg16:
3360    case DW_OP_breg17:
3361    case DW_OP_breg18:
3362    case DW_OP_breg19:
3363    case DW_OP_breg20:
3364    case DW_OP_breg21:
3365    case DW_OP_breg22:
3366    case DW_OP_breg23:
3367    case DW_OP_breg24:
3368    case DW_OP_breg25:
3369    case DW_OP_breg26:
3370    case DW_OP_breg27:
3371    case DW_OP_breg28:
3372    case DW_OP_breg29:
3373    case DW_OP_breg30:
3374    case DW_OP_breg31:
3375      dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val1->v.val_int, NULL);
3376      break;
3377    case DW_OP_regx:
3378      dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
3379      break;
3380    case DW_OP_fbreg:
3381      dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val1->v.val_int, NULL);
3382      break;
3383    case DW_OP_bregx:
3384      dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
3385      dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val2->v.val_int, NULL);
3386      break;
3387    case DW_OP_piece:
3388      dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
3389      break;
3390    case DW_OP_deref_size:
3391    case DW_OP_xderef_size:
3392      dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
3393      break;
3394
3395    case INTERNAL_DW_OP_tls_addr:
3396      if (targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel)
3397	{
3398	  targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel (asm_out_file,
3399					       DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
3400					       val1->v.val_addr);
3401	  fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
3402	}
3403      else
3404	gcc_unreachable ();
3405      break;
3406
3407    default:
3408      /* Other codes have no operands.  */
3409      break;
3410    }
3411}
3412
3413/* Output a sequence of location operations.  */
3414
3415static void
3416output_loc_sequence (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
3417{
3418  for (; loc != NULL; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
3419    {
3420      /* Output the opcode.  */
3421      dw2_asm_output_data (1, loc->dw_loc_opc,
3422			   "%s", dwarf_stack_op_name (loc->dw_loc_opc));
3423
3424      /* Output the operand(s) (if any).  */
3425      output_loc_operands (loc);
3426    }
3427}
3428
3429/* This routine will generate the correct assembly data for a location
3430   description based on a cfi entry with a complex address.  */
3431
3432static void
3433output_cfa_loc (dw_cfi_ref cfi)
3434{
3435  dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
3436  unsigned long size;
3437
3438  /* Output the size of the block.  */
3439  loc = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_loc;
3440  size = size_of_locs (loc);
3441  dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (size, NULL);
3442
3443  /* Now output the operations themselves.  */
3444  output_loc_sequence (loc);
3445}
3446
3447/* This function builds a dwarf location descriptor sequence from a
3448   dw_cfa_location, adding the given OFFSET to the result of the
3449   expression.  */
3450
3451static struct dw_loc_descr_struct *
3452build_cfa_loc (dw_cfa_location *cfa, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
3453{
3454  struct dw_loc_descr_struct *head, *tmp;
3455
3456  offset += cfa->offset;
3457
3458  if (cfa->indirect)
3459    {
3460      if (cfa->base_offset)
3461	{
3462	  if (cfa->reg <= 31)
3463	    head = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_breg0 + cfa->reg, cfa->base_offset, 0);
3464	  else
3465	    head = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bregx, cfa->reg, cfa->base_offset);
3466	}
3467      else if (cfa->reg <= 31)
3468	head = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_reg0 + cfa->reg, 0, 0);
3469      else
3470	head = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_regx, cfa->reg, 0);
3471
3472      head->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_const;
3473      tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
3474      add_loc_descr (&head, tmp);
3475      if (offset != 0)
3476	{
3477	  tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, offset, 0);
3478	  add_loc_descr (&head, tmp);
3479	}
3480    }
3481  else
3482    {
3483      if (offset == 0)
3484	if (cfa->reg <= 31)
3485	  head = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_reg0 + cfa->reg, 0, 0);
3486	else
3487	  head = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_regx, cfa->reg, 0);
3488      else if (cfa->reg <= 31)
3489	head = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_breg0 + cfa->reg, offset, 0);
3490      else
3491	head = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bregx, cfa->reg, offset);
3492    }
3493
3494  return head;
3495}
3496
3497/* This function fills in aa dw_cfa_location structure from a dwarf location
3498   descriptor sequence.  */
3499
3500static void
3501get_cfa_from_loc_descr (dw_cfa_location *cfa, struct dw_loc_descr_struct *loc)
3502{
3503  struct dw_loc_descr_struct *ptr;
3504  cfa->offset = 0;
3505  cfa->base_offset = 0;
3506  cfa->indirect = 0;
3507  cfa->reg = -1;
3508
3509  for (ptr = loc; ptr != NULL; ptr = ptr->dw_loc_next)
3510    {
3511      enum dwarf_location_atom op = ptr->dw_loc_opc;
3512
3513      switch (op)
3514	{
3515	case DW_OP_reg0:
3516	case DW_OP_reg1:
3517	case DW_OP_reg2:
3518	case DW_OP_reg3:
3519	case DW_OP_reg4:
3520	case DW_OP_reg5:
3521	case DW_OP_reg6:
3522	case DW_OP_reg7:
3523	case DW_OP_reg8:
3524	case DW_OP_reg9:
3525	case DW_OP_reg10:
3526	case DW_OP_reg11:
3527	case DW_OP_reg12:
3528	case DW_OP_reg13:
3529	case DW_OP_reg14:
3530	case DW_OP_reg15:
3531	case DW_OP_reg16:
3532	case DW_OP_reg17:
3533	case DW_OP_reg18:
3534	case DW_OP_reg19:
3535	case DW_OP_reg20:
3536	case DW_OP_reg21:
3537	case DW_OP_reg22:
3538	case DW_OP_reg23:
3539	case DW_OP_reg24:
3540	case DW_OP_reg25:
3541	case DW_OP_reg26:
3542	case DW_OP_reg27:
3543	case DW_OP_reg28:
3544	case DW_OP_reg29:
3545	case DW_OP_reg30:
3546	case DW_OP_reg31:
3547	  cfa->reg = op - DW_OP_reg0;
3548	  break;
3549	case DW_OP_regx:
3550	  cfa->reg = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int;
3551	  break;
3552	case DW_OP_breg0:
3553	case DW_OP_breg1:
3554	case DW_OP_breg2:
3555	case DW_OP_breg3:
3556	case DW_OP_breg4:
3557	case DW_OP_breg5:
3558	case DW_OP_breg6:
3559	case DW_OP_breg7:
3560	case DW_OP_breg8:
3561	case DW_OP_breg9:
3562	case DW_OP_breg10:
3563	case DW_OP_breg11:
3564	case DW_OP_breg12:
3565	case DW_OP_breg13:
3566	case DW_OP_breg14:
3567	case DW_OP_breg15:
3568	case DW_OP_breg16:
3569	case DW_OP_breg17:
3570	case DW_OP_breg18:
3571	case DW_OP_breg19:
3572	case DW_OP_breg20:
3573	case DW_OP_breg21:
3574	case DW_OP_breg22:
3575	case DW_OP_breg23:
3576	case DW_OP_breg24:
3577	case DW_OP_breg25:
3578	case DW_OP_breg26:
3579	case DW_OP_breg27:
3580	case DW_OP_breg28:
3581	case DW_OP_breg29:
3582	case DW_OP_breg30:
3583	case DW_OP_breg31:
3584	  cfa->reg = op - DW_OP_breg0;
3585	  cfa->base_offset = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int;
3586	  break;
3587	case DW_OP_bregx:
3588	  cfa->reg = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int;
3589	  cfa->base_offset = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int;
3590	  break;
3591	case DW_OP_deref:
3592	  cfa->indirect = 1;
3593	  break;
3594	case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
3595	  cfa->offset = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned;
3596	  break;
3597	default:
3598	  internal_error ("DW_LOC_OP %s not implemented",
3599			  dwarf_stack_op_name (ptr->dw_loc_opc));
3600	}
3601    }
3602}
3603#endif /* .debug_frame support */
3604
3605/* And now, the support for symbolic debugging information.  */
3606#ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
3607
3608/* .debug_str support.  */
3609static int output_indirect_string (void **, void *);
3610
3611static void dwarf2out_init (const char *);
3612static void dwarf2out_finish (const char *);
3613static void dwarf2out_define (unsigned int, const char *);
3614static void dwarf2out_undef (unsigned int, const char *);
3615static void dwarf2out_start_source_file (unsigned, const char *);
3616static void dwarf2out_end_source_file (unsigned);
3617static void dwarf2out_begin_block (unsigned, unsigned);
3618static void dwarf2out_end_block (unsigned, unsigned);
3619static bool dwarf2out_ignore_block (tree);
3620static void dwarf2out_global_decl (tree);
3621static void dwarf2out_type_decl (tree, int);
3622static void dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl (tree, tree);
3623static void dwarf2out_abstract_function (tree);
3624static void dwarf2out_var_location (rtx);
3625static void dwarf2out_begin_function (tree);
3626static void dwarf2out_switch_text_section (void);
3627
3628/* The debug hooks structure.  */
3629
3630const struct gcc_debug_hooks dwarf2_debug_hooks =
3631{
3632  dwarf2out_init,
3633  dwarf2out_finish,
3634  dwarf2out_define,
3635  dwarf2out_undef,
3636  dwarf2out_start_source_file,
3637  dwarf2out_end_source_file,
3638  dwarf2out_begin_block,
3639  dwarf2out_end_block,
3640  dwarf2out_ignore_block,
3641  dwarf2out_source_line,
3642  dwarf2out_begin_prologue,
3643  debug_nothing_int_charstar,	/* end_prologue */
3644  dwarf2out_end_epilogue,
3645  dwarf2out_begin_function,
3646  debug_nothing_int,		/* end_function */
3647  dwarf2out_decl,		/* function_decl */
3648  dwarf2out_global_decl,
3649  dwarf2out_type_decl,		/* type_decl */
3650  dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl,
3651  debug_nothing_tree,		/* deferred_inline_function */
3652  /* The DWARF 2 backend tries to reduce debugging bloat by not
3653     emitting the abstract description of inline functions until
3654     something tries to reference them.  */
3655  dwarf2out_abstract_function,	/* outlining_inline_function */
3656  debug_nothing_rtx,		/* label */
3657  debug_nothing_int,		/* handle_pch */
3658  dwarf2out_var_location,
3659  dwarf2out_switch_text_section,
3660  1                             /* start_end_main_source_file */
3661};
3662#endif
3663
3664/* NOTE: In the comments in this file, many references are made to
3665   "Debugging Information Entries".  This term is abbreviated as `DIE'
3666   throughout the remainder of this file.  */
3667
3668/* An internal representation of the DWARF output is built, and then
3669   walked to generate the DWARF debugging info.  The walk of the internal
3670   representation is done after the entire program has been compiled.
3671   The types below are used to describe the internal representation.  */
3672
3673/* Various DIE's use offsets relative to the beginning of the
3674   .debug_info section to refer to each other.  */
3675
3676typedef long int dw_offset;
3677
3678/* Define typedefs here to avoid circular dependencies.  */
3679
3680typedef struct dw_attr_struct *dw_attr_ref;
3681typedef struct dw_line_info_struct *dw_line_info_ref;
3682typedef struct dw_separate_line_info_struct *dw_separate_line_info_ref;
3683typedef struct pubname_struct *pubname_ref;
3684typedef struct dw_ranges_struct *dw_ranges_ref;
3685
3686/* Each entry in the line_info_table maintains the file and
3687   line number associated with the label generated for that
3688   entry.  The label gives the PC value associated with
3689   the line number entry.  */
3690
3691typedef struct dw_line_info_struct GTY(())
3692{
3693  unsigned long dw_file_num;
3694  unsigned long dw_line_num;
3695}
3696dw_line_info_entry;
3697
3698/* Line information for functions in separate sections; each one gets its
3699   own sequence.  */
3700typedef struct dw_separate_line_info_struct GTY(())
3701{
3702  unsigned long dw_file_num;
3703  unsigned long dw_line_num;
3704  unsigned long function;
3705}
3706dw_separate_line_info_entry;
3707
3708/* Each DIE attribute has a field specifying the attribute kind,
3709   a link to the next attribute in the chain, and an attribute value.
3710   Attributes are typically linked below the DIE they modify.  */
3711
3712typedef struct dw_attr_struct GTY(())
3713{
3714  enum dwarf_attribute dw_attr;
3715  dw_val_node dw_attr_val;
3716}
3717dw_attr_node;
3718
3719DEF_VEC_O(dw_attr_node);
3720DEF_VEC_ALLOC_O(dw_attr_node,gc);
3721
3722/* The Debugging Information Entry (DIE) structure.  DIEs form a tree.
3723   The children of each node form a circular list linked by
3724   die_sib.  die_child points to the node *before* the "first" child node.  */
3725
3726typedef struct die_struct GTY(())
3727{
3728  enum dwarf_tag die_tag;
3729  char *die_symbol;
3730  VEC(dw_attr_node,gc) * die_attr;
3731  dw_die_ref die_parent;
3732  dw_die_ref die_child;
3733  dw_die_ref die_sib;
3734  dw_die_ref die_definition; /* ref from a specification to its definition */
3735  dw_offset die_offset;
3736  unsigned long die_abbrev;
3737  int die_mark;
3738  /* Die is used and must not be pruned as unused.  */
3739  int die_perennial_p;
3740  unsigned int decl_id;
3741}
3742die_node;
3743
3744/* Evaluate 'expr' while 'c' is set to each child of DIE in order.  */
3745#define FOR_EACH_CHILD(die, c, expr) do {	\
3746  c = die->die_child;				\
3747  if (c) do {					\
3748    c = c->die_sib;				\
3749    expr;					\
3750  } while (c != die->die_child);		\
3751} while (0)
3752
3753/* The pubname structure */
3754
3755typedef struct pubname_struct GTY(())
3756{
3757  dw_die_ref die;
3758  char *name;
3759}
3760pubname_entry;
3761
3762struct dw_ranges_struct GTY(())
3763{
3764  int block_num;
3765};
3766
3767/* The limbo die list structure.  */
3768typedef struct limbo_die_struct GTY(())
3769{
3770  dw_die_ref die;
3771  tree created_for;
3772  struct limbo_die_struct *next;
3773}
3774limbo_die_node;
3775
3776/* How to start an assembler comment.  */
3777#ifndef ASM_COMMENT_START
3778#define ASM_COMMENT_START ";#"
3779#endif
3780
3781/* Define a macro which returns nonzero for a TYPE_DECL which was
3782   implicitly generated for a tagged type.
3783
3784   Note that unlike the gcc front end (which generates a NULL named
3785   TYPE_DECL node for each complete tagged type, each array type, and
3786   each function type node created) the g++ front end generates a
3787   _named_ TYPE_DECL node for each tagged type node created.
3788   These TYPE_DECLs have DECL_ARTIFICIAL set, so we know not to
3789   generate a DW_TAG_typedef DIE for them.  */
3790
3791#define TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB(decl)				\
3792  (DECL_NAME (decl) == NULL_TREE			\
3793   || (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl)				\
3794       && is_tagged_type (TREE_TYPE (decl))		\
3795       && ((decl == TYPE_STUB_DECL (TREE_TYPE (decl)))	\
3796	   /* This is necessary for stub decls that	\
3797	      appear in nested inline functions.  */	\
3798	   || (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) != NULL_TREE	\
3799	       && (decl_ultimate_origin (decl)		\
3800		   == TYPE_STUB_DECL (TREE_TYPE (decl)))))))
3801
3802/* Information concerning the compilation unit's programming
3803   language, and compiler version.  */
3804
3805/* Fixed size portion of the DWARF compilation unit header.  */
3806#define DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE \
3807  (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 3)
3808
3809/* Fixed size portion of public names info.  */
3810#define DWARF_PUBNAMES_HEADER_SIZE (2 * DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 2)
3811
3812/* Fixed size portion of the address range info.  */
3813#define DWARF_ARANGES_HEADER_SIZE					\
3814  (DWARF_ROUND (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 4,	\
3815                DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * 2)					\
3816   - DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE)
3817
3818/* Size of padding portion in the address range info.  It must be
3819   aligned to twice the pointer size.  */
3820#define DWARF_ARANGES_PAD_SIZE \
3821  (DWARF_ROUND (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 4, \
3822                DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * 2) \
3823   - (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 4))
3824
3825/* Use assembler line directives if available.  */
3826#ifndef DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
3827#ifdef HAVE_AS_DWARF2_DEBUG_LINE
3828#define DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO 1
3829#else
3830#define DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO 0
3831#endif
3832#endif
3833
3834/* Minimum line offset in a special line info. opcode.
3835   This value was chosen to give a reasonable range of values.  */
3836#define DWARF_LINE_BASE  -10
3837
3838/* First special line opcode - leave room for the standard opcodes.  */
3839#define DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE  10
3840
3841/* Range of line offsets in a special line info. opcode.  */
3842#define DWARF_LINE_RANGE  (254-DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE+1)
3843
3844/* Flag that indicates the initial value of the is_stmt_start flag.
3845   In the present implementation, we do not mark any lines as
3846   the beginning of a source statement, because that information
3847   is not made available by the GCC front-end.  */
3848#define	DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_IS_STMT_START 1
3849
3850#ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
3851/* This location is used by calc_die_sizes() to keep track
3852   the offset of each DIE within the .debug_info section.  */
3853static unsigned long next_die_offset;
3854#endif
3855
3856/* Record the root of the DIE's built for the current compilation unit.  */
3857static GTY(()) dw_die_ref comp_unit_die;
3858
3859/* A list of DIEs with a NULL parent waiting to be relocated.  */
3860static GTY(()) limbo_die_node *limbo_die_list;
3861
3862/* Filenames referenced by this compilation unit.  */
3863static GTY((param_is (struct dwarf_file_data))) htab_t file_table;
3864
3865/* A hash table of references to DIE's that describe declarations.
3866   The key is a DECL_UID() which is a unique number identifying each decl.  */
3867static GTY ((param_is (struct die_struct))) htab_t decl_die_table;
3868
3869/* Node of the variable location list.  */
3870struct var_loc_node GTY ((chain_next ("%h.next")))
3871{
3872  rtx GTY (()) var_loc_note;
3873  const char * GTY (()) label;
3874  const char * GTY (()) section_label;
3875  struct var_loc_node * GTY (()) next;
3876};
3877
3878/* Variable location list.  */
3879struct var_loc_list_def GTY (())
3880{
3881  struct var_loc_node * GTY (()) first;
3882
3883  /* Do not mark the last element of the chained list because
3884     it is marked through the chain.  */
3885  struct var_loc_node * GTY ((skip ("%h"))) last;
3886
3887  /* DECL_UID of the variable decl.  */
3888  unsigned int decl_id;
3889};
3890typedef struct var_loc_list_def var_loc_list;
3891
3892
3893/* Table of decl location linked lists.  */
3894static GTY ((param_is (var_loc_list))) htab_t decl_loc_table;
3895
3896/* A pointer to the base of a list of references to DIE's that
3897   are uniquely identified by their tag, presence/absence of
3898   children DIE's, and list of attribute/value pairs.  */
3899static GTY((length ("abbrev_die_table_allocated")))
3900  dw_die_ref *abbrev_die_table;
3901
3902/* Number of elements currently allocated for abbrev_die_table.  */
3903static GTY(()) unsigned abbrev_die_table_allocated;
3904
3905/* Number of elements in type_die_table currently in use.  */
3906static GTY(()) unsigned abbrev_die_table_in_use;
3907
3908/* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
3909   abbrev_die_table.  */
3910#define ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT 256
3911
3912/* A pointer to the base of a table that contains line information
3913   for each source code line in .text in the compilation unit.  */
3914static GTY((length ("line_info_table_allocated")))
3915     dw_line_info_ref line_info_table;
3916
3917/* Number of elements currently allocated for line_info_table.  */
3918static GTY(()) unsigned line_info_table_allocated;
3919
3920/* Number of elements in line_info_table currently in use.  */
3921static GTY(()) unsigned line_info_table_in_use;
3922
3923/* True if the compilation unit places functions in more than one section.  */
3924static GTY(()) bool have_multiple_function_sections = false;
3925
3926/* A pointer to the base of a table that contains line information
3927   for each source code line outside of .text in the compilation unit.  */
3928static GTY ((length ("separate_line_info_table_allocated")))
3929     dw_separate_line_info_ref separate_line_info_table;
3930
3931/* Number of elements currently allocated for separate_line_info_table.  */
3932static GTY(()) unsigned separate_line_info_table_allocated;
3933
3934/* Number of elements in separate_line_info_table currently in use.  */
3935static GTY(()) unsigned separate_line_info_table_in_use;
3936
3937/* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
3938   line_info_table.  */
3939#define LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT 1024
3940
3941/* A pointer to the base of a table that contains a list of publicly
3942   accessible names.  */
3943static GTY ((length ("pubname_table_allocated"))) pubname_ref pubname_table;
3944
3945/* Number of elements currently allocated for pubname_table.  */
3946static GTY(()) unsigned pubname_table_allocated;
3947
3948/* Number of elements in pubname_table currently in use.  */
3949static GTY(()) unsigned pubname_table_in_use;
3950
3951/* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
3952   pubname_table.  */
3953#define PUBNAME_TABLE_INCREMENT 64
3954
3955/* Array of dies for which we should generate .debug_arange info.  */
3956static GTY((length ("arange_table_allocated"))) dw_die_ref *arange_table;
3957
3958/* Number of elements currently allocated for arange_table.  */
3959static GTY(()) unsigned arange_table_allocated;
3960
3961/* Number of elements in arange_table currently in use.  */
3962static GTY(()) unsigned arange_table_in_use;
3963
3964/* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
3965   arange_table.  */
3966#define ARANGE_TABLE_INCREMENT 64
3967
3968/* Array of dies for which we should generate .debug_ranges info.  */
3969static GTY ((length ("ranges_table_allocated"))) dw_ranges_ref ranges_table;
3970
3971/* Number of elements currently allocated for ranges_table.  */
3972static GTY(()) unsigned ranges_table_allocated;
3973
3974/* Number of elements in ranges_table currently in use.  */
3975static GTY(()) unsigned ranges_table_in_use;
3976
3977/* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
3978   ranges_table.  */
3979#define RANGES_TABLE_INCREMENT 64
3980
3981/* Whether we have location lists that need outputting */
3982static GTY(()) bool have_location_lists;
3983
3984/* Unique label counter.  */
3985static GTY(()) unsigned int loclabel_num;
3986
3987#ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
3988/* Record whether the function being analyzed contains inlined functions.  */
3989static int current_function_has_inlines;
3990#endif
3991#if 0 && defined (MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO)
3992static int comp_unit_has_inlines;
3993#endif
3994
3995/* The last file entry emitted by maybe_emit_file().  */
3996static GTY(()) struct dwarf_file_data * last_emitted_file;
3997
3998/* Number of internal labels generated by gen_internal_sym().  */
3999static GTY(()) int label_num;
4000
4001/* Cached result of previous call to lookup_filename.  */
4002static GTY(()) struct dwarf_file_data * file_table_last_lookup;
4003
4004#ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
4005
4006/* Offset from the "steady-state frame pointer" to the frame base,
4007   within the current function.  */
4008static HOST_WIDE_INT frame_pointer_fb_offset;
4009
4010/* Forward declarations for functions defined in this file.  */
4011
4012static int is_pseudo_reg (rtx);
4013static tree type_main_variant (tree);
4014static int is_tagged_type (tree);
4015static const char *dwarf_tag_name (unsigned);
4016static const char *dwarf_attr_name (unsigned);
4017static const char *dwarf_form_name (unsigned);
4018static tree decl_ultimate_origin (tree);
4019static tree block_ultimate_origin (tree);
4020static tree decl_class_context (tree);
4021static void add_dwarf_attr (dw_die_ref, dw_attr_ref);
4022static inline enum dw_val_class AT_class (dw_attr_ref);
4023static void add_AT_flag (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned);
4024static inline unsigned AT_flag (dw_attr_ref);
4025static void add_AT_int (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, HOST_WIDE_INT);
4026static inline HOST_WIDE_INT AT_int (dw_attr_ref);
4027static void add_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
4028static inline unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT AT_unsigned (dw_attr_ref);
4029static void add_AT_long_long (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned long,
4030			      unsigned long);
4031static inline void add_AT_vec (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned int,
4032			       unsigned int, unsigned char *);
4033static hashval_t debug_str_do_hash (const void *);
4034static int debug_str_eq (const void *, const void *);
4035static void add_AT_string (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
4036static inline const char *AT_string (dw_attr_ref);
4037static int AT_string_form (dw_attr_ref);
4038static void add_AT_die_ref (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, dw_die_ref);
4039static void add_AT_specification (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
4040static inline dw_die_ref AT_ref (dw_attr_ref);
4041static inline int AT_ref_external (dw_attr_ref);
4042static inline void set_AT_ref_external (dw_attr_ref, int);
4043static void add_AT_fde_ref (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned);
4044static void add_AT_loc (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, dw_loc_descr_ref);
4045static inline dw_loc_descr_ref AT_loc (dw_attr_ref);
4046static void add_AT_loc_list (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
4047			     dw_loc_list_ref);
4048static inline dw_loc_list_ref AT_loc_list (dw_attr_ref);
4049static void add_AT_addr (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, rtx);
4050static inline rtx AT_addr (dw_attr_ref);
4051static void add_AT_lbl_id (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
4052static void add_AT_lineptr (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
4053static void add_AT_macptr (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
4054static void add_AT_offset (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
4055			   unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
4056static void add_AT_range_list (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
4057			       unsigned long);
4058static inline const char *AT_lbl (dw_attr_ref);
4059static dw_attr_ref get_AT (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
4060static const char *get_AT_low_pc (dw_die_ref);
4061static const char *get_AT_hi_pc (dw_die_ref);
4062static const char *get_AT_string (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
4063static int get_AT_flag (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
4064static unsigned get_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
4065static inline dw_die_ref get_AT_ref (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
4066static bool is_c_family (void);
4067static bool is_cxx (void);
4068static bool is_java (void);
4069static bool is_fortran (void);
4070static bool is_ada (void);
4071static void remove_AT (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
4072static void remove_child_TAG (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_tag);
4073static void add_child_die (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
4074static dw_die_ref new_die (enum dwarf_tag, dw_die_ref, tree);
4075static dw_die_ref lookup_type_die (tree);
4076static void equate_type_number_to_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4077static hashval_t decl_die_table_hash (const void *);
4078static int decl_die_table_eq (const void *, const void *);
4079static dw_die_ref lookup_decl_die (tree);
4080static hashval_t decl_loc_table_hash (const void *);
4081static int decl_loc_table_eq (const void *, const void *);
4082static var_loc_list *lookup_decl_loc (tree);
4083static void equate_decl_number_to_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4084static void add_var_loc_to_decl (tree, struct var_loc_node *);
4085static void print_spaces (FILE *);
4086static void print_die (dw_die_ref, FILE *);
4087static void print_dwarf_line_table (FILE *);
4088static dw_die_ref push_new_compile_unit (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
4089static dw_die_ref pop_compile_unit (dw_die_ref);
4090static void loc_checksum (dw_loc_descr_ref, struct md5_ctx *);
4091static void attr_checksum (dw_attr_ref, struct md5_ctx *, int *);
4092static void die_checksum (dw_die_ref, struct md5_ctx *, int *);
4093static int same_loc_p (dw_loc_descr_ref, dw_loc_descr_ref, int *);
4094static int same_dw_val_p (dw_val_node *, dw_val_node *, int *);
4095static int same_attr_p (dw_attr_ref, dw_attr_ref, int *);
4096static int same_die_p (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref, int *);
4097static int same_die_p_wrap (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
4098static void compute_section_prefix (dw_die_ref);
4099static int is_type_die (dw_die_ref);
4100static int is_comdat_die (dw_die_ref);
4101static int is_symbol_die (dw_die_ref);
4102static void assign_symbol_names (dw_die_ref);
4103static void break_out_includes (dw_die_ref);
4104static hashval_t htab_cu_hash (const void *);
4105static int htab_cu_eq (const void *, const void *);
4106static void htab_cu_del (void *);
4107static int check_duplicate_cu (dw_die_ref, htab_t, unsigned *);
4108static void record_comdat_symbol_number (dw_die_ref, htab_t, unsigned);
4109static void add_sibling_attributes (dw_die_ref);
4110static void build_abbrev_table (dw_die_ref);
4111static void output_location_lists (dw_die_ref);
4112static int constant_size (long unsigned);
4113static unsigned long size_of_die (dw_die_ref);
4114static void calc_die_sizes (dw_die_ref);
4115static void mark_dies (dw_die_ref);
4116static void unmark_dies (dw_die_ref);
4117static void unmark_all_dies (dw_die_ref);
4118static unsigned long size_of_pubnames (void);
4119static unsigned long size_of_aranges (void);
4120static enum dwarf_form value_format (dw_attr_ref);
4121static void output_value_format (dw_attr_ref);
4122static void output_abbrev_section (void);
4123static void output_die_symbol (dw_die_ref);
4124static void output_die (dw_die_ref);
4125static void output_compilation_unit_header (void);
4126static void output_comp_unit (dw_die_ref, int);
4127static const char *dwarf2_name (tree, int);
4128static void add_pubname (tree, dw_die_ref);
4129static void output_pubnames (void);
4130static void add_arange (tree, dw_die_ref);
4131static void output_aranges (void);
4132static unsigned int add_ranges (tree);
4133static void output_ranges (void);
4134static void output_line_info (void);
4135static void output_file_names (void);
4136static dw_die_ref base_type_die (tree);
4137static tree root_type (tree);
4138static int is_base_type (tree);
4139static bool is_subrange_type (tree);
4140static dw_die_ref subrange_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4141static dw_die_ref modified_type_die (tree, int, int, dw_die_ref);
4142static int type_is_enum (tree);
4143static unsigned int dbx_reg_number (rtx);
4144static void add_loc_descr_op_piece (dw_loc_descr_ref *, int);
4145static dw_loc_descr_ref reg_loc_descriptor (rtx);
4146static dw_loc_descr_ref one_reg_loc_descriptor (unsigned int);
4147static dw_loc_descr_ref multiple_reg_loc_descriptor (rtx, rtx);
4148static dw_loc_descr_ref int_loc_descriptor (HOST_WIDE_INT);
4149static dw_loc_descr_ref based_loc_descr (rtx, HOST_WIDE_INT);
4150static int is_based_loc (rtx);
4151static dw_loc_descr_ref mem_loc_descriptor (rtx, enum machine_mode mode);
4152static dw_loc_descr_ref concat_loc_descriptor (rtx, rtx);
4153static dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descriptor (rtx);
4154static dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (tree, int);
4155static dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descriptor_from_tree (tree);
4156static HOST_WIDE_INT ceiling (HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned int);
4157static tree field_type (tree);
4158static unsigned int simple_type_align_in_bits (tree);
4159static unsigned int simple_decl_align_in_bits (tree);
4160static unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT simple_type_size_in_bits (tree);
4161static HOST_WIDE_INT field_byte_offset (tree);
4162static void add_AT_location_description	(dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
4163					 dw_loc_descr_ref);
4164static void add_data_member_location_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
4165static void add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref, rtx);
4166static void insert_int (HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned, unsigned char *);
4167static HOST_WIDE_INT extract_int (const unsigned char *, unsigned);
4168static void insert_float (rtx, unsigned char *);
4169static rtx rtl_for_decl_location (tree);
4170static void add_location_or_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree,
4171						   enum dwarf_attribute);
4172static void tree_add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
4173static void add_name_attribute (dw_die_ref, const char *);
4174static void add_comp_dir_attribute (dw_die_ref);
4175static void add_bound_info (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, tree);
4176static void add_subscript_info (dw_die_ref, tree);
4177static void add_byte_size_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
4178static void add_bit_offset_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
4179static void add_bit_size_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
4180static void add_prototyped_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
4181static void add_abstract_origin_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
4182static void add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
4183static void add_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref, tree);
4184static void add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref, tree);
4185static void push_decl_scope (tree);
4186static void pop_decl_scope (void);
4187static dw_die_ref scope_die_for (tree, dw_die_ref);
4188static inline int local_scope_p (dw_die_ref);
4189static inline int class_or_namespace_scope_p (dw_die_ref);
4190static void add_type_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree, int, int, dw_die_ref);
4191static void add_calling_convention_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
4192static const char *type_tag (tree);
4193static tree member_declared_type (tree);
4194#if 0
4195static const char *decl_start_label (tree);
4196#endif
4197static void gen_array_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4198#if 0
4199static void gen_entry_point_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4200#endif
4201static void gen_inlined_enumeration_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4202static void gen_inlined_structure_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4203static void gen_inlined_union_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4204static dw_die_ref gen_enumeration_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4205static dw_die_ref gen_formal_parameter_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4206static void gen_unspecified_parameters_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4207static void gen_formal_types_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4208static void gen_subprogram_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4209static void gen_variable_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4210static void gen_label_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4211static void gen_lexical_block_die (tree, dw_die_ref, int);
4212static void gen_inlined_subroutine_die (tree, dw_die_ref, int);
4213static void gen_field_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4214static void gen_ptr_to_mbr_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4215static dw_die_ref gen_compile_unit_die (const char *);
4216static void gen_inheritance_die (tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
4217static void gen_member_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4218static void gen_struct_or_union_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref,
4219						enum debug_info_usage);
4220static void gen_subroutine_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4221static void gen_typedef_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4222static void gen_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4223static void gen_tagged_type_instantiation_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4224static void gen_block_die (tree, dw_die_ref, int);
4225static void decls_for_scope (tree, dw_die_ref, int);
4226static int is_redundant_typedef (tree);
4227static void gen_namespace_die (tree);
4228static void gen_decl_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4229static dw_die_ref force_decl_die (tree);
4230static dw_die_ref force_type_die (tree);
4231static dw_die_ref setup_namespace_context (tree, dw_die_ref);
4232static void declare_in_namespace (tree, dw_die_ref);
4233static struct dwarf_file_data * lookup_filename (const char *);
4234static void retry_incomplete_types (void);
4235static void gen_type_die_for_member (tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
4236static void splice_child_die (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
4237static int file_info_cmp (const void *, const void *);
4238static dw_loc_list_ref new_loc_list (dw_loc_descr_ref, const char *,
4239				     const char *, const char *, unsigned);
4240static void add_loc_descr_to_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref *, dw_loc_descr_ref,
4241				       const char *, const char *,
4242				       const char *);
4243static void output_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref);
4244static char *gen_internal_sym (const char *);
4245
4246static void prune_unmark_dies (dw_die_ref);
4247static void prune_unused_types_mark (dw_die_ref, int);
4248static void prune_unused_types_walk (dw_die_ref);
4249static void prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (dw_die_ref);
4250static void prune_unused_types_prune (dw_die_ref);
4251static void prune_unused_types (void);
4252static int maybe_emit_file (struct dwarf_file_data *fd);
4253
4254/* Section names used to hold DWARF debugging information.  */
4255#ifndef DEBUG_INFO_SECTION
4256#define DEBUG_INFO_SECTION	".debug_info"
4257#endif
4258#ifndef DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION
4259#define DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION	".debug_abbrev"
4260#endif
4261#ifndef DEBUG_ARANGES_SECTION
4262#define DEBUG_ARANGES_SECTION	".debug_aranges"
4263#endif
4264#ifndef DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION
4265#define DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION	".debug_macinfo"
4266#endif
4267#ifndef DEBUG_LINE_SECTION
4268#define DEBUG_LINE_SECTION	".debug_line"
4269#endif
4270#ifndef DEBUG_LOC_SECTION
4271#define DEBUG_LOC_SECTION	".debug_loc"
4272#endif
4273#ifndef DEBUG_PUBNAMES_SECTION
4274#define DEBUG_PUBNAMES_SECTION	".debug_pubnames"
4275#endif
4276#ifndef DEBUG_STR_SECTION
4277#define DEBUG_STR_SECTION	".debug_str"
4278#endif
4279#ifndef DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION
4280#define DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION	".debug_ranges"
4281#endif
4282
4283/* Standard ELF section names for compiled code and data.  */
4284#ifndef TEXT_SECTION_NAME
4285#define TEXT_SECTION_NAME	".text"
4286#endif
4287
4288/* Section flags for .debug_str section.  */
4289#define DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS \
4290  (HAVE_GAS_SHF_MERGE && flag_merge_constants			\
4291   ? SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_MERGE | SECTION_STRINGS | 1	\
4292   : SECTION_DEBUG)
4293
4294/* Labels we insert at beginning sections we can reference instead of
4295   the section names themselves.  */
4296
4297#ifndef TEXT_SECTION_LABEL
4298#define TEXT_SECTION_LABEL		"Ltext"
4299#endif
4300#ifndef COLD_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL
4301#define COLD_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL         "Ltext_cold"
4302#endif
4303#ifndef DEBUG_LINE_SECTION_LABEL
4304#define DEBUG_LINE_SECTION_LABEL	"Ldebug_line"
4305#endif
4306#ifndef DEBUG_INFO_SECTION_LABEL
4307#define DEBUG_INFO_SECTION_LABEL	"Ldebug_info"
4308#endif
4309#ifndef DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL
4310#define DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL	"Ldebug_abbrev"
4311#endif
4312#ifndef DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL
4313#define DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL		"Ldebug_loc"
4314#endif
4315#ifndef DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL
4316#define DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL	"Ldebug_ranges"
4317#endif
4318#ifndef DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION_LABEL
4319#define DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION_LABEL     "Ldebug_macinfo"
4320#endif
4321
4322/* Definitions of defaults for formats and names of various special
4323   (artificial) labels which may be generated within this file (when the -g
4324   options is used and DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO is in effect.
4325   If necessary, these may be overridden from within the tm.h file, but
4326   typically, overriding these defaults is unnecessary.  */
4327
4328static char text_end_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4329static char text_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4330static char cold_text_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4331static char cold_end_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4332static char abbrev_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4333static char debug_info_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4334static char debug_line_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4335static char macinfo_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4336static char loc_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4337static char ranges_section_label[2 * MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4338
4339#ifndef TEXT_END_LABEL
4340#define TEXT_END_LABEL		"Letext"
4341#endif
4342#ifndef COLD_END_LABEL
4343#define COLD_END_LABEL          "Letext_cold"
4344#endif
4345#ifndef BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL
4346#define BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL	"LBB"
4347#endif
4348#ifndef BLOCK_END_LABEL
4349#define BLOCK_END_LABEL		"LBE"
4350#endif
4351#ifndef LINE_CODE_LABEL
4352#define LINE_CODE_LABEL		"LM"
4353#endif
4354#ifndef SEPARATE_LINE_CODE_LABEL
4355#define SEPARATE_LINE_CODE_LABEL	"LSM"
4356#endif
4357
4358/* We allow a language front-end to designate a function that is to be
4359   called to "demangle" any name before it is put into a DIE.  */
4360
4361static const char *(*demangle_name_func) (const char *);
4362
4363void
4364dwarf2out_set_demangle_name_func (const char *(*func) (const char *))
4365{
4366  demangle_name_func = func;
4367}
4368
4369/* Test if rtl node points to a pseudo register.  */
4370
4371static inline int
4372is_pseudo_reg (rtx rtl)
4373{
4374  return ((REG_P (rtl) && REGNO (rtl) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
4375	  || (GET_CODE (rtl) == SUBREG
4376	      && REGNO (SUBREG_REG (rtl)) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER));
4377}
4378
4379/* Return a reference to a type, with its const and volatile qualifiers
4380   removed.  */
4381
4382static inline tree
4383type_main_variant (tree type)
4384{
4385  type = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type);
4386
4387  /* ??? There really should be only one main variant among any group of
4388     variants of a given type (and all of the MAIN_VARIANT values for all
4389     members of the group should point to that one type) but sometimes the C
4390     front-end messes this up for array types, so we work around that bug
4391     here.  */
4392  if (TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
4393    while (type != TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type))
4394      type = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type);
4395
4396  return type;
4397}
4398
4399/* Return nonzero if the given type node represents a tagged type.  */
4400
4401static inline int
4402is_tagged_type (tree type)
4403{
4404  enum tree_code code = TREE_CODE (type);
4405
4406  return (code == RECORD_TYPE || code == UNION_TYPE
4407	  || code == QUAL_UNION_TYPE || code == ENUMERAL_TYPE);
4408}
4409
4410/* Convert a DIE tag into its string name.  */
4411
4412static const char *
4413dwarf_tag_name (unsigned int tag)
4414{
4415  switch (tag)
4416    {
4417    case DW_TAG_padding:
4418      return "DW_TAG_padding";
4419    case DW_TAG_array_type:
4420      return "DW_TAG_array_type";
4421    case DW_TAG_class_type:
4422      return "DW_TAG_class_type";
4423    case DW_TAG_entry_point:
4424      return "DW_TAG_entry_point";
4425    case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
4426      return "DW_TAG_enumeration_type";
4427    case DW_TAG_formal_parameter:
4428      return "DW_TAG_formal_parameter";
4429    case DW_TAG_imported_declaration:
4430      return "DW_TAG_imported_declaration";
4431    case DW_TAG_label:
4432      return "DW_TAG_label";
4433    case DW_TAG_lexical_block:
4434      return "DW_TAG_lexical_block";
4435    case DW_TAG_member:
4436      return "DW_TAG_member";
4437    case DW_TAG_pointer_type:
4438      return "DW_TAG_pointer_type";
4439    case DW_TAG_reference_type:
4440      return "DW_TAG_reference_type";
4441    case DW_TAG_compile_unit:
4442      return "DW_TAG_compile_unit";
4443    case DW_TAG_string_type:
4444      return "DW_TAG_string_type";
4445    case DW_TAG_structure_type:
4446      return "DW_TAG_structure_type";
4447    case DW_TAG_subroutine_type:
4448      return "DW_TAG_subroutine_type";
4449    case DW_TAG_typedef:
4450      return "DW_TAG_typedef";
4451    case DW_TAG_union_type:
4452      return "DW_TAG_union_type";
4453    case DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters:
4454      return "DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters";
4455    case DW_TAG_variant:
4456      return "DW_TAG_variant";
4457    case DW_TAG_common_block:
4458      return "DW_TAG_common_block";
4459    case DW_TAG_common_inclusion:
4460      return "DW_TAG_common_inclusion";
4461    case DW_TAG_inheritance:
4462      return "DW_TAG_inheritance";
4463    case DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine:
4464      return "DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine";
4465    case DW_TAG_module:
4466      return "DW_TAG_module";
4467    case DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type:
4468      return "DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type";
4469    case DW_TAG_set_type:
4470      return "DW_TAG_set_type";
4471    case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
4472      return "DW_TAG_subrange_type";
4473    case DW_TAG_with_stmt:
4474      return "DW_TAG_with_stmt";
4475    case DW_TAG_access_declaration:
4476      return "DW_TAG_access_declaration";
4477    case DW_TAG_base_type:
4478      return "DW_TAG_base_type";
4479    case DW_TAG_catch_block:
4480      return "DW_TAG_catch_block";
4481    case DW_TAG_const_type:
4482      return "DW_TAG_const_type";
4483    case DW_TAG_constant:
4484      return "DW_TAG_constant";
4485    case DW_TAG_enumerator:
4486      return "DW_TAG_enumerator";
4487    case DW_TAG_file_type:
4488      return "DW_TAG_file_type";
4489    case DW_TAG_friend:
4490      return "DW_TAG_friend";
4491    case DW_TAG_namelist:
4492      return "DW_TAG_namelist";
4493    case DW_TAG_namelist_item:
4494      return "DW_TAG_namelist_item";
4495    case DW_TAG_namespace:
4496      return "DW_TAG_namespace";
4497    case DW_TAG_packed_type:
4498      return "DW_TAG_packed_type";
4499    case DW_TAG_subprogram:
4500      return "DW_TAG_subprogram";
4501    case DW_TAG_template_type_param:
4502      return "DW_TAG_template_type_param";
4503    case DW_TAG_template_value_param:
4504      return "DW_TAG_template_value_param";
4505    case DW_TAG_thrown_type:
4506      return "DW_TAG_thrown_type";
4507    case DW_TAG_try_block:
4508      return "DW_TAG_try_block";
4509    case DW_TAG_variant_part:
4510      return "DW_TAG_variant_part";
4511    case DW_TAG_variable:
4512      return "DW_TAG_variable";
4513    case DW_TAG_volatile_type:
4514      return "DW_TAG_volatile_type";
4515    case DW_TAG_imported_module:
4516      return "DW_TAG_imported_module";
4517    case DW_TAG_MIPS_loop:
4518      return "DW_TAG_MIPS_loop";
4519    case DW_TAG_format_label:
4520      return "DW_TAG_format_label";
4521    case DW_TAG_function_template:
4522      return "DW_TAG_function_template";
4523    case DW_TAG_class_template:
4524      return "DW_TAG_class_template";
4525    case DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL:
4526      return "DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL";
4527    case DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL:
4528      return "DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL";
4529    default:
4530      return "DW_TAG_<unknown>";
4531    }
4532}
4533
4534/* Convert a DWARF attribute code into its string name.  */
4535
4536static const char *
4537dwarf_attr_name (unsigned int attr)
4538{
4539  switch (attr)
4540    {
4541    case DW_AT_sibling:
4542      return "DW_AT_sibling";
4543    case DW_AT_location:
4544      return "DW_AT_location";
4545    case DW_AT_name:
4546      return "DW_AT_name";
4547    case DW_AT_ordering:
4548      return "DW_AT_ordering";
4549    case DW_AT_subscr_data:
4550      return "DW_AT_subscr_data";
4551    case DW_AT_byte_size:
4552      return "DW_AT_byte_size";
4553    case DW_AT_bit_offset:
4554      return "DW_AT_bit_offset";
4555    case DW_AT_bit_size:
4556      return "DW_AT_bit_size";
4557    case DW_AT_element_list:
4558      return "DW_AT_element_list";
4559    case DW_AT_stmt_list:
4560      return "DW_AT_stmt_list";
4561    case DW_AT_low_pc:
4562      return "DW_AT_low_pc";
4563    case DW_AT_high_pc:
4564      return "DW_AT_high_pc";
4565    case DW_AT_language:
4566      return "DW_AT_language";
4567    case DW_AT_member:
4568      return "DW_AT_member";
4569    case DW_AT_discr:
4570      return "DW_AT_discr";
4571    case DW_AT_discr_value:
4572      return "DW_AT_discr_value";
4573    case DW_AT_visibility:
4574      return "DW_AT_visibility";
4575    case DW_AT_import:
4576      return "DW_AT_import";
4577    case DW_AT_string_length:
4578      return "DW_AT_string_length";
4579    case DW_AT_common_reference:
4580      return "DW_AT_common_reference";
4581    case DW_AT_comp_dir:
4582      return "DW_AT_comp_dir";
4583    case DW_AT_const_value:
4584      return "DW_AT_const_value";
4585    case DW_AT_containing_type:
4586      return "DW_AT_containing_type";
4587    case DW_AT_default_value:
4588      return "DW_AT_default_value";
4589    case DW_AT_inline:
4590      return "DW_AT_inline";
4591    case DW_AT_is_optional:
4592      return "DW_AT_is_optional";
4593    case DW_AT_lower_bound:
4594      return "DW_AT_lower_bound";
4595    case DW_AT_producer:
4596      return "DW_AT_producer";
4597    case DW_AT_prototyped:
4598      return "DW_AT_prototyped";
4599    case DW_AT_return_addr:
4600      return "DW_AT_return_addr";
4601    case DW_AT_start_scope:
4602      return "DW_AT_start_scope";
4603    case DW_AT_stride_size:
4604      return "DW_AT_stride_size";
4605    case DW_AT_upper_bound:
4606      return "DW_AT_upper_bound";
4607    case DW_AT_abstract_origin:
4608      return "DW_AT_abstract_origin";
4609    case DW_AT_accessibility:
4610      return "DW_AT_accessibility";
4611    case DW_AT_address_class:
4612      return "DW_AT_address_class";
4613    case DW_AT_artificial:
4614      return "DW_AT_artificial";
4615    case DW_AT_base_types:
4616      return "DW_AT_base_types";
4617    case DW_AT_calling_convention:
4618      return "DW_AT_calling_convention";
4619    case DW_AT_count:
4620      return "DW_AT_count";
4621    case DW_AT_data_member_location:
4622      return "DW_AT_data_member_location";
4623    case DW_AT_decl_column:
4624      return "DW_AT_decl_column";
4625    case DW_AT_decl_file:
4626      return "DW_AT_decl_file";
4627    case DW_AT_decl_line:
4628      return "DW_AT_decl_line";
4629    case DW_AT_declaration:
4630      return "DW_AT_declaration";
4631    case DW_AT_discr_list:
4632      return "DW_AT_discr_list";
4633    case DW_AT_encoding:
4634      return "DW_AT_encoding";
4635    case DW_AT_external:
4636      return "DW_AT_external";
4637    case DW_AT_frame_base:
4638      return "DW_AT_frame_base";
4639    case DW_AT_friend:
4640      return "DW_AT_friend";
4641    case DW_AT_identifier_case:
4642      return "DW_AT_identifier_case";
4643    case DW_AT_macro_info:
4644      return "DW_AT_macro_info";
4645    case DW_AT_namelist_items:
4646      return "DW_AT_namelist_items";
4647    case DW_AT_priority:
4648      return "DW_AT_priority";
4649    case DW_AT_segment:
4650      return "DW_AT_segment";
4651    case DW_AT_specification:
4652      return "DW_AT_specification";
4653    case DW_AT_static_link:
4654      return "DW_AT_static_link";
4655    case DW_AT_type:
4656      return "DW_AT_type";
4657    case DW_AT_use_location:
4658      return "DW_AT_use_location";
4659    case DW_AT_variable_parameter:
4660      return "DW_AT_variable_parameter";
4661    case DW_AT_virtuality:
4662      return "DW_AT_virtuality";
4663    case DW_AT_vtable_elem_location:
4664      return "DW_AT_vtable_elem_location";
4665
4666    case DW_AT_allocated:
4667      return "DW_AT_allocated";
4668    case DW_AT_associated:
4669      return "DW_AT_associated";
4670    case DW_AT_data_location:
4671      return "DW_AT_data_location";
4672    case DW_AT_stride:
4673      return "DW_AT_stride";
4674    case DW_AT_entry_pc:
4675      return "DW_AT_entry_pc";
4676    case DW_AT_use_UTF8:
4677      return "DW_AT_use_UTF8";
4678    case DW_AT_extension:
4679      return "DW_AT_extension";
4680    case DW_AT_ranges:
4681      return "DW_AT_ranges";
4682    case DW_AT_trampoline:
4683      return "DW_AT_trampoline";
4684    case DW_AT_call_column:
4685      return "DW_AT_call_column";
4686    case DW_AT_call_file:
4687      return "DW_AT_call_file";
4688    case DW_AT_call_line:
4689      return "DW_AT_call_line";
4690
4691    case DW_AT_MIPS_fde:
4692      return "DW_AT_MIPS_fde";
4693    case DW_AT_MIPS_loop_begin:
4694      return "DW_AT_MIPS_loop_begin";
4695    case DW_AT_MIPS_tail_loop_begin:
4696      return "DW_AT_MIPS_tail_loop_begin";
4697    case DW_AT_MIPS_epilog_begin:
4698      return "DW_AT_MIPS_epilog_begin";
4699    case DW_AT_MIPS_loop_unroll_factor:
4700      return "DW_AT_MIPS_loop_unroll_factor";
4701    case DW_AT_MIPS_software_pipeline_depth:
4702      return "DW_AT_MIPS_software_pipeline_depth";
4703    case DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name:
4704      return "DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name";
4705    case DW_AT_MIPS_stride:
4706      return "DW_AT_MIPS_stride";
4707    case DW_AT_MIPS_abstract_name:
4708      return "DW_AT_MIPS_abstract_name";
4709    case DW_AT_MIPS_clone_origin:
4710      return "DW_AT_MIPS_clone_origin";
4711    case DW_AT_MIPS_has_inlines:
4712      return "DW_AT_MIPS_has_inlines";
4713
4714    case DW_AT_sf_names:
4715      return "DW_AT_sf_names";
4716    case DW_AT_src_info:
4717      return "DW_AT_src_info";
4718    case DW_AT_mac_info:
4719      return "DW_AT_mac_info";
4720    case DW_AT_src_coords:
4721      return "DW_AT_src_coords";
4722    case DW_AT_body_begin:
4723      return "DW_AT_body_begin";
4724    case DW_AT_body_end:
4725      return "DW_AT_body_end";
4726    case DW_AT_GNU_vector:
4727      return "DW_AT_GNU_vector";
4728
4729    case DW_AT_VMS_rtnbeg_pd_address:
4730      return "DW_AT_VMS_rtnbeg_pd_address";
4731
4732    default:
4733      return "DW_AT_<unknown>";
4734    }
4735}
4736
4737/* Convert a DWARF value form code into its string name.  */
4738
4739static const char *
4740dwarf_form_name (unsigned int form)
4741{
4742  switch (form)
4743    {
4744    case DW_FORM_addr:
4745      return "DW_FORM_addr";
4746    case DW_FORM_block2:
4747      return "DW_FORM_block2";
4748    case DW_FORM_block4:
4749      return "DW_FORM_block4";
4750    case DW_FORM_data2:
4751      return "DW_FORM_data2";
4752    case DW_FORM_data4:
4753      return "DW_FORM_data4";
4754    case DW_FORM_data8:
4755      return "DW_FORM_data8";
4756    case DW_FORM_string:
4757      return "DW_FORM_string";
4758    case DW_FORM_block:
4759      return "DW_FORM_block";
4760    case DW_FORM_block1:
4761      return "DW_FORM_block1";
4762    case DW_FORM_data1:
4763      return "DW_FORM_data1";
4764    case DW_FORM_flag:
4765      return "DW_FORM_flag";
4766    case DW_FORM_sdata:
4767      return "DW_FORM_sdata";
4768    case DW_FORM_strp:
4769      return "DW_FORM_strp";
4770    case DW_FORM_udata:
4771      return "DW_FORM_udata";
4772    case DW_FORM_ref_addr:
4773      return "DW_FORM_ref_addr";
4774    case DW_FORM_ref1:
4775      return "DW_FORM_ref1";
4776    case DW_FORM_ref2:
4777      return "DW_FORM_ref2";
4778    case DW_FORM_ref4:
4779      return "DW_FORM_ref4";
4780    case DW_FORM_ref8:
4781      return "DW_FORM_ref8";
4782    case DW_FORM_ref_udata:
4783      return "DW_FORM_ref_udata";
4784    case DW_FORM_indirect:
4785      return "DW_FORM_indirect";
4786    default:
4787      return "DW_FORM_<unknown>";
4788    }
4789}
4790
4791/* Determine the "ultimate origin" of a decl.  The decl may be an inlined
4792   instance of an inlined instance of a decl which is local to an inline
4793   function, so we have to trace all of the way back through the origin chain
4794   to find out what sort of node actually served as the original seed for the
4795   given block.  */
4796
4797static tree
4798decl_ultimate_origin (tree decl)
4799{
4800  if (!CODE_CONTAINS_STRUCT (TREE_CODE (decl), TS_DECL_COMMON))
4801    return NULL_TREE;
4802
4803  /* output_inline_function sets DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for all the
4804     nodes in the function to point to themselves; ignore that if
4805     we're trying to output the abstract instance of this function.  */
4806  if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl) && DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) == decl)
4807    return NULL_TREE;
4808
4809  /* Since the DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for a DECL is supposed to be the
4810     most distant ancestor, this should never happen.  */
4811  gcc_assert (!DECL_FROM_INLINE (DECL_ORIGIN (decl)));
4812
4813  return DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl);
4814}
4815
4816/* Determine the "ultimate origin" of a block.  The block may be an inlined
4817   instance of an inlined instance of a block which is local to an inline
4818   function, so we have to trace all of the way back through the origin chain
4819   to find out what sort of node actually served as the original seed for the
4820   given block.  */
4821
4822static tree
4823block_ultimate_origin (tree block)
4824{
4825  tree immediate_origin = BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (block);
4826
4827  /* output_inline_function sets BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for all the
4828     nodes in the function to point to themselves; ignore that if
4829     we're trying to output the abstract instance of this function.  */
4830  if (BLOCK_ABSTRACT (block) && immediate_origin == block)
4831    return NULL_TREE;
4832
4833  if (immediate_origin == NULL_TREE)
4834    return NULL_TREE;
4835  else
4836    {
4837      tree ret_val;
4838      tree lookahead = immediate_origin;
4839
4840      do
4841	{
4842	  ret_val = lookahead;
4843	  lookahead = (TREE_CODE (ret_val) == BLOCK
4844		       ? BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (ret_val) : NULL);
4845	}
4846      while (lookahead != NULL && lookahead != ret_val);
4847
4848      /* The block's abstract origin chain may not be the *ultimate* origin of
4849	 the block. It could lead to a DECL that has an abstract origin set.
4850	 If so, we want that DECL's abstract origin (which is what DECL_ORIGIN
4851	 will give us if it has one).  Note that DECL's abstract origins are
4852	 supposed to be the most distant ancestor (or so decl_ultimate_origin
4853	 claims), so we don't need to loop following the DECL origins.  */
4854      if (DECL_P (ret_val))
4855	return DECL_ORIGIN (ret_val);
4856
4857      return ret_val;
4858    }
4859}
4860
4861/* Get the class to which DECL belongs, if any.  In g++, the DECL_CONTEXT
4862   of a virtual function may refer to a base class, so we check the 'this'
4863   parameter.  */
4864
4865static tree
4866decl_class_context (tree decl)
4867{
4868  tree context = NULL_TREE;
4869
4870  if (TREE_CODE (decl) != FUNCTION_DECL || ! DECL_VINDEX (decl))
4871    context = DECL_CONTEXT (decl);
4872  else
4873    context = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT
4874      (TREE_TYPE (TREE_VALUE (TYPE_ARG_TYPES (TREE_TYPE (decl)))));
4875
4876  if (context && !TYPE_P (context))
4877    context = NULL_TREE;
4878
4879  return context;
4880}
4881
4882/* Add an attribute/value pair to a DIE.  */
4883
4884static inline void
4885add_dwarf_attr (dw_die_ref die, dw_attr_ref attr)
4886{
4887  /* Maybe this should be an assert?  */
4888  if (die == NULL)
4889    return;
4890
4891  if (die->die_attr == NULL)
4892    die->die_attr = VEC_alloc (dw_attr_node, gc, 1);
4893  VEC_safe_push (dw_attr_node, gc, die->die_attr, attr);
4894}
4895
4896static inline enum dw_val_class
4897AT_class (dw_attr_ref a)
4898{
4899  return a->dw_attr_val.val_class;
4900}
4901
4902/* Add a flag value attribute to a DIE.  */
4903
4904static inline void
4905add_AT_flag (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, unsigned int flag)
4906{
4907  dw_attr_node attr;
4908
4909  attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4910  attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_flag;
4911  attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_flag = flag;
4912  add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4913}
4914
4915static inline unsigned
4916AT_flag (dw_attr_ref a)
4917{
4918  gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_flag);
4919  return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag;
4920}
4921
4922/* Add a signed integer attribute value to a DIE.  */
4923
4924static inline void
4925add_AT_int (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, HOST_WIDE_INT int_val)
4926{
4927  dw_attr_node attr;
4928
4929  attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4930  attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_const;
4931  attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_int = int_val;
4932  add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4933}
4934
4935static inline HOST_WIDE_INT
4936AT_int (dw_attr_ref a)
4937{
4938  gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_const);
4939  return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_int;
4940}
4941
4942/* Add an unsigned integer attribute value to a DIE.  */
4943
4944static inline void
4945add_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4946		 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT unsigned_val)
4947{
4948  dw_attr_node attr;
4949
4950  attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4951  attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_unsigned_const;
4952  attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned = unsigned_val;
4953  add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4954}
4955
4956static inline unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
4957AT_unsigned (dw_attr_ref a)
4958{
4959  gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_unsigned_const);
4960  return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned;
4961}
4962
4963/* Add an unsigned double integer attribute value to a DIE.  */
4964
4965static inline void
4966add_AT_long_long (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4967		  long unsigned int val_hi, long unsigned int val_low)
4968{
4969  dw_attr_node attr;
4970
4971  attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4972  attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_long_long;
4973  attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.hi = val_hi;
4974  attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.low = val_low;
4975  add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4976}
4977
4978/* Add a floating point attribute value to a DIE and return it.  */
4979
4980static inline void
4981add_AT_vec (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4982	    unsigned int length, unsigned int elt_size, unsigned char *array)
4983{
4984  dw_attr_node attr;
4985
4986  attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4987  attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_vec;
4988  attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length = length;
4989  attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size = elt_size;
4990  attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.array = array;
4991  add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4992}
4993
4994/* Hash and equality functions for debug_str_hash.  */
4995
4996static hashval_t
4997debug_str_do_hash (const void *x)
4998{
4999  return htab_hash_string (((const struct indirect_string_node *)x)->str);
5000}
5001
5002static int
5003debug_str_eq (const void *x1, const void *x2)
5004{
5005  return strcmp ((((const struct indirect_string_node *)x1)->str),
5006		 (const char *)x2) == 0;
5007}
5008
5009/* Add a string attribute value to a DIE.  */
5010
5011static inline void
5012add_AT_string (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, const char *str)
5013{
5014  dw_attr_node attr;
5015  struct indirect_string_node *node;
5016  void **slot;
5017
5018  if (! debug_str_hash)
5019    debug_str_hash = htab_create_ggc (10, debug_str_do_hash,
5020				      debug_str_eq, NULL);
5021
5022  slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (debug_str_hash, str,
5023				   htab_hash_string (str), INSERT);
5024  if (*slot == NULL)
5025    *slot = ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (struct indirect_string_node));
5026  node = (struct indirect_string_node *) *slot;
5027  node->str = ggc_strdup (str);
5028  node->refcount++;
5029
5030  attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5031  attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_str;
5032  attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_str = node;
5033  add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5034}
5035
5036static inline const char *
5037AT_string (dw_attr_ref a)
5038{
5039  gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str);
5040  return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->str;
5041}
5042
5043/* Find out whether a string should be output inline in DIE
5044   or out-of-line in .debug_str section.  */
5045
5046static int
5047AT_string_form (dw_attr_ref a)
5048{
5049  struct indirect_string_node *node;
5050  unsigned int len;
5051  char label[32];
5052
5053  gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str);
5054
5055  node = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str;
5056  if (node->form)
5057    return node->form;
5058
5059  len = strlen (node->str) + 1;
5060
5061  /* If the string is shorter or equal to the size of the reference, it is
5062     always better to put it inline.  */
5063  if (len <= DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE || node->refcount == 0)
5064    return node->form = DW_FORM_string;
5065
5066  /* If we cannot expect the linker to merge strings in .debug_str
5067     section, only put it into .debug_str if it is worth even in this
5068     single module.  */
5069  if ((debug_str_section->common.flags & SECTION_MERGE) == 0
5070      && (len - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE) * node->refcount <= len)
5071    return node->form = DW_FORM_string;
5072
5073  ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "LASF", dw2_string_counter);
5074  ++dw2_string_counter;
5075  node->label = xstrdup (label);
5076
5077  return node->form = DW_FORM_strp;
5078}
5079
5080/* Add a DIE reference attribute value to a DIE.  */
5081
5082static inline void
5083add_AT_die_ref (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, dw_die_ref targ_die)
5084{
5085  dw_attr_node attr;
5086
5087  attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5088  attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
5089  attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die = targ_die;
5090  attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
5091  add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5092}
5093
5094/* Add an AT_specification attribute to a DIE, and also make the back
5095   pointer from the specification to the definition.  */
5096
5097static inline void
5098add_AT_specification (dw_die_ref die, dw_die_ref targ_die)
5099{
5100  add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_specification, targ_die);
5101  gcc_assert (!targ_die->die_definition);
5102  targ_die->die_definition = die;
5103}
5104
5105static inline dw_die_ref
5106AT_ref (dw_attr_ref a)
5107{
5108  gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref);
5109  return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die;
5110}
5111
5112static inline int
5113AT_ref_external (dw_attr_ref a)
5114{
5115  if (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref)
5116    return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external;
5117
5118  return 0;
5119}
5120
5121static inline void
5122set_AT_ref_external (dw_attr_ref a, int i)
5123{
5124  gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref);
5125  a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external = i;
5126}
5127
5128/* Add an FDE reference attribute value to a DIE.  */
5129
5130static inline void
5131add_AT_fde_ref (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, unsigned int targ_fde)
5132{
5133  dw_attr_node attr;
5134
5135  attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5136  attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_fde_ref;
5137  attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_fde_index = targ_fde;
5138  add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5139}
5140
5141/* Add a location description attribute value to a DIE.  */
5142
5143static inline void
5144add_AT_loc (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
5145{
5146  dw_attr_node attr;
5147
5148  attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5149  attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
5150  attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_loc = loc;
5151  add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5152}
5153
5154static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
5155AT_loc (dw_attr_ref a)
5156{
5157  gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc);
5158  return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc;
5159}
5160
5161static inline void
5162add_AT_loc_list (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, dw_loc_list_ref loc_list)
5163{
5164  dw_attr_node attr;
5165
5166  attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5167  attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_loc_list;
5168  attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_loc_list = loc_list;
5169  add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5170  have_location_lists = true;
5171}
5172
5173static inline dw_loc_list_ref
5174AT_loc_list (dw_attr_ref a)
5175{
5176  gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc_list);
5177  return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc_list;
5178}
5179
5180/* Add an address constant attribute value to a DIE.  */
5181
5182static inline void
5183add_AT_addr (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, rtx addr)
5184{
5185  dw_attr_node attr;
5186
5187  attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5188  attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
5189  attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_addr = addr;
5190  add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5191}
5192
5193/* Get the RTX from to an address DIE attribute.  */
5194
5195static inline rtx
5196AT_addr (dw_attr_ref a)
5197{
5198  gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_addr);
5199  return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_addr;
5200}
5201
5202/* Add a file attribute value to a DIE.  */
5203
5204static inline void
5205add_AT_file (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
5206	     struct dwarf_file_data *fd)
5207{
5208  dw_attr_node attr;
5209
5210  attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5211  attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_file;
5212  attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_file = fd;
5213  add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5214}
5215
5216/* Get the dwarf_file_data from a file DIE attribute.  */
5217
5218static inline struct dwarf_file_data *
5219AT_file (dw_attr_ref a)
5220{
5221  gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_file);
5222  return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file;
5223}
5224
5225/* Add a label identifier attribute value to a DIE.  */
5226
5227static inline void
5228add_AT_lbl_id (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, const char *lbl_id)
5229{
5230  dw_attr_node attr;
5231
5232  attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5233  attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_lbl_id;
5234  attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = xstrdup (lbl_id);
5235  add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5236}
5237
5238/* Add a section offset attribute value to a DIE, an offset into the
5239   debug_line section.  */
5240
5241static inline void
5242add_AT_lineptr (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
5243		const char *label)
5244{
5245  dw_attr_node attr;
5246
5247  attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5248  attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_lineptr;
5249  attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = xstrdup (label);
5250  add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5251}
5252
5253/* Add a section offset attribute value to a DIE, an offset into the
5254   debug_macinfo section.  */
5255
5256static inline void
5257add_AT_macptr (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
5258	       const char *label)
5259{
5260  dw_attr_node attr;
5261
5262  attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5263  attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_macptr;
5264  attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = xstrdup (label);
5265  add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5266}
5267
5268/* Add an offset attribute value to a DIE.  */
5269
5270static inline void
5271add_AT_offset (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
5272	       unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
5273{
5274  dw_attr_node attr;
5275
5276  attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5277  attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_offset;
5278  attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_offset = offset;
5279  add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5280}
5281
5282/* Add an range_list attribute value to a DIE.  */
5283
5284static void
5285add_AT_range_list (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
5286		   long unsigned int offset)
5287{
5288  dw_attr_node attr;
5289
5290  attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5291  attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_range_list;
5292  attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_offset = offset;
5293  add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5294}
5295
5296static inline const char *
5297AT_lbl (dw_attr_ref a)
5298{
5299  gcc_assert (a && (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_lbl_id
5300		    || AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_lineptr
5301		    || AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_macptr));
5302  return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id;
5303}
5304
5305/* Get the attribute of type attr_kind.  */
5306
5307static dw_attr_ref
5308get_AT (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5309{
5310  dw_attr_ref a;
5311  unsigned ix;
5312  dw_die_ref spec = NULL;
5313
5314  if (! die)
5315    return NULL;
5316
5317  for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
5318    if (a->dw_attr == attr_kind)
5319      return a;
5320    else if (a->dw_attr == DW_AT_specification
5321	     || a->dw_attr == DW_AT_abstract_origin)
5322      spec = AT_ref (a);
5323
5324  if (spec)
5325    return get_AT (spec, attr_kind);
5326
5327  return NULL;
5328}
5329
5330/* Return the "low pc" attribute value, typically associated with a subprogram
5331   DIE.  Return null if the "low pc" attribute is either not present, or if it
5332   cannot be represented as an assembler label identifier.  */
5333
5334static inline const char *
5335get_AT_low_pc (dw_die_ref die)
5336{
5337  dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, DW_AT_low_pc);
5338
5339  return a ? AT_lbl (a) : NULL;
5340}
5341
5342/* Return the "high pc" attribute value, typically associated with a subprogram
5343   DIE.  Return null if the "high pc" attribute is either not present, or if it
5344   cannot be represented as an assembler label identifier.  */
5345
5346static inline const char *
5347get_AT_hi_pc (dw_die_ref die)
5348{
5349  dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, DW_AT_high_pc);
5350
5351  return a ? AT_lbl (a) : NULL;
5352}
5353
5354/* Return the value of the string attribute designated by ATTR_KIND, or
5355   NULL if it is not present.  */
5356
5357static inline const char *
5358get_AT_string (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5359{
5360  dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
5361
5362  return a ? AT_string (a) : NULL;
5363}
5364
5365/* Return the value of the flag attribute designated by ATTR_KIND, or -1
5366   if it is not present.  */
5367
5368static inline int
5369get_AT_flag (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5370{
5371  dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
5372
5373  return a ? AT_flag (a) : 0;
5374}
5375
5376/* Return the value of the unsigned attribute designated by ATTR_KIND, or 0
5377   if it is not present.  */
5378
5379static inline unsigned
5380get_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5381{
5382  dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
5383
5384  return a ? AT_unsigned (a) : 0;
5385}
5386
5387static inline dw_die_ref
5388get_AT_ref (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5389{
5390  dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
5391
5392  return a ? AT_ref (a) : NULL;
5393}
5394
5395static inline struct dwarf_file_data *
5396get_AT_file (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5397{
5398  dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
5399
5400  return a ? AT_file (a) : NULL;
5401}
5402
5403/* Return TRUE if the language is C or C++.  */
5404
5405static inline bool
5406is_c_family (void)
5407{
5408  unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language);
5409
5410  return (lang == DW_LANG_C || lang == DW_LANG_C89 || lang == DW_LANG_ObjC
5411	  || lang == DW_LANG_C99
5412	  || lang == DW_LANG_C_plus_plus || lang == DW_LANG_ObjC_plus_plus);
5413}
5414
5415/* Return TRUE if the language is C++.  */
5416
5417static inline bool
5418is_cxx (void)
5419{
5420  unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language);
5421
5422  return lang == DW_LANG_C_plus_plus || lang == DW_LANG_ObjC_plus_plus;
5423}
5424
5425/* Return TRUE if the language is Fortran.  */
5426
5427static inline bool
5428is_fortran (void)
5429{
5430  unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language);
5431
5432  return (lang == DW_LANG_Fortran77
5433	  || lang == DW_LANG_Fortran90
5434	  || lang == DW_LANG_Fortran95);
5435}
5436
5437/* Return TRUE if the language is Java.  */
5438
5439static inline bool
5440is_java (void)
5441{
5442  unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language);
5443
5444  return lang == DW_LANG_Java;
5445}
5446
5447/* Return TRUE if the language is Ada.  */
5448
5449static inline bool
5450is_ada (void)
5451{
5452  unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language);
5453
5454  return lang == DW_LANG_Ada95 || lang == DW_LANG_Ada83;
5455}
5456
5457/* Remove the specified attribute if present.  */
5458
5459static void
5460remove_AT (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5461{
5462  dw_attr_ref a;
5463  unsigned ix;
5464
5465  if (! die)
5466    return;
5467
5468  for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
5469    if (a->dw_attr == attr_kind)
5470      {
5471	if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str)
5472	  if (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->refcount)
5473	    a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->refcount--;
5474
5475	/* VEC_ordered_remove should help reduce the number of abbrevs
5476	   that are needed.  */
5477	VEC_ordered_remove (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix);
5478	return;
5479      }
5480}
5481
5482/* Remove CHILD from its parent.  PREV must have the property that
5483   PREV->DIE_SIB == CHILD.  Does not alter CHILD.  */
5484
5485static void
5486remove_child_with_prev (dw_die_ref child, dw_die_ref prev)
5487{
5488  gcc_assert (child->die_parent == prev->die_parent);
5489  gcc_assert (prev->die_sib == child);
5490  if (prev == child)
5491    {
5492      gcc_assert (child->die_parent->die_child == child);
5493      prev = NULL;
5494    }
5495  else
5496    prev->die_sib = child->die_sib;
5497  if (child->die_parent->die_child == child)
5498    child->die_parent->die_child = prev;
5499}
5500
5501/* Remove child DIE whose die_tag is TAG.  Do nothing if no child
5502   matches TAG.  */
5503
5504static void
5505remove_child_TAG (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_tag tag)
5506{
5507  dw_die_ref c;
5508
5509  c = die->die_child;
5510  if (c) do {
5511    dw_die_ref prev = c;
5512    c = c->die_sib;
5513    while (c->die_tag == tag)
5514      {
5515	remove_child_with_prev (c, prev);
5516	/* Might have removed every child.  */
5517	if (c == c->die_sib)
5518	  return;
5519	c = c->die_sib;
5520      }
5521  } while (c != die->die_child);
5522}
5523
5524/* Add a CHILD_DIE as the last child of DIE.  */
5525
5526static void
5527add_child_die (dw_die_ref die, dw_die_ref child_die)
5528{
5529  /* FIXME this should probably be an assert.  */
5530  if (! die || ! child_die)
5531    return;
5532  gcc_assert (die != child_die);
5533
5534  child_die->die_parent = die;
5535  if (die->die_child)
5536    {
5537      child_die->die_sib = die->die_child->die_sib;
5538      die->die_child->die_sib = child_die;
5539    }
5540  else
5541    child_die->die_sib = child_die;
5542  die->die_child = child_die;
5543}
5544
5545/* Move CHILD, which must be a child of PARENT or the DIE for which PARENT
5546   is the specification, to the end of PARENT's list of children.
5547   This is done by removing and re-adding it.  */
5548
5549static void
5550splice_child_die (dw_die_ref parent, dw_die_ref child)
5551{
5552  dw_die_ref p;
5553
5554  /* We want the declaration DIE from inside the class, not the
5555     specification DIE at toplevel.  */
5556  if (child->die_parent != parent)
5557    {
5558      dw_die_ref tmp = get_AT_ref (child, DW_AT_specification);
5559
5560      if (tmp)
5561	child = tmp;
5562    }
5563
5564  gcc_assert (child->die_parent == parent
5565	      || (child->die_parent
5566		  == get_AT_ref (parent, DW_AT_specification)));
5567
5568  for (p = child->die_parent->die_child; ; p = p->die_sib)
5569    if (p->die_sib == child)
5570      {
5571	remove_child_with_prev (child, p);
5572	break;
5573      }
5574
5575  add_child_die (parent, child);
5576}
5577
5578/* Return a pointer to a newly created DIE node.  */
5579
5580static inline dw_die_ref
5581new_die (enum dwarf_tag tag_value, dw_die_ref parent_die, tree t)
5582{
5583  dw_die_ref die = ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (die_node));
5584
5585  die->die_tag = tag_value;
5586
5587  if (parent_die != NULL)
5588    add_child_die (parent_die, die);
5589  else
5590    {
5591      limbo_die_node *limbo_node;
5592
5593      limbo_node = ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (limbo_die_node));
5594      limbo_node->die = die;
5595      limbo_node->created_for = t;
5596      limbo_node->next = limbo_die_list;
5597      limbo_die_list = limbo_node;
5598    }
5599
5600  return die;
5601}
5602
5603/* Return the DIE associated with the given type specifier.  */
5604
5605static inline dw_die_ref
5606lookup_type_die (tree type)
5607{
5608  return TYPE_SYMTAB_DIE (type);
5609}
5610
5611/* Equate a DIE to a given type specifier.  */
5612
5613static inline void
5614equate_type_number_to_die (tree type, dw_die_ref type_die)
5615{
5616  TYPE_SYMTAB_DIE (type) = type_die;
5617}
5618
5619/* Returns a hash value for X (which really is a die_struct).  */
5620
5621static hashval_t
5622decl_die_table_hash (const void *x)
5623{
5624  return (hashval_t) ((const dw_die_ref) x)->decl_id;
5625}
5626
5627/* Return nonzero if decl_id of die_struct X is the same as UID of decl *Y.  */
5628
5629static int
5630decl_die_table_eq (const void *x, const void *y)
5631{
5632  return (((const dw_die_ref) x)->decl_id == DECL_UID ((const tree) y));
5633}
5634
5635/* Return the DIE associated with a given declaration.  */
5636
5637static inline dw_die_ref
5638lookup_decl_die (tree decl)
5639{
5640  return htab_find_with_hash (decl_die_table, decl, DECL_UID (decl));
5641}
5642
5643/* Returns a hash value for X (which really is a var_loc_list).  */
5644
5645static hashval_t
5646decl_loc_table_hash (const void *x)
5647{
5648  return (hashval_t) ((const var_loc_list *) x)->decl_id;
5649}
5650
5651/* Return nonzero if decl_id of var_loc_list X is the same as
5652   UID of decl *Y.  */
5653
5654static int
5655decl_loc_table_eq (const void *x, const void *y)
5656{
5657  return (((const var_loc_list *) x)->decl_id == DECL_UID ((const tree) y));
5658}
5659
5660/* Return the var_loc list associated with a given declaration.  */
5661
5662static inline var_loc_list *
5663lookup_decl_loc (tree decl)
5664{
5665  return htab_find_with_hash (decl_loc_table, decl, DECL_UID (decl));
5666}
5667
5668/* Equate a DIE to a particular declaration.  */
5669
5670static void
5671equate_decl_number_to_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref decl_die)
5672{
5673  unsigned int decl_id = DECL_UID (decl);
5674  void **slot;
5675
5676  slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (decl_die_table, decl, decl_id, INSERT);
5677  *slot = decl_die;
5678  decl_die->decl_id = decl_id;
5679}
5680
5681/* Add a variable location node to the linked list for DECL.  */
5682
5683static void
5684add_var_loc_to_decl (tree decl, struct var_loc_node *loc)
5685{
5686  unsigned int decl_id = DECL_UID (decl);
5687  var_loc_list *temp;
5688  void **slot;
5689
5690  slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (decl_loc_table, decl, decl_id, INSERT);
5691  if (*slot == NULL)
5692    {
5693      temp = ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (var_loc_list));
5694      temp->decl_id = decl_id;
5695      *slot = temp;
5696    }
5697  else
5698    temp = *slot;
5699
5700  if (temp->last)
5701    {
5702      /* If the current location is the same as the end of the list,
5703	 we have nothing to do.  */
5704      if (!rtx_equal_p (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (temp->last->var_loc_note),
5705			NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (loc->var_loc_note)))
5706	{
5707	  /* Add LOC to the end of list and update LAST.  */
5708	  temp->last->next = loc;
5709	  temp->last = loc;
5710	}
5711    }
5712  /* Do not add empty location to the beginning of the list.  */
5713  else if (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (loc->var_loc_note) != NULL_RTX)
5714    {
5715      temp->first = loc;
5716      temp->last = loc;
5717    }
5718}
5719
5720/* Keep track of the number of spaces used to indent the
5721   output of the debugging routines that print the structure of
5722   the DIE internal representation.  */
5723static int print_indent;
5724
5725/* Indent the line the number of spaces given by print_indent.  */
5726
5727static inline void
5728print_spaces (FILE *outfile)
5729{
5730  fprintf (outfile, "%*s", print_indent, "");
5731}
5732
5733/* Print the information associated with a given DIE, and its children.
5734   This routine is a debugging aid only.  */
5735
5736static void
5737print_die (dw_die_ref die, FILE *outfile)
5738{
5739  dw_attr_ref a;
5740  dw_die_ref c;
5741  unsigned ix;
5742
5743  print_spaces (outfile);
5744  fprintf (outfile, "DIE %4lu: %s\n",
5745	   die->die_offset, dwarf_tag_name (die->die_tag));
5746  print_spaces (outfile);
5747  fprintf (outfile, "  abbrev id: %lu", die->die_abbrev);
5748  fprintf (outfile, " offset: %lu\n", die->die_offset);
5749
5750  for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
5751    {
5752      print_spaces (outfile);
5753      fprintf (outfile, "  %s: ", dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr));
5754
5755      switch (AT_class (a))
5756	{
5757	case dw_val_class_addr:
5758	  fprintf (outfile, "address");
5759	  break;
5760	case dw_val_class_offset:
5761	  fprintf (outfile, "offset");
5762	  break;
5763	case dw_val_class_loc:
5764	  fprintf (outfile, "location descriptor");
5765	  break;
5766	case dw_val_class_loc_list:
5767	  fprintf (outfile, "location list -> label:%s",
5768		   AT_loc_list (a)->ll_symbol);
5769	  break;
5770	case dw_val_class_range_list:
5771	  fprintf (outfile, "range list");
5772	  break;
5773	case dw_val_class_const:
5774	  fprintf (outfile, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC, AT_int (a));
5775	  break;
5776	case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
5777	  fprintf (outfile, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_UNSIGNED, AT_unsigned (a));
5778	  break;
5779	case dw_val_class_long_long:
5780	  fprintf (outfile, "constant (%lu,%lu)",
5781		   a->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.hi,
5782		   a->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.low);
5783	  break;
5784	case dw_val_class_vec:
5785	  fprintf (outfile, "floating-point or vector constant");
5786	  break;
5787	case dw_val_class_flag:
5788	  fprintf (outfile, "%u", AT_flag (a));
5789	  break;
5790	case dw_val_class_die_ref:
5791	  if (AT_ref (a) != NULL)
5792	    {
5793	      if (AT_ref (a)->die_symbol)
5794		fprintf (outfile, "die -> label: %s", AT_ref (a)->die_symbol);
5795	      else
5796		fprintf (outfile, "die -> %lu", AT_ref (a)->die_offset);
5797	    }
5798	  else
5799	    fprintf (outfile, "die -> <null>");
5800	  break;
5801	case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
5802	case dw_val_class_lineptr:
5803	case dw_val_class_macptr:
5804	  fprintf (outfile, "label: %s", AT_lbl (a));
5805	  break;
5806	case dw_val_class_str:
5807	  if (AT_string (a) != NULL)
5808	    fprintf (outfile, "\"%s\"", AT_string (a));
5809	  else
5810	    fprintf (outfile, "<null>");
5811	  break;
5812	case dw_val_class_file:
5813	  fprintf (outfile, "\"%s\" (%d)", AT_file (a)->filename,
5814		   AT_file (a)->emitted_number);
5815	  break;
5816	default:
5817	  break;
5818	}
5819
5820      fprintf (outfile, "\n");
5821    }
5822
5823  if (die->die_child != NULL)
5824    {
5825      print_indent += 4;
5826      FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, print_die (c, outfile));
5827      print_indent -= 4;
5828    }
5829  if (print_indent == 0)
5830    fprintf (outfile, "\n");
5831}
5832
5833/* Print the contents of the source code line number correspondence table.
5834   This routine is a debugging aid only.  */
5835
5836static void
5837print_dwarf_line_table (FILE *outfile)
5838{
5839  unsigned i;
5840  dw_line_info_ref line_info;
5841
5842  fprintf (outfile, "\n\nDWARF source line information\n");
5843  for (i = 1; i < line_info_table_in_use; i++)
5844    {
5845      line_info = &line_info_table[i];
5846      fprintf (outfile, "%5d: %4ld %6ld\n", i,
5847	       line_info->dw_file_num,
5848	       line_info->dw_line_num);
5849    }
5850
5851  fprintf (outfile, "\n\n");
5852}
5853
5854/* Print the information collected for a given DIE.  */
5855
5856void
5857debug_dwarf_die (dw_die_ref die)
5858{
5859  print_die (die, stderr);
5860}
5861
5862/* Print all DWARF information collected for the compilation unit.
5863   This routine is a debugging aid only.  */
5864
5865void
5866debug_dwarf (void)
5867{
5868  print_indent = 0;
5869  print_die (comp_unit_die, stderr);
5870  if (! DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
5871    print_dwarf_line_table (stderr);
5872}
5873
5874/* Start a new compilation unit DIE for an include file.  OLD_UNIT is the CU
5875   for the enclosing include file, if any.  BINCL_DIE is the DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL
5876   DIE that marks the start of the DIEs for this include file.  */
5877
5878static dw_die_ref
5879push_new_compile_unit (dw_die_ref old_unit, dw_die_ref bincl_die)
5880{
5881  const char *filename = get_AT_string (bincl_die, DW_AT_name);
5882  dw_die_ref new_unit = gen_compile_unit_die (filename);
5883
5884  new_unit->die_sib = old_unit;
5885  return new_unit;
5886}
5887
5888/* Close an include-file CU and reopen the enclosing one.  */
5889
5890static dw_die_ref
5891pop_compile_unit (dw_die_ref old_unit)
5892{
5893  dw_die_ref new_unit = old_unit->die_sib;
5894
5895  old_unit->die_sib = NULL;
5896  return new_unit;
5897}
5898
5899#define CHECKSUM(FOO) md5_process_bytes (&(FOO), sizeof (FOO), ctx)
5900#define CHECKSUM_STRING(FOO) md5_process_bytes ((FOO), strlen (FOO), ctx)
5901
5902/* Calculate the checksum of a location expression.  */
5903
5904static inline void
5905loc_checksum (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, struct md5_ctx *ctx)
5906{
5907  CHECKSUM (loc->dw_loc_opc);
5908  CHECKSUM (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1);
5909  CHECKSUM (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2);
5910}
5911
5912/* Calculate the checksum of an attribute.  */
5913
5914static void
5915attr_checksum (dw_attr_ref at, struct md5_ctx *ctx, int *mark)
5916{
5917  dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
5918  rtx r;
5919
5920  CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr);
5921
5922  /* We don't care that this was compiled with a different compiler
5923     snapshot; if the output is the same, that's what matters.  */
5924  if (at->dw_attr == DW_AT_producer)
5925    return;
5926
5927  switch (AT_class (at))
5928    {
5929    case dw_val_class_const:
5930      CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_int);
5931      break;
5932    case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
5933      CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned);
5934      break;
5935    case dw_val_class_long_long:
5936      CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long);
5937      break;
5938    case dw_val_class_vec:
5939      CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec);
5940      break;
5941    case dw_val_class_flag:
5942      CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag);
5943      break;
5944    case dw_val_class_str:
5945      CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_string (at));
5946      break;
5947
5948    case dw_val_class_addr:
5949      r = AT_addr (at);
5950      gcc_assert (GET_CODE (r) == SYMBOL_REF);
5951      CHECKSUM_STRING (XSTR (r, 0));
5952      break;
5953
5954    case dw_val_class_offset:
5955      CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset);
5956      break;
5957
5958    case dw_val_class_loc:
5959      for (loc = AT_loc (at); loc; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
5960	loc_checksum (loc, ctx);
5961      break;
5962
5963    case dw_val_class_die_ref:
5964      die_checksum (AT_ref (at), ctx, mark);
5965      break;
5966
5967    case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
5968    case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
5969    case dw_val_class_lineptr:
5970    case dw_val_class_macptr:
5971      break;
5972
5973    case dw_val_class_file:
5974      CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_file (at)->filename);
5975      break;
5976
5977    default:
5978      break;
5979    }
5980}
5981
5982/* Calculate the checksum of a DIE.  */
5983
5984static void
5985die_checksum (dw_die_ref die, struct md5_ctx *ctx, int *mark)
5986{
5987  dw_die_ref c;
5988  dw_attr_ref a;
5989  unsigned ix;
5990
5991  /* To avoid infinite recursion.  */
5992  if (die->die_mark)
5993    {
5994      CHECKSUM (die->die_mark);
5995      return;
5996    }
5997  die->die_mark = ++(*mark);
5998
5999  CHECKSUM (die->die_tag);
6000
6001  for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
6002    attr_checksum (a, ctx, mark);
6003
6004  FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, die_checksum (c, ctx, mark));
6005}
6006
6007#undef CHECKSUM
6008#undef CHECKSUM_STRING
6009
6010/* Do the location expressions look same?  */
6011static inline int
6012same_loc_p (dw_loc_descr_ref loc1, dw_loc_descr_ref loc2, int *mark)
6013{
6014  return loc1->dw_loc_opc == loc2->dw_loc_opc
6015	 && same_dw_val_p (&loc1->dw_loc_oprnd1, &loc2->dw_loc_oprnd1, mark)
6016	 && same_dw_val_p (&loc1->dw_loc_oprnd2, &loc2->dw_loc_oprnd2, mark);
6017}
6018
6019/* Do the values look the same?  */
6020static int
6021same_dw_val_p (dw_val_node *v1, dw_val_node *v2, int *mark)
6022{
6023  dw_loc_descr_ref loc1, loc2;
6024  rtx r1, r2;
6025
6026  if (v1->val_class != v2->val_class)
6027    return 0;
6028
6029  switch (v1->val_class)
6030    {
6031    case dw_val_class_const:
6032      return v1->v.val_int == v2->v.val_int;
6033    case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
6034      return v1->v.val_unsigned == v2->v.val_unsigned;
6035    case dw_val_class_long_long:
6036      return v1->v.val_long_long.hi == v2->v.val_long_long.hi
6037	     && v1->v.val_long_long.low == v2->v.val_long_long.low;
6038    case dw_val_class_vec:
6039      if (v1->v.val_vec.length != v2->v.val_vec.length
6040	  || v1->v.val_vec.elt_size != v2->v.val_vec.elt_size)
6041	return 0;
6042      if (memcmp (v1->v.val_vec.array, v2->v.val_vec.array,
6043		  v1->v.val_vec.length * v1->v.val_vec.elt_size))
6044	return 0;
6045      return 1;
6046    case dw_val_class_flag:
6047      return v1->v.val_flag == v2->v.val_flag;
6048    case dw_val_class_str:
6049      return !strcmp(v1->v.val_str->str, v2->v.val_str->str);
6050
6051    case dw_val_class_addr:
6052      r1 = v1->v.val_addr;
6053      r2 = v2->v.val_addr;
6054      if (GET_CODE (r1) != GET_CODE (r2))
6055	return 0;
6056      gcc_assert (GET_CODE (r1) == SYMBOL_REF);
6057      return !strcmp (XSTR (r1, 0), XSTR (r2, 0));
6058
6059    case dw_val_class_offset:
6060      return v1->v.val_offset == v2->v.val_offset;
6061
6062    case dw_val_class_loc:
6063      for (loc1 = v1->v.val_loc, loc2 = v2->v.val_loc;
6064	   loc1 && loc2;
6065	   loc1 = loc1->dw_loc_next, loc2 = loc2->dw_loc_next)
6066	if (!same_loc_p (loc1, loc2, mark))
6067	  return 0;
6068      return !loc1 && !loc2;
6069
6070    case dw_val_class_die_ref:
6071      return same_die_p (v1->v.val_die_ref.die, v2->v.val_die_ref.die, mark);
6072
6073    case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
6074    case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
6075    case dw_val_class_lineptr:
6076    case dw_val_class_macptr:
6077      return 1;
6078
6079    case dw_val_class_file:
6080      return v1->v.val_file == v2->v.val_file;
6081
6082    default:
6083      return 1;
6084    }
6085}
6086
6087/* Do the attributes look the same?  */
6088
6089static int
6090same_attr_p (dw_attr_ref at1, dw_attr_ref at2, int *mark)
6091{
6092  if (at1->dw_attr != at2->dw_attr)
6093    return 0;
6094
6095  /* We don't care that this was compiled with a different compiler
6096     snapshot; if the output is the same, that's what matters. */
6097  if (at1->dw_attr == DW_AT_producer)
6098    return 1;
6099
6100  return same_dw_val_p (&at1->dw_attr_val, &at2->dw_attr_val, mark);
6101}
6102
6103/* Do the dies look the same?  */
6104
6105static int
6106same_die_p (dw_die_ref die1, dw_die_ref die2, int *mark)
6107{
6108  dw_die_ref c1, c2;
6109  dw_attr_ref a1;
6110  unsigned ix;
6111
6112  /* To avoid infinite recursion.  */
6113  if (die1->die_mark)
6114    return die1->die_mark == die2->die_mark;
6115  die1->die_mark = die2->die_mark = ++(*mark);
6116
6117  if (die1->die_tag != die2->die_tag)
6118    return 0;
6119
6120  if (VEC_length (dw_attr_node, die1->die_attr)
6121      != VEC_length (dw_attr_node, die2->die_attr))
6122    return 0;
6123
6124  for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die1->die_attr, ix, a1); ix++)
6125    if (!same_attr_p (a1, VEC_index (dw_attr_node, die2->die_attr, ix), mark))
6126      return 0;
6127
6128  c1 = die1->die_child;
6129  c2 = die2->die_child;
6130  if (! c1)
6131    {
6132      if (c2)
6133	return 0;
6134    }
6135  else
6136    for (;;)
6137      {
6138	if (!same_die_p (c1, c2, mark))
6139	  return 0;
6140	c1 = c1->die_sib;
6141	c2 = c2->die_sib;
6142	if (c1 == die1->die_child)
6143	  {
6144	    if (c2 == die2->die_child)
6145	      break;
6146	    else
6147	      return 0;
6148	  }
6149    }
6150
6151  return 1;
6152}
6153
6154/* Do the dies look the same?  Wrapper around same_die_p.  */
6155
6156static int
6157same_die_p_wrap (dw_die_ref die1, dw_die_ref die2)
6158{
6159  int mark = 0;
6160  int ret = same_die_p (die1, die2, &mark);
6161
6162  unmark_all_dies (die1);
6163  unmark_all_dies (die2);
6164
6165  return ret;
6166}
6167
6168/* The prefix to attach to symbols on DIEs in the current comdat debug
6169   info section.  */
6170static char *comdat_symbol_id;
6171
6172/* The index of the current symbol within the current comdat CU.  */
6173static unsigned int comdat_symbol_number;
6174
6175/* Calculate the MD5 checksum of the compilation unit DIE UNIT_DIE and its
6176   children, and set comdat_symbol_id accordingly.  */
6177
6178static void
6179compute_section_prefix (dw_die_ref unit_die)
6180{
6181  const char *die_name = get_AT_string (unit_die, DW_AT_name);
6182  const char *base = die_name ? lbasename (die_name) : "anonymous";
6183  char *name = alloca (strlen (base) + 64);
6184  char *p;
6185  int i, mark;
6186  unsigned char checksum[16];
6187  struct md5_ctx ctx;
6188
6189  /* Compute the checksum of the DIE, then append part of it as hex digits to
6190     the name filename of the unit.  */
6191
6192  md5_init_ctx (&ctx);
6193  mark = 0;
6194  die_checksum (unit_die, &ctx, &mark);
6195  unmark_all_dies (unit_die);
6196  md5_finish_ctx (&ctx, checksum);
6197
6198  sprintf (name, "%s.", base);
6199  clean_symbol_name (name);
6200
6201  p = name + strlen (name);
6202  for (i = 0; i < 4; i++)
6203    {
6204      sprintf (p, "%.2x", checksum[i]);
6205      p += 2;
6206    }
6207
6208  comdat_symbol_id = unit_die->die_symbol = xstrdup (name);
6209  comdat_symbol_number = 0;
6210}
6211
6212/* Returns nonzero if DIE represents a type, in the sense of TYPE_P.  */
6213
6214static int
6215is_type_die (dw_die_ref die)
6216{
6217  switch (die->die_tag)
6218    {
6219    case DW_TAG_array_type:
6220    case DW_TAG_class_type:
6221    case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
6222    case DW_TAG_pointer_type:
6223    case DW_TAG_reference_type:
6224    case DW_TAG_string_type:
6225    case DW_TAG_structure_type:
6226    case DW_TAG_subroutine_type:
6227    case DW_TAG_union_type:
6228    case DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type:
6229    case DW_TAG_set_type:
6230    case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
6231    case DW_TAG_base_type:
6232    case DW_TAG_const_type:
6233    case DW_TAG_file_type:
6234    case DW_TAG_packed_type:
6235    case DW_TAG_volatile_type:
6236    case DW_TAG_typedef:
6237      return 1;
6238    default:
6239      return 0;
6240    }
6241}
6242
6243/* Returns 1 iff C is the sort of DIE that should go into a COMDAT CU.
6244   Basically, we want to choose the bits that are likely to be shared between
6245   compilations (types) and leave out the bits that are specific to individual
6246   compilations (functions).  */
6247
6248static int
6249is_comdat_die (dw_die_ref c)
6250{
6251  /* I think we want to leave base types and __vtbl_ptr_type in the main CU, as
6252     we do for stabs.  The advantage is a greater likelihood of sharing between
6253     objects that don't include headers in the same order (and therefore would
6254     put the base types in a different comdat).  jason 8/28/00 */
6255
6256  if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_base_type)
6257    return 0;
6258
6259  if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_pointer_type
6260      || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_reference_type
6261      || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_const_type
6262      || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_volatile_type)
6263    {
6264      dw_die_ref t = get_AT_ref (c, DW_AT_type);
6265
6266      return t ? is_comdat_die (t) : 0;
6267    }
6268
6269  return is_type_die (c);
6270}
6271
6272/* Returns 1 iff C is the sort of DIE that might be referred to from another
6273   compilation unit.  */
6274
6275static int
6276is_symbol_die (dw_die_ref c)
6277{
6278  return (is_type_die (c)
6279	  || (get_AT (c, DW_AT_declaration)
6280	      && !get_AT (c, DW_AT_specification))
6281	  || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_namespace);
6282}
6283
6284static char *
6285gen_internal_sym (const char *prefix)
6286{
6287  char buf[256];
6288
6289  ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (buf, prefix, label_num++);
6290  return xstrdup (buf);
6291}
6292
6293/* Assign symbols to all worthy DIEs under DIE.  */
6294
6295static void
6296assign_symbol_names (dw_die_ref die)
6297{
6298  dw_die_ref c;
6299
6300  if (is_symbol_die (die))
6301    {
6302      if (comdat_symbol_id)
6303	{
6304	  char *p = alloca (strlen (comdat_symbol_id) + 64);
6305
6306	  sprintf (p, "%s.%s.%x", DIE_LABEL_PREFIX,
6307		   comdat_symbol_id, comdat_symbol_number++);
6308	  die->die_symbol = xstrdup (p);
6309	}
6310      else
6311	die->die_symbol = gen_internal_sym ("LDIE");
6312    }
6313
6314  FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, assign_symbol_names (c));
6315}
6316
6317struct cu_hash_table_entry
6318{
6319  dw_die_ref cu;
6320  unsigned min_comdat_num, max_comdat_num;
6321  struct cu_hash_table_entry *next;
6322};
6323
6324/* Routines to manipulate hash table of CUs.  */
6325static hashval_t
6326htab_cu_hash (const void *of)
6327{
6328  const struct cu_hash_table_entry *entry = of;
6329
6330  return htab_hash_string (entry->cu->die_symbol);
6331}
6332
6333static int
6334htab_cu_eq (const void *of1, const void *of2)
6335{
6336  const struct cu_hash_table_entry *entry1 = of1;
6337  const struct die_struct *entry2 = of2;
6338
6339  return !strcmp (entry1->cu->die_symbol, entry2->die_symbol);
6340}
6341
6342static void
6343htab_cu_del (void *what)
6344{
6345  struct cu_hash_table_entry *next, *entry = what;
6346
6347  while (entry)
6348    {
6349      next = entry->next;
6350      free (entry);
6351      entry = next;
6352    }
6353}
6354
6355/* Check whether we have already seen this CU and set up SYM_NUM
6356   accordingly.  */
6357static int
6358check_duplicate_cu (dw_die_ref cu, htab_t htable, unsigned int *sym_num)
6359{
6360  struct cu_hash_table_entry dummy;
6361  struct cu_hash_table_entry **slot, *entry, *last = &dummy;
6362
6363  dummy.max_comdat_num = 0;
6364
6365  slot = (struct cu_hash_table_entry **)
6366    htab_find_slot_with_hash (htable, cu, htab_hash_string (cu->die_symbol),
6367	INSERT);
6368  entry = *slot;
6369
6370  for (; entry; last = entry, entry = entry->next)
6371    {
6372      if (same_die_p_wrap (cu, entry->cu))
6373	break;
6374    }
6375
6376  if (entry)
6377    {
6378      *sym_num = entry->min_comdat_num;
6379      return 1;
6380    }
6381
6382  entry = XCNEW (struct cu_hash_table_entry);
6383  entry->cu = cu;
6384  entry->min_comdat_num = *sym_num = last->max_comdat_num;
6385  entry->next = *slot;
6386  *slot = entry;
6387
6388  return 0;
6389}
6390
6391/* Record SYM_NUM to record of CU in HTABLE.  */
6392static void
6393record_comdat_symbol_number (dw_die_ref cu, htab_t htable, unsigned int sym_num)
6394{
6395  struct cu_hash_table_entry **slot, *entry;
6396
6397  slot = (struct cu_hash_table_entry **)
6398    htab_find_slot_with_hash (htable, cu, htab_hash_string (cu->die_symbol),
6399	NO_INSERT);
6400  entry = *slot;
6401
6402  entry->max_comdat_num = sym_num;
6403}
6404
6405/* Traverse the DIE (which is always comp_unit_die), and set up
6406   additional compilation units for each of the include files we see
6407   bracketed by BINCL/EINCL.  */
6408
6409static void
6410break_out_includes (dw_die_ref die)
6411{
6412  dw_die_ref c;
6413  dw_die_ref unit = NULL;
6414  limbo_die_node *node, **pnode;
6415  htab_t cu_hash_table;
6416
6417  c = die->die_child;
6418  if (c) do {
6419    dw_die_ref prev = c;
6420    c = c->die_sib;
6421    while (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL
6422	   || (unit && is_comdat_die (c)))
6423      {
6424	dw_die_ref next = c->die_sib;
6425
6426	/* This DIE is for a secondary CU; remove it from the main one.  */
6427	remove_child_with_prev (c, prev);
6428
6429	if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL)
6430	  unit = push_new_compile_unit (unit, c);
6431	else if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL)
6432	  unit = pop_compile_unit (unit);
6433	else
6434	  add_child_die (unit, c);
6435	c = next;
6436	if (c == die->die_child)
6437	  break;
6438      }
6439  } while (c != die->die_child);
6440
6441#if 0
6442  /* We can only use this in debugging, since the frontend doesn't check
6443     to make sure that we leave every include file we enter.  */
6444  gcc_assert (!unit);
6445#endif
6446
6447  assign_symbol_names (die);
6448  cu_hash_table = htab_create (10, htab_cu_hash, htab_cu_eq, htab_cu_del);
6449  for (node = limbo_die_list, pnode = &limbo_die_list;
6450       node;
6451       node = node->next)
6452    {
6453      int is_dupl;
6454
6455      compute_section_prefix (node->die);
6456      is_dupl = check_duplicate_cu (node->die, cu_hash_table,
6457			&comdat_symbol_number);
6458      assign_symbol_names (node->die);
6459      if (is_dupl)
6460	*pnode = node->next;
6461      else
6462	{
6463	  pnode = &node->next;
6464	  record_comdat_symbol_number (node->die, cu_hash_table,
6465		comdat_symbol_number);
6466	}
6467    }
6468  htab_delete (cu_hash_table);
6469}
6470
6471/* Traverse the DIE and add a sibling attribute if it may have the
6472   effect of speeding up access to siblings.  To save some space,
6473   avoid generating sibling attributes for DIE's without children.  */
6474
6475static void
6476add_sibling_attributes (dw_die_ref die)
6477{
6478  dw_die_ref c;
6479
6480  if (! die->die_child)
6481    return;
6482
6483  if (die->die_parent && die != die->die_parent->die_child)
6484    add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_sibling, die->die_sib);
6485
6486  FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, add_sibling_attributes (c));
6487}
6488
6489/* Output all location lists for the DIE and its children.  */
6490
6491static void
6492output_location_lists (dw_die_ref die)
6493{
6494  dw_die_ref c;
6495  dw_attr_ref a;
6496  unsigned ix;
6497
6498  for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
6499    if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc_list)
6500      output_loc_list (AT_loc_list (a));
6501
6502  FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, output_location_lists (c));
6503}
6504
6505/* The format of each DIE (and its attribute value pairs) is encoded in an
6506   abbreviation table.  This routine builds the abbreviation table and assigns
6507   a unique abbreviation id for each abbreviation entry.  The children of each
6508   die are visited recursively.  */
6509
6510static void
6511build_abbrev_table (dw_die_ref die)
6512{
6513  unsigned long abbrev_id;
6514  unsigned int n_alloc;
6515  dw_die_ref c;
6516  dw_attr_ref a;
6517  unsigned ix;
6518
6519  /* Scan the DIE references, and mark as external any that refer to
6520     DIEs from other CUs (i.e. those which are not marked).  */
6521  for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
6522    if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref
6523	&& AT_ref (a)->die_mark == 0)
6524      {
6525	gcc_assert (AT_ref (a)->die_symbol);
6526
6527	set_AT_ref_external (a, 1);
6528      }
6529
6530  for (abbrev_id = 1; abbrev_id < abbrev_die_table_in_use; ++abbrev_id)
6531    {
6532      dw_die_ref abbrev = abbrev_die_table[abbrev_id];
6533      dw_attr_ref die_a, abbrev_a;
6534      unsigned ix;
6535      bool ok = true;
6536
6537      if (abbrev->die_tag != die->die_tag)
6538	continue;
6539      if ((abbrev->die_child != NULL) != (die->die_child != NULL))
6540	continue;
6541
6542      if (VEC_length (dw_attr_node, abbrev->die_attr)
6543	  != VEC_length (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr))
6544	continue;
6545
6546      for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, die_a); ix++)
6547	{
6548	  abbrev_a = VEC_index (dw_attr_node, abbrev->die_attr, ix);
6549	  if ((abbrev_a->dw_attr != die_a->dw_attr)
6550	      || (value_format (abbrev_a) != value_format (die_a)))
6551	    {
6552	      ok = false;
6553	      break;
6554	    }
6555	}
6556      if (ok)
6557	break;
6558    }
6559
6560  if (abbrev_id >= abbrev_die_table_in_use)
6561    {
6562      if (abbrev_die_table_in_use >= abbrev_die_table_allocated)
6563	{
6564	  n_alloc = abbrev_die_table_allocated + ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
6565	  abbrev_die_table = ggc_realloc (abbrev_die_table,
6566					  sizeof (dw_die_ref) * n_alloc);
6567
6568	  memset (&abbrev_die_table[abbrev_die_table_allocated], 0,
6569		 (n_alloc - abbrev_die_table_allocated) * sizeof (dw_die_ref));
6570	  abbrev_die_table_allocated = n_alloc;
6571	}
6572
6573      ++abbrev_die_table_in_use;
6574      abbrev_die_table[abbrev_id] = die;
6575    }
6576
6577  die->die_abbrev = abbrev_id;
6578  FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, build_abbrev_table (c));
6579}
6580
6581/* Return the power-of-two number of bytes necessary to represent VALUE.  */
6582
6583static int
6584constant_size (long unsigned int value)
6585{
6586  int log;
6587
6588  if (value == 0)
6589    log = 0;
6590  else
6591    log = floor_log2 (value);
6592
6593  log = log / 8;
6594  log = 1 << (floor_log2 (log) + 1);
6595
6596  return log;
6597}
6598
6599/* Return the size of a DIE as it is represented in the
6600   .debug_info section.  */
6601
6602static unsigned long
6603size_of_die (dw_die_ref die)
6604{
6605  unsigned long size = 0;
6606  dw_attr_ref a;
6607  unsigned ix;
6608
6609  size += size_of_uleb128 (die->die_abbrev);
6610  for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
6611    {
6612      switch (AT_class (a))
6613	{
6614	case dw_val_class_addr:
6615	  size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
6616	  break;
6617	case dw_val_class_offset:
6618	  size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
6619	  break;
6620	case dw_val_class_loc:
6621	  {
6622	    unsigned long lsize = size_of_locs (AT_loc (a));
6623
6624	    /* Block length.  */
6625	    size += constant_size (lsize);
6626	    size += lsize;
6627	  }
6628	  break;
6629	case dw_val_class_loc_list:
6630	  size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
6631	  break;
6632	case dw_val_class_range_list:
6633	  size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
6634	  break;
6635	case dw_val_class_const:
6636	  size += size_of_sleb128 (AT_int (a));
6637	  break;
6638	case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
6639	  size += constant_size (AT_unsigned (a));
6640	  break;
6641	case dw_val_class_long_long:
6642	  size += 1 + 2*HOST_BITS_PER_LONG/HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR; /* block */
6643	  break;
6644	case dw_val_class_vec:
6645	  size += 1 + (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length
6646		       * a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size); /* block */
6647	  break;
6648	case dw_val_class_flag:
6649	  size += 1;
6650	  break;
6651	case dw_val_class_die_ref:
6652	  if (AT_ref_external (a))
6653	    size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
6654	  else
6655	    size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
6656	  break;
6657	case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
6658	  size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
6659	  break;
6660	case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
6661	  size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
6662	  break;
6663	case dw_val_class_lineptr:
6664	case dw_val_class_macptr:
6665	  size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
6666	  break;
6667	case dw_val_class_str:
6668	  if (AT_string_form (a) == DW_FORM_strp)
6669	    size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
6670	  else
6671	    size += strlen (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->str) + 1;
6672	  break;
6673	case dw_val_class_file:
6674	  size += constant_size (maybe_emit_file (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file));
6675	  break;
6676	default:
6677	  gcc_unreachable ();
6678	}
6679    }
6680
6681  return size;
6682}
6683
6684/* Size the debugging information associated with a given DIE.  Visits the
6685   DIE's children recursively.  Updates the global variable next_die_offset, on
6686   each time through.  Uses the current value of next_die_offset to update the
6687   die_offset field in each DIE.  */
6688
6689static void
6690calc_die_sizes (dw_die_ref die)
6691{
6692  dw_die_ref c;
6693
6694  die->die_offset = next_die_offset;
6695  next_die_offset += size_of_die (die);
6696
6697  FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, calc_die_sizes (c));
6698
6699  if (die->die_child != NULL)
6700    /* Count the null byte used to terminate sibling lists.  */
6701    next_die_offset += 1;
6702}
6703
6704/* Set the marks for a die and its children.  We do this so
6705   that we know whether or not a reference needs to use FORM_ref_addr; only
6706   DIEs in the same CU will be marked.  We used to clear out the offset
6707   and use that as the flag, but ran into ordering problems.  */
6708
6709static void
6710mark_dies (dw_die_ref die)
6711{
6712  dw_die_ref c;
6713
6714  gcc_assert (!die->die_mark);
6715
6716  die->die_mark = 1;
6717  FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, mark_dies (c));
6718}
6719
6720/* Clear the marks for a die and its children.  */
6721
6722static void
6723unmark_dies (dw_die_ref die)
6724{
6725  dw_die_ref c;
6726
6727  gcc_assert (die->die_mark);
6728
6729  die->die_mark = 0;
6730  FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, unmark_dies (c));
6731}
6732
6733/* Clear the marks for a die, its children and referred dies.  */
6734
6735static void
6736unmark_all_dies (dw_die_ref die)
6737{
6738  dw_die_ref c;
6739  dw_attr_ref a;
6740  unsigned ix;
6741
6742  if (!die->die_mark)
6743    return;
6744  die->die_mark = 0;
6745
6746  FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, unmark_all_dies (c));
6747
6748  for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
6749    if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref)
6750      unmark_all_dies (AT_ref (a));
6751}
6752
6753/* Return the size of the .debug_pubnames table  generated for the
6754   compilation unit.  */
6755
6756static unsigned long
6757size_of_pubnames (void)
6758{
6759  unsigned long size;
6760  unsigned i;
6761
6762  size = DWARF_PUBNAMES_HEADER_SIZE;
6763  for (i = 0; i < pubname_table_in_use; i++)
6764    {
6765      pubname_ref p = &pubname_table[i];
6766      size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + strlen (p->name) + 1;
6767    }
6768
6769  size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
6770  return size;
6771}
6772
6773/* Return the size of the information in the .debug_aranges section.  */
6774
6775static unsigned long
6776size_of_aranges (void)
6777{
6778  unsigned long size;
6779
6780  size = DWARF_ARANGES_HEADER_SIZE;
6781
6782  /* Count the address/length pair for this compilation unit.  */
6783  size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
6784  size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * arange_table_in_use;
6785
6786  /* Count the two zero words used to terminated the address range table.  */
6787  size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
6788  return size;
6789}
6790
6791/* Select the encoding of an attribute value.  */
6792
6793static enum dwarf_form
6794value_format (dw_attr_ref a)
6795{
6796  switch (a->dw_attr_val.val_class)
6797    {
6798    case dw_val_class_addr:
6799      return DW_FORM_addr;
6800    case dw_val_class_range_list:
6801    case dw_val_class_offset:
6802    case dw_val_class_loc_list:
6803      switch (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE)
6804	{
6805	case 4:
6806	  return DW_FORM_data4;
6807	case 8:
6808	  return DW_FORM_data8;
6809	default:
6810	  gcc_unreachable ();
6811	}
6812    case dw_val_class_loc:
6813      switch (constant_size (size_of_locs (AT_loc (a))))
6814	{
6815	case 1:
6816	  return DW_FORM_block1;
6817	case 2:
6818	  return DW_FORM_block2;
6819	default:
6820	  gcc_unreachable ();
6821	}
6822    case dw_val_class_const:
6823      return DW_FORM_sdata;
6824    case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
6825      switch (constant_size (AT_unsigned (a)))
6826	{
6827	case 1:
6828	  return DW_FORM_data1;
6829	case 2:
6830	  return DW_FORM_data2;
6831	case 4:
6832	  return DW_FORM_data4;
6833	case 8:
6834	  return DW_FORM_data8;
6835	default:
6836	  gcc_unreachable ();
6837	}
6838    case dw_val_class_long_long:
6839      return DW_FORM_block1;
6840    case dw_val_class_vec:
6841      return DW_FORM_block1;
6842    case dw_val_class_flag:
6843      return DW_FORM_flag;
6844    case dw_val_class_die_ref:
6845      if (AT_ref_external (a))
6846	return DW_FORM_ref_addr;
6847      else
6848	return DW_FORM_ref;
6849    case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
6850      return DW_FORM_data;
6851    case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
6852      return DW_FORM_addr;
6853    case dw_val_class_lineptr:
6854    case dw_val_class_macptr:
6855      return DW_FORM_data;
6856    case dw_val_class_str:
6857      return AT_string_form (a);
6858    case dw_val_class_file:
6859      switch (constant_size (maybe_emit_file (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file)))
6860	{
6861	case 1:
6862	  return DW_FORM_data1;
6863	case 2:
6864	  return DW_FORM_data2;
6865	case 4:
6866	  return DW_FORM_data4;
6867	default:
6868	  gcc_unreachable ();
6869	}
6870
6871    default:
6872      gcc_unreachable ();
6873    }
6874}
6875
6876/* Output the encoding of an attribute value.  */
6877
6878static void
6879output_value_format (dw_attr_ref a)
6880{
6881  enum dwarf_form form = value_format (a);
6882
6883  dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (form, "(%s)", dwarf_form_name (form));
6884}
6885
6886/* Output the .debug_abbrev section which defines the DIE abbreviation
6887   table.  */
6888
6889static void
6890output_abbrev_section (void)
6891{
6892  unsigned long abbrev_id;
6893
6894  for (abbrev_id = 1; abbrev_id < abbrev_die_table_in_use; ++abbrev_id)
6895    {
6896      dw_die_ref abbrev = abbrev_die_table[abbrev_id];
6897      unsigned ix;
6898      dw_attr_ref a_attr;
6899
6900      dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (abbrev_id, "(abbrev code)");
6901      dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (abbrev->die_tag, "(TAG: %s)",
6902				   dwarf_tag_name (abbrev->die_tag));
6903
6904      if (abbrev->die_child != NULL)
6905	dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_children_yes, "DW_children_yes");
6906      else
6907	dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_children_no, "DW_children_no");
6908
6909      for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, abbrev->die_attr, ix, a_attr);
6910	   ix++)
6911	{
6912	  dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (a_attr->dw_attr, "(%s)",
6913				       dwarf_attr_name (a_attr->dw_attr));
6914	  output_value_format (a_attr);
6915	}
6916
6917      dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, NULL);
6918      dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, NULL);
6919    }
6920
6921  /* Terminate the table.  */
6922  dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, NULL);
6923}
6924
6925/* Output a symbol we can use to refer to this DIE from another CU.  */
6926
6927static inline void
6928output_die_symbol (dw_die_ref die)
6929{
6930  char *sym = die->die_symbol;
6931
6932  if (sym == 0)
6933    return;
6934
6935  if (strncmp (sym, DIE_LABEL_PREFIX, sizeof (DIE_LABEL_PREFIX) - 1) == 0)
6936    /* We make these global, not weak; if the target doesn't support
6937       .linkonce, it doesn't support combining the sections, so debugging
6938       will break.  */
6939    targetm.asm_out.globalize_label (asm_out_file, sym);
6940
6941  ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, sym);
6942}
6943
6944/* Return a new location list, given the begin and end range, and the
6945   expression. gensym tells us whether to generate a new internal symbol for
6946   this location list node, which is done for the head of the list only.  */
6947
6948static inline dw_loc_list_ref
6949new_loc_list (dw_loc_descr_ref expr, const char *begin, const char *end,
6950	      const char *section, unsigned int gensym)
6951{
6952  dw_loc_list_ref retlist = ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (dw_loc_list_node));
6953
6954  retlist->begin = begin;
6955  retlist->end = end;
6956  retlist->expr = expr;
6957  retlist->section = section;
6958  if (gensym)
6959    retlist->ll_symbol = gen_internal_sym ("LLST");
6960
6961  return retlist;
6962}
6963
6964/* Add a location description expression to a location list.  */
6965
6966static inline void
6967add_loc_descr_to_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref *list_head, dw_loc_descr_ref descr,
6968			   const char *begin, const char *end,
6969			   const char *section)
6970{
6971  dw_loc_list_ref *d;
6972
6973  /* Find the end of the chain.  */
6974  for (d = list_head; (*d) != NULL; d = &(*d)->dw_loc_next)
6975    ;
6976
6977  /* Add a new location list node to the list.  */
6978  *d = new_loc_list (descr, begin, end, section, 0);
6979}
6980
6981static void
6982dwarf2out_switch_text_section (void)
6983{
6984  dw_fde_ref fde;
6985
6986  gcc_assert (cfun);
6987
6988  fde = &fde_table[fde_table_in_use - 1];
6989  fde->dw_fde_switched_sections = true;
6990  fde->dw_fde_hot_section_label = cfun->hot_section_label;
6991  fde->dw_fde_hot_section_end_label = cfun->hot_section_end_label;
6992  fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_label = cfun->cold_section_label;
6993  fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_end_label = cfun->cold_section_end_label;
6994  have_multiple_function_sections = true;
6995
6996  /* Reset the current label on switching text sections, so that we
6997     don't attempt to advance_loc4 between labels in different sections.  */
6998  fde->dw_fde_current_label = NULL;
6999}
7000
7001/* Output the location list given to us.  */
7002
7003static void
7004output_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref list_head)
7005{
7006  dw_loc_list_ref curr = list_head;
7007
7008  ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, list_head->ll_symbol);
7009
7010  /* Walk the location list, and output each range + expression.  */
7011  for (curr = list_head; curr != NULL; curr = curr->dw_loc_next)
7012    {
7013      unsigned long size;
7014      if (!have_multiple_function_sections)
7015	{
7016	  dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->begin, curr->section,
7017				"Location list begin address (%s)",
7018				list_head->ll_symbol);
7019	  dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->end, curr->section,
7020				"Location list end address (%s)",
7021				list_head->ll_symbol);
7022	}
7023      else
7024	{
7025	  dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->begin,
7026			       "Location list begin address (%s)",
7027			       list_head->ll_symbol);
7028	  dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->end,
7029			       "Location list end address (%s)",
7030			       list_head->ll_symbol);
7031	}
7032      size = size_of_locs (curr->expr);
7033
7034      /* Output the block length for this list of location operations.  */
7035      gcc_assert (size <= 0xffff);
7036      dw2_asm_output_data (2, size, "%s", "Location expression size");
7037
7038      output_loc_sequence (curr->expr);
7039    }
7040
7041  dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0,
7042		       "Location list terminator begin (%s)",
7043		       list_head->ll_symbol);
7044  dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0,
7045		       "Location list terminator end (%s)",
7046		       list_head->ll_symbol);
7047}
7048
7049/* Output the DIE and its attributes.  Called recursively to generate
7050   the definitions of each child DIE.  */
7051
7052static void
7053output_die (dw_die_ref die)
7054{
7055  dw_attr_ref a;
7056  dw_die_ref c;
7057  unsigned long size;
7058  unsigned ix;
7059
7060  /* If someone in another CU might refer to us, set up a symbol for
7061     them to point to.  */
7062  if (die->die_symbol)
7063    output_die_symbol (die);
7064
7065  dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (die->die_abbrev, "(DIE (0x%lx) %s)",
7066			       die->die_offset, dwarf_tag_name (die->die_tag));
7067
7068  for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
7069    {
7070      const char *name = dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr);
7071
7072      switch (AT_class (a))
7073	{
7074	case dw_val_class_addr:
7075	  dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, AT_addr (a), "%s", name);
7076	  break;
7077
7078	case dw_val_class_offset:
7079	  dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, a->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset,
7080			       "%s", name);
7081	  break;
7082
7083	case dw_val_class_range_list:
7084	  {
7085	    char *p = strchr (ranges_section_label, '\0');
7086
7087	    sprintf (p, "+" HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_HEX,
7088		     a->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset);
7089	    dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, ranges_section_label,
7090				   debug_ranges_section, "%s", name);
7091	    *p = '\0';
7092	  }
7093	  break;
7094
7095	case dw_val_class_loc:
7096	  size = size_of_locs (AT_loc (a));
7097
7098	  /* Output the block length for this list of location operations.  */
7099	  dw2_asm_output_data (constant_size (size), size, "%s", name);
7100
7101	  output_loc_sequence (AT_loc (a));
7102	  break;
7103
7104	case dw_val_class_const:
7105	  /* ??? It would be slightly more efficient to use a scheme like is
7106	     used for unsigned constants below, but gdb 4.x does not sign
7107	     extend.  Gdb 5.x does sign extend.  */
7108	  dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (AT_int (a), "%s", name);
7109	  break;
7110
7111	case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
7112	  dw2_asm_output_data (constant_size (AT_unsigned (a)),
7113			       AT_unsigned (a), "%s", name);
7114	  break;
7115
7116	case dw_val_class_long_long:
7117	  {
7118	    unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT first, second;
7119
7120	    dw2_asm_output_data (1,
7121				 2 * HOST_BITS_PER_LONG / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
7122				 "%s", name);
7123
7124	    if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
7125	      {
7126		first = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.hi;
7127		second = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.low;
7128	      }
7129	    else
7130	      {
7131		first = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.low;
7132		second = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.hi;
7133	      }
7134
7135	    dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_LONG / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
7136				 first, "long long constant");
7137	    dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_LONG / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
7138				 second, NULL);
7139	  }
7140	  break;
7141
7142	case dw_val_class_vec:
7143	  {
7144	    unsigned int elt_size = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size;
7145	    unsigned int len = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length;
7146	    unsigned int i;
7147	    unsigned char *p;
7148
7149	    dw2_asm_output_data (1, len * elt_size, "%s", name);
7150	    if (elt_size > sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT))
7151	      {
7152		elt_size /= 2;
7153		len *= 2;
7154	      }
7155	    for (i = 0, p = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.array;
7156		 i < len;
7157		 i++, p += elt_size)
7158	      dw2_asm_output_data (elt_size, extract_int (p, elt_size),
7159				   "fp or vector constant word %u", i);
7160	    break;
7161	  }
7162
7163	case dw_val_class_flag:
7164	  dw2_asm_output_data (1, AT_flag (a), "%s", name);
7165	  break;
7166
7167	case dw_val_class_loc_list:
7168	  {
7169	    char *sym = AT_loc_list (a)->ll_symbol;
7170
7171	    gcc_assert (sym);
7172	    dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, sym, debug_loc_section,
7173				   "%s", name);
7174	  }
7175	  break;
7176
7177	case dw_val_class_die_ref:
7178	  if (AT_ref_external (a))
7179	    {
7180	      char *sym = AT_ref (a)->die_symbol;
7181
7182	      gcc_assert (sym);
7183	      dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, sym, debug_info_section,
7184				     "%s", name);
7185	    }
7186	  else
7187	    {
7188	      gcc_assert (AT_ref (a)->die_offset);
7189	      dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, AT_ref (a)->die_offset,
7190				   "%s", name);
7191	    }
7192	  break;
7193
7194	case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
7195	  {
7196	    char l1[20];
7197
7198	    ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, FDE_LABEL,
7199					 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_fde_index * 2);
7200	    dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l1, debug_frame_section,
7201				   "%s", name);
7202	  }
7203	  break;
7204
7205	case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
7206	  dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, AT_lbl (a), "%s", name);
7207	  break;
7208
7209	case dw_val_class_lineptr:
7210	  dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, AT_lbl (a),
7211				 debug_line_section, "%s", name);
7212	  break;
7213
7214	case dw_val_class_macptr:
7215	  dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, AT_lbl (a),
7216				 debug_macinfo_section, "%s", name);
7217	  break;
7218
7219	case dw_val_class_str:
7220	  if (AT_string_form (a) == DW_FORM_strp)
7221	    dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
7222				   a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->label,
7223				   debug_str_section,
7224				   "%s: \"%s\"", name, AT_string (a));
7225	  else
7226	    dw2_asm_output_nstring (AT_string (a), -1, "%s", name);
7227	  break;
7228
7229	case dw_val_class_file:
7230	  {
7231	    int f = maybe_emit_file (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file);
7232
7233	    dw2_asm_output_data (constant_size (f), f, "%s (%s)", name,
7234				 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file->filename);
7235	    break;
7236	  }
7237
7238	default:
7239	  gcc_unreachable ();
7240	}
7241    }
7242
7243  FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, output_die (c));
7244
7245  /* Add null byte to terminate sibling list.  */
7246  if (die->die_child != NULL)
7247    dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "end of children of DIE 0x%lx",
7248			 die->die_offset);
7249}
7250
7251/* Output the compilation unit that appears at the beginning of the
7252   .debug_info section, and precedes the DIE descriptions.  */
7253
7254static void
7255output_compilation_unit_header (void)
7256{
7257  if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
7258    dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
7259      "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
7260  dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
7261                       next_die_offset - DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE,
7262		       "Length of Compilation Unit Info");
7263  dw2_asm_output_data (2, DWARF_VERSION, "DWARF version number");
7264  dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, abbrev_section_label,
7265			 debug_abbrev_section,
7266			 "Offset Into Abbrev. Section");
7267  dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Pointer Size (in bytes)");
7268}
7269
7270/* Output the compilation unit DIE and its children.  */
7271
7272static void
7273output_comp_unit (dw_die_ref die, int output_if_empty)
7274{
7275  const char *secname;
7276  char *oldsym, *tmp;
7277
7278  /* Unless we are outputting main CU, we may throw away empty ones.  */
7279  if (!output_if_empty && die->die_child == NULL)
7280    return;
7281
7282  /* Even if there are no children of this DIE, we must output the information
7283     about the compilation unit.  Otherwise, on an empty translation unit, we
7284     will generate a present, but empty, .debug_info section.  IRIX 6.5 `nm'
7285     will then complain when examining the file.  First mark all the DIEs in
7286     this CU so we know which get local refs.  */
7287  mark_dies (die);
7288
7289  build_abbrev_table (die);
7290
7291  /* Initialize the beginning DIE offset - and calculate sizes/offsets.  */
7292  next_die_offset = DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE;
7293  calc_die_sizes (die);
7294
7295  oldsym = die->die_symbol;
7296  if (oldsym)
7297    {
7298      tmp = alloca (strlen (oldsym) + 24);
7299
7300      sprintf (tmp, ".gnu.linkonce.wi.%s", oldsym);
7301      secname = tmp;
7302      die->die_symbol = NULL;
7303      switch_to_section (get_section (secname, SECTION_DEBUG, NULL));
7304    }
7305  else
7306    switch_to_section (debug_info_section);
7307
7308  /* Output debugging information.  */
7309  output_compilation_unit_header ();
7310  output_die (die);
7311
7312  /* Leave the marks on the main CU, so we can check them in
7313     output_pubnames.  */
7314  if (oldsym)
7315    {
7316      unmark_dies (die);
7317      die->die_symbol = oldsym;
7318    }
7319}
7320
7321/* Return the DWARF2/3 pubname associated with a decl.  */
7322
7323static const char *
7324dwarf2_name (tree decl, int scope)
7325{
7326  return lang_hooks.dwarf_name (decl, scope ? 1 : 0);
7327}
7328
7329/* Add a new entry to .debug_pubnames if appropriate.  */
7330
7331static void
7332add_pubname (tree decl, dw_die_ref die)
7333{
7334  pubname_ref p;
7335
7336  if (! TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
7337    return;
7338
7339  if (pubname_table_in_use == pubname_table_allocated)
7340    {
7341      pubname_table_allocated += PUBNAME_TABLE_INCREMENT;
7342      pubname_table
7343	= ggc_realloc (pubname_table,
7344		       (pubname_table_allocated * sizeof (pubname_entry)));
7345      memset (pubname_table + pubname_table_in_use, 0,
7346	      PUBNAME_TABLE_INCREMENT * sizeof (pubname_entry));
7347    }
7348
7349  p = &pubname_table[pubname_table_in_use++];
7350  p->die = die;
7351  p->name = xstrdup (dwarf2_name (decl, 1));
7352}
7353
7354/* Output the public names table used to speed up access to externally
7355   visible names.  For now, only generate entries for externally
7356   visible procedures.  */
7357
7358static void
7359output_pubnames (void)
7360{
7361  unsigned i;
7362  unsigned long pubnames_length = size_of_pubnames ();
7363
7364  if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
7365    dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
7366      "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
7367  dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, pubnames_length,
7368		       "Length of Public Names Info");
7369  dw2_asm_output_data (2, DWARF_VERSION, "DWARF Version");
7370  dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, debug_info_section_label,
7371			 debug_info_section,
7372			 "Offset of Compilation Unit Info");
7373  dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, next_die_offset,
7374		       "Compilation Unit Length");
7375
7376  for (i = 0; i < pubname_table_in_use; i++)
7377    {
7378      pubname_ref pub = &pubname_table[i];
7379
7380      /* We shouldn't see pubnames for DIEs outside of the main CU.  */
7381      gcc_assert (pub->die->die_mark);
7382
7383      dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, pub->die->die_offset,
7384			   "DIE offset");
7385
7386      dw2_asm_output_nstring (pub->name, -1, "external name");
7387    }
7388
7389  dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, 0, NULL);
7390}
7391
7392/* Add a new entry to .debug_aranges if appropriate.  */
7393
7394static void
7395add_arange (tree decl, dw_die_ref die)
7396{
7397  if (! DECL_SECTION_NAME (decl))
7398    return;
7399
7400  if (arange_table_in_use == arange_table_allocated)
7401    {
7402      arange_table_allocated += ARANGE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
7403      arange_table = ggc_realloc (arange_table,
7404				  (arange_table_allocated
7405				   * sizeof (dw_die_ref)));
7406      memset (arange_table + arange_table_in_use, 0,
7407	      ARANGE_TABLE_INCREMENT * sizeof (dw_die_ref));
7408    }
7409
7410  arange_table[arange_table_in_use++] = die;
7411}
7412
7413/* Output the information that goes into the .debug_aranges table.
7414   Namely, define the beginning and ending address range of the
7415   text section generated for this compilation unit.  */
7416
7417static void
7418output_aranges (void)
7419{
7420  unsigned i;
7421  unsigned long aranges_length = size_of_aranges ();
7422
7423  if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
7424    dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
7425      "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
7426  dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, aranges_length,
7427		       "Length of Address Ranges Info");
7428  dw2_asm_output_data (2, DWARF_VERSION, "DWARF Version");
7429  dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, debug_info_section_label,
7430			 debug_info_section,
7431			 "Offset of Compilation Unit Info");
7432  dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Size of Address");
7433  dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "Size of Segment Descriptor");
7434
7435  /* We need to align to twice the pointer size here.  */
7436  if (DWARF_ARANGES_PAD_SIZE)
7437    {
7438      /* Pad using a 2 byte words so that padding is correct for any
7439	 pointer size.  */
7440      dw2_asm_output_data (2, 0, "Pad to %d byte boundary",
7441			   2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
7442      for (i = 2; i < (unsigned) DWARF_ARANGES_PAD_SIZE; i += 2)
7443	dw2_asm_output_data (2, 0, NULL);
7444    }
7445
7446  dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, text_section_label, "Address");
7447  dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, text_end_label,
7448			text_section_label, "Length");
7449  if (flag_reorder_blocks_and_partition)
7450    {
7451      dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, cold_text_section_label,
7452			   "Address");
7453      dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, cold_end_label,
7454			    cold_text_section_label, "Length");
7455    }
7456
7457  for (i = 0; i < arange_table_in_use; i++)
7458    {
7459      dw_die_ref die = arange_table[i];
7460
7461      /* We shouldn't see aranges for DIEs outside of the main CU.  */
7462      gcc_assert (die->die_mark);
7463
7464      if (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram)
7465	{
7466	  dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, get_AT_low_pc (die),
7467			       "Address");
7468	  dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, get_AT_hi_pc (die),
7469				get_AT_low_pc (die), "Length");
7470	}
7471      else
7472	{
7473	  /* A static variable; extract the symbol from DW_AT_location.
7474	     Note that this code isn't currently hit, as we only emit
7475	     aranges for functions (jason 9/23/99).  */
7476	  dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, DW_AT_location);
7477	  dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
7478
7479	  gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc);
7480
7481	  loc = AT_loc (a);
7482	  gcc_assert (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_addr);
7483
7484	  dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
7485				   loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr, "Address");
7486	  dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
7487			       get_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_byte_size),
7488			       "Length");
7489	}
7490    }
7491
7492  /* Output the terminator words.  */
7493  dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
7494  dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
7495}
7496
7497/* Add a new entry to .debug_ranges.  Return the offset at which it
7498   was placed.  */
7499
7500static unsigned int
7501add_ranges (tree block)
7502{
7503  unsigned int in_use = ranges_table_in_use;
7504
7505  if (in_use == ranges_table_allocated)
7506    {
7507      ranges_table_allocated += RANGES_TABLE_INCREMENT;
7508      ranges_table
7509	= ggc_realloc (ranges_table, (ranges_table_allocated
7510				      * sizeof (struct dw_ranges_struct)));
7511      memset (ranges_table + ranges_table_in_use, 0,
7512	      RANGES_TABLE_INCREMENT * sizeof (struct dw_ranges_struct));
7513    }
7514
7515  ranges_table[in_use].block_num = (block ? BLOCK_NUMBER (block) : 0);
7516  ranges_table_in_use = in_use + 1;
7517
7518  return in_use * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
7519}
7520
7521static void
7522output_ranges (void)
7523{
7524  unsigned i;
7525  static const char *const start_fmt = "Offset 0x%x";
7526  const char *fmt = start_fmt;
7527
7528  for (i = 0; i < ranges_table_in_use; i++)
7529    {
7530      int block_num = ranges_table[i].block_num;
7531
7532      if (block_num)
7533	{
7534	  char blabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
7535	  char elabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
7536
7537	  ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (blabel, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL, block_num);
7538	  ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (elabel, BLOCK_END_LABEL, block_num);
7539
7540	  /* If all code is in the text section, then the compilation
7541	     unit base address defaults to DW_AT_low_pc, which is the
7542	     base of the text section.  */
7543	  if (!have_multiple_function_sections)
7544	    {
7545	      dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, blabel,
7546				    text_section_label,
7547				    fmt, i * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
7548	      dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, elabel,
7549				    text_section_label, NULL);
7550	    }
7551
7552	  /* Otherwise, we add a DW_AT_entry_pc attribute to force the
7553	     compilation unit base address to zero, which allows us to
7554	     use absolute addresses, and not worry about whether the
7555	     target supports cross-section arithmetic.  */
7556	  else
7557	    {
7558	      dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, blabel,
7559				   fmt, i * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
7560	      dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, elabel, NULL);
7561	    }
7562
7563	  fmt = NULL;
7564	}
7565      else
7566	{
7567	  dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
7568	  dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
7569	  fmt = start_fmt;
7570	}
7571    }
7572}
7573
7574/* Data structure containing information about input files.  */
7575struct file_info
7576{
7577  const char *path;	/* Complete file name.  */
7578  const char *fname;	/* File name part.  */
7579  int length;		/* Length of entire string.  */
7580  struct dwarf_file_data * file_idx;	/* Index in input file table.  */
7581  int dir_idx;		/* Index in directory table.  */
7582};
7583
7584/* Data structure containing information about directories with source
7585   files.  */
7586struct dir_info
7587{
7588  const char *path;	/* Path including directory name.  */
7589  int length;		/* Path length.  */
7590  int prefix;		/* Index of directory entry which is a prefix.  */
7591  int count;		/* Number of files in this directory.  */
7592  int dir_idx;		/* Index of directory used as base.  */
7593};
7594
7595/* Callback function for file_info comparison.  We sort by looking at
7596   the directories in the path.  */
7597
7598static int
7599file_info_cmp (const void *p1, const void *p2)
7600{
7601  const struct file_info *s1 = p1;
7602  const struct file_info *s2 = p2;
7603  unsigned char *cp1;
7604  unsigned char *cp2;
7605
7606  /* Take care of file names without directories.  We need to make sure that
7607     we return consistent values to qsort since some will get confused if
7608     we return the same value when identical operands are passed in opposite
7609     orders.  So if neither has a directory, return 0 and otherwise return
7610     1 or -1 depending on which one has the directory.  */
7611  if ((s1->path == s1->fname || s2->path == s2->fname))
7612    return (s2->path == s2->fname) - (s1->path == s1->fname);
7613
7614  cp1 = (unsigned char *) s1->path;
7615  cp2 = (unsigned char *) s2->path;
7616
7617  while (1)
7618    {
7619      ++cp1;
7620      ++cp2;
7621      /* Reached the end of the first path?  If so, handle like above.  */
7622      if ((cp1 == (unsigned char *) s1->fname)
7623	  || (cp2 == (unsigned char *) s2->fname))
7624	return ((cp2 == (unsigned char *) s2->fname)
7625		- (cp1 == (unsigned char *) s1->fname));
7626
7627      /* Character of current path component the same?  */
7628      else if (*cp1 != *cp2)
7629	return *cp1 - *cp2;
7630    }
7631}
7632
7633struct file_name_acquire_data
7634{
7635  struct file_info *files;
7636  int used_files;
7637  int max_files;
7638};
7639
7640/* Traversal function for the hash table.  */
7641
7642static int
7643file_name_acquire (void ** slot, void *data)
7644{
7645  struct file_name_acquire_data *fnad = data;
7646  struct dwarf_file_data *d = *slot;
7647  struct file_info *fi;
7648  const char *f;
7649
7650  gcc_assert (fnad->max_files >= d->emitted_number);
7651
7652  if (! d->emitted_number)
7653    return 1;
7654
7655  gcc_assert (fnad->max_files != fnad->used_files);
7656
7657  fi = fnad->files + fnad->used_files++;
7658
7659  /* Skip all leading "./".  */
7660  f = d->filename;
7661  while (f[0] == '.' && f[1] == '/')
7662    f += 2;
7663
7664  /* Create a new array entry.  */
7665  fi->path = f;
7666  fi->length = strlen (f);
7667  fi->file_idx = d;
7668
7669  /* Search for the file name part.  */
7670  f = strrchr (f, '/');
7671  fi->fname = f == NULL ? fi->path : f + 1;
7672  return 1;
7673}
7674
7675/* Output the directory table and the file name table.  We try to minimize
7676   the total amount of memory needed.  A heuristic is used to avoid large
7677   slowdowns with many input files.  */
7678
7679static void
7680output_file_names (void)
7681{
7682  struct file_name_acquire_data fnad;
7683  int numfiles;
7684  struct file_info *files;
7685  struct dir_info *dirs;
7686  int *saved;
7687  int *savehere;
7688  int *backmap;
7689  int ndirs;
7690  int idx_offset;
7691  int i;
7692  int idx;
7693
7694  if (!last_emitted_file)
7695    {
7696      dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End directory table");
7697      dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End file name table");
7698      return;
7699    }
7700
7701  numfiles = last_emitted_file->emitted_number;
7702
7703  /* Allocate the various arrays we need.  */
7704  files = alloca (numfiles * sizeof (struct file_info));
7705  dirs = alloca (numfiles * sizeof (struct dir_info));
7706
7707  fnad.files = files;
7708  fnad.used_files = 0;
7709  fnad.max_files = numfiles;
7710  htab_traverse (file_table, file_name_acquire, &fnad);
7711  gcc_assert (fnad.used_files == fnad.max_files);
7712
7713  qsort (files, numfiles, sizeof (files[0]), file_info_cmp);
7714
7715  /* Find all the different directories used.  */
7716  dirs[0].path = files[0].path;
7717  dirs[0].length = files[0].fname - files[0].path;
7718  dirs[0].prefix = -1;
7719  dirs[0].count = 1;
7720  dirs[0].dir_idx = 0;
7721  files[0].dir_idx = 0;
7722  ndirs = 1;
7723
7724  for (i = 1; i < numfiles; i++)
7725    if (files[i].fname - files[i].path == dirs[ndirs - 1].length
7726	&& memcmp (dirs[ndirs - 1].path, files[i].path,
7727		   dirs[ndirs - 1].length) == 0)
7728      {
7729	/* Same directory as last entry.  */
7730	files[i].dir_idx = ndirs - 1;
7731	++dirs[ndirs - 1].count;
7732      }
7733    else
7734      {
7735	int j;
7736
7737	/* This is a new directory.  */
7738	dirs[ndirs].path = files[i].path;
7739	dirs[ndirs].length = files[i].fname - files[i].path;
7740	dirs[ndirs].count = 1;
7741	dirs[ndirs].dir_idx = ndirs;
7742	files[i].dir_idx = ndirs;
7743
7744	/* Search for a prefix.  */
7745	dirs[ndirs].prefix = -1;
7746	for (j = 0; j < ndirs; j++)
7747	  if (dirs[j].length < dirs[ndirs].length
7748	      && dirs[j].length > 1
7749	      && (dirs[ndirs].prefix == -1
7750		  || dirs[j].length > dirs[dirs[ndirs].prefix].length)
7751	      && memcmp (dirs[j].path, dirs[ndirs].path, dirs[j].length) == 0)
7752	    dirs[ndirs].prefix = j;
7753
7754	++ndirs;
7755      }
7756
7757  /* Now to the actual work.  We have to find a subset of the directories which
7758     allow expressing the file name using references to the directory table
7759     with the least amount of characters.  We do not do an exhaustive search
7760     where we would have to check out every combination of every single
7761     possible prefix.  Instead we use a heuristic which provides nearly optimal
7762     results in most cases and never is much off.  */
7763  saved = alloca (ndirs * sizeof (int));
7764  savehere = alloca (ndirs * sizeof (int));
7765
7766  memset (saved, '\0', ndirs * sizeof (saved[0]));
7767  for (i = 0; i < ndirs; i++)
7768    {
7769      int j;
7770      int total;
7771
7772      /* We can always save some space for the current directory.  But this
7773	 does not mean it will be enough to justify adding the directory.  */
7774      savehere[i] = dirs[i].length;
7775      total = (savehere[i] - saved[i]) * dirs[i].count;
7776
7777      for (j = i + 1; j < ndirs; j++)
7778	{
7779	  savehere[j] = 0;
7780	  if (saved[j] < dirs[i].length)
7781	    {
7782	      /* Determine whether the dirs[i] path is a prefix of the
7783		 dirs[j] path.  */
7784	      int k;
7785
7786	      k = dirs[j].prefix;
7787	      while (k != -1 && k != (int) i)
7788		k = dirs[k].prefix;
7789
7790	      if (k == (int) i)
7791		{
7792		  /* Yes it is.  We can possibly save some memory by
7793		     writing the filenames in dirs[j] relative to
7794		     dirs[i].  */
7795		  savehere[j] = dirs[i].length;
7796		  total += (savehere[j] - saved[j]) * dirs[j].count;
7797		}
7798	    }
7799	}
7800
7801      /* Check whether we can save enough to justify adding the dirs[i]
7802	 directory.  */
7803      if (total > dirs[i].length + 1)
7804	{
7805	  /* It's worthwhile adding.  */
7806	  for (j = i; j < ndirs; j++)
7807	    if (savehere[j] > 0)
7808	      {
7809		/* Remember how much we saved for this directory so far.  */
7810		saved[j] = savehere[j];
7811
7812		/* Remember the prefix directory.  */
7813		dirs[j].dir_idx = i;
7814	      }
7815	}
7816    }
7817
7818  /* Emit the directory name table.  */
7819  idx = 1;
7820  idx_offset = dirs[0].length > 0 ? 1 : 0;
7821  for (i = 1 - idx_offset; i < ndirs; i++)
7822    dw2_asm_output_nstring (dirs[i].path, dirs[i].length - 1,
7823			    "Directory Entry: 0x%x", i + idx_offset);
7824
7825  dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End directory table");
7826
7827  /* We have to emit them in the order of emitted_number since that's
7828     used in the debug info generation.  To do this efficiently we
7829     generate a back-mapping of the indices first.  */
7830  backmap = alloca (numfiles * sizeof (int));
7831  for (i = 0; i < numfiles; i++)
7832    backmap[files[i].file_idx->emitted_number - 1] = i;
7833
7834  /* Now write all the file names.  */
7835  for (i = 0; i < numfiles; i++)
7836    {
7837      int file_idx = backmap[i];
7838      int dir_idx = dirs[files[file_idx].dir_idx].dir_idx;
7839
7840      dw2_asm_output_nstring (files[file_idx].path + dirs[dir_idx].length, -1,
7841			      "File Entry: 0x%x", (unsigned) i + 1);
7842
7843      /* Include directory index.  */
7844      dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (dir_idx + idx_offset, NULL);
7845
7846      /* Modification time.  */
7847      dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, NULL);
7848
7849      /* File length in bytes.  */
7850      dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, NULL);
7851    }
7852
7853  dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End file name table");
7854}
7855
7856
7857/* Output the source line number correspondence information.  This
7858   information goes into the .debug_line section.  */
7859
7860static void
7861output_line_info (void)
7862{
7863  char l1[20], l2[20], p1[20], p2[20];
7864  char line_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
7865  char prev_line_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
7866  unsigned opc;
7867  unsigned n_op_args;
7868  unsigned long lt_index;
7869  unsigned long current_line;
7870  long line_offset;
7871  long line_delta;
7872  unsigned long current_file;
7873  unsigned long function;
7874
7875  ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, LINE_NUMBER_BEGIN_LABEL, 0);
7876  ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, LINE_NUMBER_END_LABEL, 0);
7877  ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (p1, LN_PROLOG_AS_LABEL, 0);
7878  ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (p2, LN_PROLOG_END_LABEL, 0);
7879
7880  if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
7881    dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
7882      "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
7883  dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
7884			"Length of Source Line Info");
7885  ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
7886
7887  dw2_asm_output_data (2, DWARF_VERSION, "DWARF Version");
7888  dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, p2, p1, "Prolog Length");
7889  ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, p1);
7890
7891  /* Define the architecture-dependent minimum instruction length (in
7892   bytes).  In this implementation of DWARF, this field is used for
7893   information purposes only.  Since GCC generates assembly language,
7894   we have no a priori knowledge of how many instruction bytes are
7895   generated for each source line, and therefore can use only the
7896   DW_LNE_set_address and DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc line information
7897   commands.  Accordingly, we fix this as `1', which is "correct
7898   enough" for all architectures, and don't let the target override.  */
7899  dw2_asm_output_data (1, 1,
7900		       "Minimum Instruction Length");
7901
7902  dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_IS_STMT_START,
7903		       "Default is_stmt_start flag");
7904  dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_BASE,
7905		       "Line Base Value (Special Opcodes)");
7906  dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_RANGE,
7907		       "Line Range Value (Special Opcodes)");
7908  dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE,
7909		       "Special Opcode Base");
7910
7911  for (opc = 1; opc < DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE; opc++)
7912    {
7913      switch (opc)
7914	{
7915	case DW_LNS_advance_pc:
7916	case DW_LNS_advance_line:
7917	case DW_LNS_set_file:
7918	case DW_LNS_set_column:
7919	case DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc:
7920	  n_op_args = 1;
7921	  break;
7922	default:
7923	  n_op_args = 0;
7924	  break;
7925	}
7926
7927      dw2_asm_output_data (1, n_op_args, "opcode: 0x%x has %d args",
7928			   opc, n_op_args);
7929    }
7930
7931  /* Write out the information about the files we use.  */
7932  output_file_names ();
7933  ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, p2);
7934
7935  /* We used to set the address register to the first location in the text
7936     section here, but that didn't accomplish anything since we already
7937     have a line note for the opening brace of the first function.  */
7938
7939  /* Generate the line number to PC correspondence table, encoded as
7940     a series of state machine operations.  */
7941  current_file = 1;
7942  current_line = 1;
7943
7944  if (cfun && in_cold_section_p)
7945    strcpy (prev_line_label, cfun->cold_section_label);
7946  else
7947    strcpy (prev_line_label, text_section_label);
7948  for (lt_index = 1; lt_index < line_info_table_in_use; ++lt_index)
7949    {
7950      dw_line_info_ref line_info = &line_info_table[lt_index];
7951
7952#if 0
7953      /* Disable this optimization for now; GDB wants to see two line notes
7954	 at the beginning of a function so it can find the end of the
7955	 prologue.  */
7956
7957      /* Don't emit anything for redundant notes.  Just updating the
7958	 address doesn't accomplish anything, because we already assume
7959	 that anything after the last address is this line.  */
7960      if (line_info->dw_line_num == current_line
7961	  && line_info->dw_file_num == current_file)
7962	continue;
7963#endif
7964
7965      /* Emit debug info for the address of the current line.
7966
7967	 Unfortunately, we have little choice here currently, and must always
7968	 use the most general form.  GCC does not know the address delta
7969	 itself, so we can't use DW_LNS_advance_pc.  Many ports do have length
7970	 attributes which will give an upper bound on the address range.  We
7971	 could perhaps use length attributes to determine when it is safe to
7972	 use DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc.  */
7973
7974      ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (line_label, LINE_CODE_LABEL, lt_index);
7975      if (0)
7976	{
7977	  /* This can handle deltas up to 0xffff.  This takes 3 bytes.  */
7978	  dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc,
7979			       "DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc");
7980	  dw2_asm_output_delta (2, line_label, prev_line_label, NULL);
7981	}
7982      else
7983	{
7984	  /* This can handle any delta.  This takes
7985	     4+DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE bytes.  */
7986	  dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
7987	  dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
7988	  dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
7989	  dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, line_label, NULL);
7990	}
7991
7992      strcpy (prev_line_label, line_label);
7993
7994      /* Emit debug info for the source file of the current line, if
7995	 different from the previous line.  */
7996      if (line_info->dw_file_num != current_file)
7997	{
7998	  current_file = line_info->dw_file_num;
7999	  dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_set_file, "DW_LNS_set_file");
8000	  dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (current_file, "%lu", current_file);
8001	}
8002
8003      /* Emit debug info for the current line number, choosing the encoding
8004	 that uses the least amount of space.  */
8005      if (line_info->dw_line_num != current_line)
8006	{
8007	  line_offset = line_info->dw_line_num - current_line;
8008	  line_delta = line_offset - DWARF_LINE_BASE;
8009	  current_line = line_info->dw_line_num;
8010	  if (line_delta >= 0 && line_delta < (DWARF_LINE_RANGE - 1))
8011	    /* This can handle deltas from -10 to 234, using the current
8012	       definitions of DWARF_LINE_BASE and DWARF_LINE_RANGE.  This
8013	       takes 1 byte.  */
8014	    dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE + line_delta,
8015				 "line %lu", current_line);
8016	  else
8017	    {
8018	      /* This can handle any delta.  This takes at least 4 bytes,
8019		 depending on the value being encoded.  */
8020	      dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_advance_line,
8021				   "advance to line %lu", current_line);
8022	      dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (line_offset, NULL);
8023	      dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy, "DW_LNS_copy");
8024	    }
8025	}
8026      else
8027	/* We still need to start a new row, so output a copy insn.  */
8028	dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy, "DW_LNS_copy");
8029    }
8030
8031  /* Emit debug info for the address of the end of the function.  */
8032  if (0)
8033    {
8034      dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc,
8035			   "DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc");
8036      dw2_asm_output_delta (2, text_end_label, prev_line_label, NULL);
8037    }
8038  else
8039    {
8040      dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
8041      dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
8042      dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
8043      dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, text_end_label, NULL);
8044    }
8045
8046  dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_end_sequence");
8047  dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1, NULL);
8048  dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_end_sequence, NULL);
8049
8050  function = 0;
8051  current_file = 1;
8052  current_line = 1;
8053  for (lt_index = 0; lt_index < separate_line_info_table_in_use;)
8054    {
8055      dw_separate_line_info_ref line_info
8056	= &separate_line_info_table[lt_index];
8057
8058#if 0
8059      /* Don't emit anything for redundant notes.  */
8060      if (line_info->dw_line_num == current_line
8061	  && line_info->dw_file_num == current_file
8062	  && line_info->function == function)
8063	goto cont;
8064#endif
8065
8066      /* Emit debug info for the address of the current line.  If this is
8067	 a new function, or the first line of a function, then we need
8068	 to handle it differently.  */
8069      ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (line_label, SEPARATE_LINE_CODE_LABEL,
8070				   lt_index);
8071      if (function != line_info->function)
8072	{
8073	  function = line_info->function;
8074
8075	  /* Set the address register to the first line in the function.  */
8076	  dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
8077	  dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
8078	  dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
8079	  dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, line_label, NULL);
8080	}
8081      else
8082	{
8083	  /* ??? See the DW_LNS_advance_pc comment above.  */
8084	  if (0)
8085	    {
8086	      dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc,
8087				   "DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc");
8088	      dw2_asm_output_delta (2, line_label, prev_line_label, NULL);
8089	    }
8090	  else
8091	    {
8092	      dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
8093	      dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
8094	      dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
8095	      dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, line_label, NULL);
8096	    }
8097	}
8098
8099      strcpy (prev_line_label, line_label);
8100
8101      /* Emit debug info for the source file of the current line, if
8102	 different from the previous line.  */
8103      if (line_info->dw_file_num != current_file)
8104	{
8105	  current_file = line_info->dw_file_num;
8106	  dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_set_file, "DW_LNS_set_file");
8107	  dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (current_file, "%lu", current_file);
8108	}
8109
8110      /* Emit debug info for the current line number, choosing the encoding
8111	 that uses the least amount of space.  */
8112      if (line_info->dw_line_num != current_line)
8113	{
8114	  line_offset = line_info->dw_line_num - current_line;
8115	  line_delta = line_offset - DWARF_LINE_BASE;
8116	  current_line = line_info->dw_line_num;
8117	  if (line_delta >= 0 && line_delta < (DWARF_LINE_RANGE - 1))
8118	    dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE + line_delta,
8119				 "line %lu", current_line);
8120	  else
8121	    {
8122	      dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_advance_line,
8123				   "advance to line %lu", current_line);
8124	      dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (line_offset, NULL);
8125	      dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy, "DW_LNS_copy");
8126	    }
8127	}
8128      else
8129	dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy, "DW_LNS_copy");
8130
8131#if 0
8132    cont:
8133#endif
8134
8135      lt_index++;
8136
8137      /* If we're done with a function, end its sequence.  */
8138      if (lt_index == separate_line_info_table_in_use
8139	  || separate_line_info_table[lt_index].function != function)
8140	{
8141	  current_file = 1;
8142	  current_line = 1;
8143
8144	  /* Emit debug info for the address of the end of the function.  */
8145	  ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (line_label, FUNC_END_LABEL, function);
8146	  if (0)
8147	    {
8148	      dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc,
8149				   "DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc");
8150	      dw2_asm_output_delta (2, line_label, prev_line_label, NULL);
8151	    }
8152	  else
8153	    {
8154	      dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
8155	      dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
8156	      dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
8157	      dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, line_label, NULL);
8158	    }
8159
8160	  /* Output the marker for the end of this sequence.  */
8161	  dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_end_sequence");
8162	  dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1, NULL);
8163	  dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_end_sequence, NULL);
8164	}
8165    }
8166
8167  /* Output the marker for the end of the line number info.  */
8168  ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
8169}
8170
8171/* Given a pointer to a tree node for some base type, return a pointer to
8172   a DIE that describes the given type.
8173
8174   This routine must only be called for GCC type nodes that correspond to
8175   Dwarf base (fundamental) types.  */
8176
8177static dw_die_ref
8178base_type_die (tree type)
8179{
8180  dw_die_ref base_type_result;
8181  enum dwarf_type encoding;
8182
8183  if (TREE_CODE (type) == ERROR_MARK || TREE_CODE (type) == VOID_TYPE)
8184    return 0;
8185
8186  switch (TREE_CODE (type))
8187    {
8188    case INTEGER_TYPE:
8189      if (TYPE_STRING_FLAG (type))
8190	{
8191	  if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
8192	    encoding = DW_ATE_unsigned_char;
8193	  else
8194	    encoding = DW_ATE_signed_char;
8195	}
8196      else if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
8197	encoding = DW_ATE_unsigned;
8198      else
8199	encoding = DW_ATE_signed;
8200      break;
8201
8202    case REAL_TYPE:
8203      if (DECIMAL_FLOAT_MODE_P (TYPE_MODE (type)))
8204	encoding = DW_ATE_decimal_float;
8205      else
8206	encoding = DW_ATE_float;
8207      break;
8208
8209      /* Dwarf2 doesn't know anything about complex ints, so use
8210	 a user defined type for it.  */
8211    case COMPLEX_TYPE:
8212      if (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (type)) == REAL_TYPE)
8213	encoding = DW_ATE_complex_float;
8214      else
8215	encoding = DW_ATE_lo_user;
8216      break;
8217
8218    case BOOLEAN_TYPE:
8219      /* GNU FORTRAN/Ada/C++ BOOLEAN type.  */
8220      encoding = DW_ATE_boolean;
8221      break;
8222
8223    default:
8224      /* No other TREE_CODEs are Dwarf fundamental types.  */
8225      gcc_unreachable ();
8226    }
8227
8228  base_type_result = new_die (DW_TAG_base_type, comp_unit_die, type);
8229
8230  /* This probably indicates a bug.  */
8231  if (! TYPE_NAME (type))
8232    add_name_attribute (base_type_result, "__unknown__");
8233
8234  add_AT_unsigned (base_type_result, DW_AT_byte_size,
8235		   int_size_in_bytes (type));
8236  add_AT_unsigned (base_type_result, DW_AT_encoding, encoding);
8237
8238  return base_type_result;
8239}
8240
8241/* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return a pointer to
8242   the Dwarf "root" type for the given input type.  The Dwarf "root" type of
8243   a given type is generally the same as the given type, except that if the
8244   given type is a pointer or reference type, then the root type of the given
8245   type is the root type of the "basis" type for the pointer or reference
8246   type.  (This definition of the "root" type is recursive.) Also, the root
8247   type of a `const' qualified type or a `volatile' qualified type is the
8248   root type of the given type without the qualifiers.  */
8249
8250static tree
8251root_type (tree type)
8252{
8253  if (TREE_CODE (type) == ERROR_MARK)
8254    return error_mark_node;
8255
8256  switch (TREE_CODE (type))
8257    {
8258    case ERROR_MARK:
8259      return error_mark_node;
8260
8261    case POINTER_TYPE:
8262    case REFERENCE_TYPE:
8263      return type_main_variant (root_type (TREE_TYPE (type)));
8264
8265    default:
8266      return type_main_variant (type);
8267    }
8268}
8269
8270/* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return nonzero if the
8271   given input type is a Dwarf "fundamental" type.  Otherwise return null.  */
8272
8273static inline int
8274is_base_type (tree type)
8275{
8276  switch (TREE_CODE (type))
8277    {
8278    case ERROR_MARK:
8279    case VOID_TYPE:
8280    case INTEGER_TYPE:
8281    case REAL_TYPE:
8282    case COMPLEX_TYPE:
8283    case BOOLEAN_TYPE:
8284      return 1;
8285
8286    case ARRAY_TYPE:
8287    case RECORD_TYPE:
8288    case UNION_TYPE:
8289    case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
8290    case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
8291    case FUNCTION_TYPE:
8292    case METHOD_TYPE:
8293    case POINTER_TYPE:
8294    case REFERENCE_TYPE:
8295    case OFFSET_TYPE:
8296    case LANG_TYPE:
8297    case VECTOR_TYPE:
8298      return 0;
8299
8300    default:
8301      gcc_unreachable ();
8302    }
8303
8304  return 0;
8305}
8306
8307/* Given a pointer to a tree node, assumed to be some kind of a ..._TYPE
8308   node, return the size in bits for the type if it is a constant, or else
8309   return the alignment for the type if the type's size is not constant, or
8310   else return BITS_PER_WORD if the type actually turns out to be an
8311   ERROR_MARK node.  */
8312
8313static inline unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
8314simple_type_size_in_bits (tree type)
8315{
8316  if (TREE_CODE (type) == ERROR_MARK)
8317    return BITS_PER_WORD;
8318  else if (TYPE_SIZE (type) == NULL_TREE)
8319    return 0;
8320  else if (host_integerp (TYPE_SIZE (type), 1))
8321    return tree_low_cst (TYPE_SIZE (type), 1);
8322  else
8323    return TYPE_ALIGN (type);
8324}
8325
8326/* Return true if the debug information for the given type should be
8327   emitted as a subrange type.  */
8328
8329static inline bool
8330is_subrange_type (tree type)
8331{
8332  tree subtype = TREE_TYPE (type);
8333
8334  /* Subrange types are identified by the fact that they are integer
8335     types, and that they have a subtype which is either an integer type
8336     or an enumeral type.  */
8337
8338  if (TREE_CODE (type) != INTEGER_TYPE
8339      || subtype == NULL_TREE)
8340    return false;
8341
8342  if (TREE_CODE (subtype) != INTEGER_TYPE
8343      && TREE_CODE (subtype) != ENUMERAL_TYPE)
8344    return false;
8345
8346  if (TREE_CODE (type) == TREE_CODE (subtype)
8347      && int_size_in_bytes (type) == int_size_in_bytes (subtype)
8348      && TYPE_MIN_VALUE (type) != NULL
8349      && TYPE_MIN_VALUE (subtype) != NULL
8350      && tree_int_cst_equal (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (type), TYPE_MIN_VALUE (subtype))
8351      && TYPE_MAX_VALUE (type) != NULL
8352      && TYPE_MAX_VALUE (subtype) != NULL
8353      && tree_int_cst_equal (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (type), TYPE_MAX_VALUE (subtype)))
8354    {
8355      /* The type and its subtype have the same representation.  If in
8356         addition the two types also have the same name, then the given
8357         type is not a subrange type, but rather a plain base type.  */
8358      /* FIXME: brobecker/2004-03-22:
8359         Sizetype INTEGER_CSTs nodes are canonicalized.  It should
8360         therefore be sufficient to check the TYPE_SIZE node pointers
8361         rather than checking the actual size.  Unfortunately, we have
8362         found some cases, such as in the Ada "integer" type, where
8363         this is not the case.  Until this problem is solved, we need to
8364         keep checking the actual size.  */
8365      tree type_name = TYPE_NAME (type);
8366      tree subtype_name = TYPE_NAME (subtype);
8367
8368      if (type_name != NULL && TREE_CODE (type_name) == TYPE_DECL)
8369        type_name = DECL_NAME (type_name);
8370
8371      if (subtype_name != NULL && TREE_CODE (subtype_name) == TYPE_DECL)
8372        subtype_name = DECL_NAME (subtype_name);
8373
8374      if (type_name == subtype_name)
8375        return false;
8376    }
8377
8378  return true;
8379}
8380
8381/*  Given a pointer to a tree node for a subrange type, return a pointer
8382    to a DIE that describes the given type.  */
8383
8384static dw_die_ref
8385subrange_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
8386{
8387  dw_die_ref subrange_die;
8388  const HOST_WIDE_INT size_in_bytes = int_size_in_bytes (type);
8389
8390  if (context_die == NULL)
8391    context_die = comp_unit_die;
8392
8393  subrange_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subrange_type, context_die, type);
8394
8395  if (int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (type)) != size_in_bytes)
8396    {
8397      /* The size of the subrange type and its base type do not match,
8398         so we need to generate a size attribute for the subrange type.  */
8399      add_AT_unsigned (subrange_die, DW_AT_byte_size, size_in_bytes);
8400    }
8401
8402  if (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (type) != NULL)
8403    add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_lower_bound,
8404                    TYPE_MIN_VALUE (type));
8405  if (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (type) != NULL)
8406    add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_upper_bound,
8407                    TYPE_MAX_VALUE (type));
8408
8409  return subrange_die;
8410}
8411
8412/* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return a debugging
8413   entry that chains various modifiers in front of the given type.  */
8414
8415static dw_die_ref
8416modified_type_die (tree type, int is_const_type, int is_volatile_type,
8417		   dw_die_ref context_die)
8418{
8419  enum tree_code code = TREE_CODE (type);
8420  dw_die_ref mod_type_die;
8421  dw_die_ref sub_die = NULL;
8422  tree item_type = NULL;
8423  tree qualified_type;
8424  tree name;
8425
8426  if (code == ERROR_MARK)
8427    return NULL;
8428
8429  /* See if we already have the appropriately qualified variant of
8430     this type.  */
8431  qualified_type
8432    = get_qualified_type (type,
8433			  ((is_const_type ? TYPE_QUAL_CONST : 0)
8434			   | (is_volatile_type ? TYPE_QUAL_VOLATILE : 0)));
8435
8436  /* If we do, then we can just use its DIE, if it exists.  */
8437  if (qualified_type)
8438    {
8439      mod_type_die = lookup_type_die (qualified_type);
8440      if (mod_type_die)
8441	return mod_type_die;
8442    }
8443
8444  name = qualified_type ? TYPE_NAME (qualified_type) : NULL;
8445
8446  /* Handle C typedef types.  */
8447  if (name && TREE_CODE (name) == TYPE_DECL && DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (name))
8448    {
8449      tree dtype = TREE_TYPE (name);
8450
8451      if (qualified_type == dtype)
8452	{
8453	  /* For a named type, use the typedef.  */
8454	  gen_type_die (qualified_type, context_die);
8455	  return lookup_type_die (qualified_type);
8456	}
8457      else if (is_const_type < TYPE_READONLY (dtype)
8458	       || is_volatile_type < TYPE_VOLATILE (dtype)
8459	       || (is_const_type <= TYPE_READONLY (dtype)
8460		   && is_volatile_type <= TYPE_VOLATILE (dtype)
8461		   && DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (name) != type))
8462	/* cv-unqualified version of named type.  Just use the unnamed
8463	   type to which it refers.  */
8464	return modified_type_die (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (name),
8465				  is_const_type, is_volatile_type,
8466				  context_die);
8467      /* Else cv-qualified version of named type; fall through.  */
8468    }
8469
8470  if (is_const_type)
8471    {
8472      mod_type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_const_type, comp_unit_die, type);
8473      sub_die = modified_type_die (type, 0, is_volatile_type, context_die);
8474    }
8475  else if (is_volatile_type)
8476    {
8477      mod_type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_volatile_type, comp_unit_die, type);
8478      sub_die = modified_type_die (type, 0, 0, context_die);
8479    }
8480  else if (code == POINTER_TYPE)
8481    {
8482      mod_type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_pointer_type, comp_unit_die, type);
8483      add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size,
8484		       simple_type_size_in_bits (type) / BITS_PER_UNIT);
8485      item_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
8486    }
8487  else if (code == REFERENCE_TYPE)
8488    {
8489      mod_type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_reference_type, comp_unit_die, type);
8490      add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size,
8491		       simple_type_size_in_bits (type) / BITS_PER_UNIT);
8492      item_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
8493    }
8494  else if (is_subrange_type (type))
8495    {
8496      mod_type_die = subrange_type_die (type, context_die);
8497      item_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
8498    }
8499  else if (is_base_type (type))
8500    mod_type_die = base_type_die (type);
8501  else
8502    {
8503      gen_type_die (type, context_die);
8504
8505      /* We have to get the type_main_variant here (and pass that to the
8506	 `lookup_type_die' routine) because the ..._TYPE node we have
8507	 might simply be a *copy* of some original type node (where the
8508	 copy was created to help us keep track of typedef names) and
8509	 that copy might have a different TYPE_UID from the original
8510	 ..._TYPE node.  */
8511      if (TREE_CODE (type) != VECTOR_TYPE)
8512	return lookup_type_die (type_main_variant (type));
8513      else
8514	/* Vectors have the debugging information in the type,
8515	   not the main variant.  */
8516	return lookup_type_die (type);
8517    }
8518
8519  /* Builtin types don't have a DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE.  For those,
8520     don't output a DW_TAG_typedef, since there isn't one in the
8521     user's program; just attach a DW_AT_name to the type.  */
8522  if (name
8523      && (TREE_CODE (name) != TYPE_DECL || TREE_TYPE (name) == qualified_type))
8524    {
8525      if (TREE_CODE (name) == TYPE_DECL)
8526	/* Could just call add_name_and_src_coords_attributes here,
8527	   but since this is a builtin type it doesn't have any
8528	   useful source coordinates anyway.  */
8529	name = DECL_NAME (name);
8530      add_name_attribute (mod_type_die, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (name));
8531    }
8532
8533  if (qualified_type)
8534    equate_type_number_to_die (qualified_type, mod_type_die);
8535
8536  if (item_type)
8537    /* We must do this after the equate_type_number_to_die call, in case
8538       this is a recursive type.  This ensures that the modified_type_die
8539       recursion will terminate even if the type is recursive.  Recursive
8540       types are possible in Ada.  */
8541    sub_die = modified_type_die (item_type,
8542				 TYPE_READONLY (item_type),
8543				 TYPE_VOLATILE (item_type),
8544				 context_die);
8545
8546  if (sub_die != NULL)
8547    add_AT_die_ref (mod_type_die, DW_AT_type, sub_die);
8548
8549  return mod_type_die;
8550}
8551
8552/* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return true if it is
8553   an enumerated type.  */
8554
8555static inline int
8556type_is_enum (tree type)
8557{
8558  return TREE_CODE (type) == ENUMERAL_TYPE;
8559}
8560
8561/* Return the DBX register number described by a given RTL node.  */
8562
8563static unsigned int
8564dbx_reg_number (rtx rtl)
8565{
8566  unsigned regno = REGNO (rtl);
8567
8568  gcc_assert (regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER);
8569
8570#ifdef LEAF_REG_REMAP
8571  if (current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs)
8572    {
8573      int leaf_reg = LEAF_REG_REMAP (regno);
8574      if (leaf_reg != -1)
8575	regno = (unsigned) leaf_reg;
8576    }
8577#endif
8578
8579  return DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (regno);
8580}
8581
8582/* Optionally add a DW_OP_piece term to a location description expression.
8583   DW_OP_piece is only added if the location description expression already
8584   doesn't end with DW_OP_piece.  */
8585
8586static void
8587add_loc_descr_op_piece (dw_loc_descr_ref *list_head, int size)
8588{
8589  dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
8590
8591  if (*list_head != NULL)
8592    {
8593      /* Find the end of the chain.  */
8594      for (loc = *list_head; loc->dw_loc_next != NULL; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
8595	;
8596
8597      if (loc->dw_loc_opc != DW_OP_piece)
8598	loc->dw_loc_next = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_piece, size, 0);
8599    }
8600}
8601
8602/* Return a location descriptor that designates a machine register or
8603   zero if there is none.  */
8604
8605static dw_loc_descr_ref
8606reg_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl)
8607{
8608  rtx regs;
8609
8610  if (REGNO (rtl) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
8611    return 0;
8612
8613  regs = targetm.dwarf_register_span (rtl);
8614
8615  if (hard_regno_nregs[REGNO (rtl)][GET_MODE (rtl)] > 1 || regs)
8616    return multiple_reg_loc_descriptor (rtl, regs);
8617  else
8618    return one_reg_loc_descriptor (dbx_reg_number (rtl));
8619}
8620
8621/* Return a location descriptor that designates a machine register for
8622   a given hard register number.  */
8623
8624static dw_loc_descr_ref
8625one_reg_loc_descriptor (unsigned int regno)
8626{
8627  if (regno <= 31)
8628    return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_reg0 + regno, 0, 0);
8629  else
8630    return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_regx, regno, 0);
8631}
8632
8633/* Given an RTL of a register, return a location descriptor that
8634   designates a value that spans more than one register.  */
8635
8636static dw_loc_descr_ref
8637multiple_reg_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, rtx regs)
8638{
8639  int nregs, size, i;
8640  unsigned reg;
8641  dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result = NULL;
8642
8643  reg = REGNO (rtl);
8644#ifdef LEAF_REG_REMAP
8645  if (current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs)
8646    {
8647      int leaf_reg = LEAF_REG_REMAP (reg);
8648      if (leaf_reg != -1)
8649	reg = (unsigned) leaf_reg;
8650    }
8651#endif
8652  gcc_assert ((unsigned) DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (reg) == dbx_reg_number (rtl));
8653  nregs = hard_regno_nregs[REGNO (rtl)][GET_MODE (rtl)];
8654
8655  /* Simple, contiguous registers.  */
8656  if (regs == NULL_RTX)
8657    {
8658      size = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl)) / nregs;
8659
8660      loc_result = NULL;
8661      while (nregs--)
8662	{
8663	  dw_loc_descr_ref t;
8664
8665	  t = one_reg_loc_descriptor (DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (reg));
8666	  add_loc_descr (&loc_result, t);
8667	  add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result, size);
8668	  ++reg;
8669	}
8670      return loc_result;
8671    }
8672
8673  /* Now onto stupid register sets in non contiguous locations.  */
8674
8675  gcc_assert (GET_CODE (regs) == PARALLEL);
8676
8677  size = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XVECEXP (regs, 0, 0)));
8678  loc_result = NULL;
8679
8680  for (i = 0; i < XVECLEN (regs, 0); ++i)
8681    {
8682      dw_loc_descr_ref t;
8683
8684      t = one_reg_loc_descriptor (REGNO (XVECEXP (regs, 0, i)));
8685      add_loc_descr (&loc_result, t);
8686      size = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XVECEXP (regs, 0, 0)));
8687      add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result, size);
8688    }
8689  return loc_result;
8690}
8691
8692/* Return a location descriptor that designates a constant.  */
8693
8694static dw_loc_descr_ref
8695int_loc_descriptor (HOST_WIDE_INT i)
8696{
8697  enum dwarf_location_atom op;
8698
8699  /* Pick the smallest representation of a constant, rather than just
8700     defaulting to the LEB encoding.  */
8701  if (i >= 0)
8702    {
8703      if (i <= 31)
8704	op = DW_OP_lit0 + i;
8705      else if (i <= 0xff)
8706	op = DW_OP_const1u;
8707      else if (i <= 0xffff)
8708	op = DW_OP_const2u;
8709      else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32
8710	       || i <= 0xffffffff)
8711	op = DW_OP_const4u;
8712      else
8713	op = DW_OP_constu;
8714    }
8715  else
8716    {
8717      if (i >= -0x80)
8718	op = DW_OP_const1s;
8719      else if (i >= -0x8000)
8720	op = DW_OP_const2s;
8721      else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32
8722	       || i >= -0x80000000)
8723	op = DW_OP_const4s;
8724      else
8725	op = DW_OP_consts;
8726    }
8727
8728  return new_loc_descr (op, i, 0);
8729}
8730
8731/* Return a location descriptor that designates a base+offset location.  */
8732
8733static dw_loc_descr_ref
8734based_loc_descr (rtx reg, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
8735{
8736  unsigned int regno;
8737
8738  /* We only use "frame base" when we're sure we're talking about the
8739     post-prologue local stack frame.  We do this by *not* running
8740     register elimination until this point, and recognizing the special
8741     argument pointer and soft frame pointer rtx's.  */
8742  if (reg == arg_pointer_rtx || reg == frame_pointer_rtx)
8743    {
8744      rtx elim = eliminate_regs (reg, VOIDmode, NULL_RTX);
8745
8746      if (elim != reg)
8747	{
8748	  if (GET_CODE (elim) == PLUS)
8749	    {
8750	      offset += INTVAL (XEXP (elim, 1));
8751	      elim = XEXP (elim, 0);
8752	    }
8753	  gcc_assert (elim == (frame_pointer_needed ? hard_frame_pointer_rtx
8754		      : stack_pointer_rtx));
8755          offset += frame_pointer_fb_offset;
8756
8757          return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_fbreg, offset, 0);
8758	}
8759    }
8760
8761  regno = dbx_reg_number (reg);
8762  if (regno <= 31)
8763    return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_breg0 + regno, offset, 0);
8764  else
8765    return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bregx, regno, offset);
8766}
8767
8768/* Return true if this RTL expression describes a base+offset calculation.  */
8769
8770static inline int
8771is_based_loc (rtx rtl)
8772{
8773  return (GET_CODE (rtl) == PLUS
8774	  && ((REG_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
8775	       && REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
8776	       && GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 1)) == CONST_INT)));
8777}
8778
8779/* The following routine converts the RTL for a variable or parameter
8780   (resident in memory) into an equivalent Dwarf representation of a
8781   mechanism for getting the address of that same variable onto the top of a
8782   hypothetical "address evaluation" stack.
8783
8784   When creating memory location descriptors, we are effectively transforming
8785   the RTL for a memory-resident object into its Dwarf postfix expression
8786   equivalent.  This routine recursively descends an RTL tree, turning
8787   it into Dwarf postfix code as it goes.
8788
8789   MODE is the mode of the memory reference, needed to handle some
8790   autoincrement addressing modes.
8791
8792   CAN_USE_FBREG is a flag whether we can use DW_AT_frame_base in the
8793   location list for RTL.
8794
8795   Return 0 if we can't represent the location.  */
8796
8797static dw_loc_descr_ref
8798mem_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, enum machine_mode mode)
8799{
8800  dw_loc_descr_ref mem_loc_result = NULL;
8801  enum dwarf_location_atom op;
8802
8803  /* Note that for a dynamically sized array, the location we will generate a
8804     description of here will be the lowest numbered location which is
8805     actually within the array.  That's *not* necessarily the same as the
8806     zeroth element of the array.  */
8807
8808  rtl = targetm.delegitimize_address (rtl);
8809
8810  switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
8811    {
8812    case POST_INC:
8813    case POST_DEC:
8814    case POST_MODIFY:
8815      /* POST_INC and POST_DEC can be handled just like a SUBREG.  So we
8816	 just fall into the SUBREG code.  */
8817
8818      /* ... fall through ...  */
8819
8820    case SUBREG:
8821      /* The case of a subreg may arise when we have a local (register)
8822	 variable or a formal (register) parameter which doesn't quite fill
8823	 up an entire register.  For now, just assume that it is
8824	 legitimate to make the Dwarf info refer to the whole register which
8825	 contains the given subreg.  */
8826      rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
8827
8828      /* ... fall through ...  */
8829
8830    case REG:
8831      /* Whenever a register number forms a part of the description of the
8832	 method for calculating the (dynamic) address of a memory resident
8833	 object, DWARF rules require the register number be referred to as
8834	 a "base register".  This distinction is not based in any way upon
8835	 what category of register the hardware believes the given register
8836	 belongs to.  This is strictly DWARF terminology we're dealing with
8837	 here. Note that in cases where the location of a memory-resident
8838	 data object could be expressed as: OP_ADD (OP_BASEREG (basereg),
8839	 OP_CONST (0)) the actual DWARF location descriptor that we generate
8840	 may just be OP_BASEREG (basereg).  This may look deceptively like
8841	 the object in question was allocated to a register (rather than in
8842	 memory) so DWARF consumers need to be aware of the subtle
8843	 distinction between OP_REG and OP_BASEREG.  */
8844      if (REGNO (rtl) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
8845	mem_loc_result = based_loc_descr (rtl, 0);
8846      break;
8847
8848    case MEM:
8849      mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), GET_MODE (rtl));
8850      if (mem_loc_result != 0)
8851	add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0));
8852      break;
8853
8854    case LO_SUM:
8855	 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 1);
8856
8857      /* ... fall through ...  */
8858
8859    case LABEL_REF:
8860      /* Some ports can transform a symbol ref into a label ref, because
8861	 the symbol ref is too far away and has to be dumped into a constant
8862	 pool.  */
8863    case CONST:
8864    case SYMBOL_REF:
8865      /* Alternatively, the symbol in the constant pool might be referenced
8866	 by a different symbol.  */
8867      if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SYMBOL_REF && CONSTANT_POOL_ADDRESS_P (rtl))
8868	{
8869	  bool marked;
8870	  rtx tmp = get_pool_constant_mark (rtl, &marked);
8871
8872	  if (GET_CODE (tmp) == SYMBOL_REF)
8873	    {
8874	      rtl = tmp;
8875	      if (CONSTANT_POOL_ADDRESS_P (tmp))
8876		get_pool_constant_mark (tmp, &marked);
8877	      else
8878		marked = true;
8879	    }
8880
8881	  /* If all references to this pool constant were optimized away,
8882	     it was not output and thus we can't represent it.
8883	     FIXME: might try to use DW_OP_const_value here, though
8884	     DW_OP_piece complicates it.  */
8885	  if (!marked)
8886	    return 0;
8887	}
8888
8889      mem_loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_addr, 0, 0);
8890      mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
8891      mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr = rtl;
8892      VEC_safe_push (rtx, gc, used_rtx_array, rtl);
8893      break;
8894
8895    case PRE_MODIFY:
8896      /* Extract the PLUS expression nested inside and fall into
8897	 PLUS code below.  */
8898      rtl = XEXP (rtl, 1);
8899      goto plus;
8900
8901    case PRE_INC:
8902    case PRE_DEC:
8903      /* Turn these into a PLUS expression and fall into the PLUS code
8904	 below.  */
8905      rtl = gen_rtx_PLUS (word_mode, XEXP (rtl, 0),
8906			  GEN_INT (GET_CODE (rtl) == PRE_INC
8907				   ? GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (mode)
8908				   : -GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (mode)));
8909
8910      /* ... fall through ...  */
8911
8912    case PLUS:
8913    plus:
8914      if (is_based_loc (rtl))
8915	mem_loc_result = based_loc_descr (XEXP (rtl, 0),
8916					  INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)));
8917      else
8918	{
8919	  mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode);
8920	  if (mem_loc_result == 0)
8921	    break;
8922
8923	  if (GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 1)) == CONST_INT
8924	      && INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)) >= 0)
8925	    add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
8926			   new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst,
8927					  INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)), 0));
8928	  else
8929	    {
8930	      add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
8931			     mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode));
8932	      add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
8933			     new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
8934	    }
8935	}
8936      break;
8937
8938    /* If a pseudo-reg is optimized away, it is possible for it to
8939       be replaced with a MEM containing a multiply or shift.  */
8940    case MULT:
8941      op = DW_OP_mul;
8942      goto do_binop;
8943
8944    case ASHIFT:
8945      op = DW_OP_shl;
8946      goto do_binop;
8947
8948    case ASHIFTRT:
8949      op = DW_OP_shra;
8950      goto do_binop;
8951
8952    case LSHIFTRT:
8953      op = DW_OP_shr;
8954      goto do_binop;
8955
8956    do_binop:
8957      {
8958	dw_loc_descr_ref op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode);
8959	dw_loc_descr_ref op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode);
8960
8961	if (op0 == 0 || op1 == 0)
8962	  break;
8963
8964	mem_loc_result = op0;
8965	add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op1);
8966	add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
8967	break;
8968      }
8969
8970    case CONST_INT:
8971      mem_loc_result = int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (rtl));
8972      break;
8973
8974    default:
8975      gcc_unreachable ();
8976    }
8977
8978  return mem_loc_result;
8979}
8980
8981/* Return a descriptor that describes the concatenation of two locations.
8982   This is typically a complex variable.  */
8983
8984static dw_loc_descr_ref
8985concat_loc_descriptor (rtx x0, rtx x1)
8986{
8987  dw_loc_descr_ref cc_loc_result = NULL;
8988  dw_loc_descr_ref x0_ref = loc_descriptor (x0);
8989  dw_loc_descr_ref x1_ref = loc_descriptor (x1);
8990
8991  if (x0_ref == 0 || x1_ref == 0)
8992    return 0;
8993
8994  cc_loc_result = x0_ref;
8995  add_loc_descr_op_piece (&cc_loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x0)));
8996
8997  add_loc_descr (&cc_loc_result, x1_ref);
8998  add_loc_descr_op_piece (&cc_loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x1)));
8999
9000  return cc_loc_result;
9001}
9002
9003/* Output a proper Dwarf location descriptor for a variable or parameter
9004   which is either allocated in a register or in a memory location.  For a
9005   register, we just generate an OP_REG and the register number.  For a
9006   memory location we provide a Dwarf postfix expression describing how to
9007   generate the (dynamic) address of the object onto the address stack.
9008
9009   If we don't know how to describe it, return 0.  */
9010
9011static dw_loc_descr_ref
9012loc_descriptor (rtx rtl)
9013{
9014  dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result = NULL;
9015
9016  switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
9017    {
9018    case SUBREG:
9019      /* The case of a subreg may arise when we have a local (register)
9020	 variable or a formal (register) parameter which doesn't quite fill
9021	 up an entire register.  For now, just assume that it is
9022	 legitimate to make the Dwarf info refer to the whole register which
9023	 contains the given subreg.  */
9024      rtl = SUBREG_REG (rtl);
9025
9026      /* ... fall through ...  */
9027
9028    case REG:
9029      loc_result = reg_loc_descriptor (rtl);
9030      break;
9031
9032    case MEM:
9033      loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), GET_MODE (rtl));
9034      break;
9035
9036    case CONCAT:
9037      loc_result = concat_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), XEXP (rtl, 1));
9038      break;
9039
9040    case VAR_LOCATION:
9041      /* Single part.  */
9042      if (GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 1)) != PARALLEL)
9043	{
9044	  loc_result = loc_descriptor (XEXP (XEXP (rtl, 1), 0));
9045	  break;
9046	}
9047
9048      rtl = XEXP (rtl, 1);
9049      /* FALLTHRU */
9050
9051    case PARALLEL:
9052      {
9053	rtvec par_elems = XVEC (rtl, 0);
9054	int num_elem = GET_NUM_ELEM (par_elems);
9055	enum machine_mode mode;
9056	int i;
9057
9058	/* Create the first one, so we have something to add to.  */
9059	loc_result = loc_descriptor (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, 0), 0));
9060	mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, 0), 0));
9061	add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (mode));
9062	for (i = 1; i < num_elem; i++)
9063	  {
9064	    dw_loc_descr_ref temp;
9065
9066	    temp = loc_descriptor (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, i), 0));
9067	    add_loc_descr (&loc_result, temp);
9068	    mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, i), 0));
9069	    add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (mode));
9070	  }
9071      }
9072      break;
9073
9074    default:
9075      gcc_unreachable ();
9076    }
9077
9078  return loc_result;
9079}
9080
9081/* Similar, but generate the descriptor from trees instead of rtl.  This comes
9082   up particularly with variable length arrays.  WANT_ADDRESS is 2 if this is
9083   a top-level invocation of loc_descriptor_from_tree; is 1 if this is not a
9084   top-level invocation, and we require the address of LOC; is 0 if we require
9085   the value of LOC.  */
9086
9087static dw_loc_descr_ref
9088loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (tree loc, int want_address)
9089{
9090  dw_loc_descr_ref ret, ret1;
9091  int have_address = 0;
9092  enum dwarf_location_atom op;
9093
9094  /* ??? Most of the time we do not take proper care for sign/zero
9095     extending the values properly.  Hopefully this won't be a real
9096     problem...  */
9097
9098  switch (TREE_CODE (loc))
9099    {
9100    case ERROR_MARK:
9101      return 0;
9102
9103    case PLACEHOLDER_EXPR:
9104      /* This case involves extracting fields from an object to determine the
9105	 position of other fields.  We don't try to encode this here.  The
9106	 only user of this is Ada, which encodes the needed information using
9107	 the names of types.  */
9108      return 0;
9109
9110    case CALL_EXPR:
9111      return 0;
9112
9113    case PREINCREMENT_EXPR:
9114    case PREDECREMENT_EXPR:
9115    case POSTINCREMENT_EXPR:
9116    case POSTDECREMENT_EXPR:
9117      /* There are no opcodes for these operations.  */
9118      return 0;
9119
9120    case ADDR_EXPR:
9121      /* If we already want an address, there's nothing we can do.  */
9122      if (want_address)
9123	return 0;
9124
9125      /* Otherwise, process the argument and look for the address.  */
9126      return loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 1);
9127
9128    case VAR_DECL:
9129      if (DECL_THREAD_LOCAL_P (loc))
9130	{
9131	  rtx rtl;
9132
9133	  /* If this is not defined, we have no way to emit the data.  */
9134	  if (!targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel)
9135	    return 0;
9136
9137	  /* The way DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address is specified, we can only
9138	     look up addresses of objects in the current module.  */
9139	  if (DECL_EXTERNAL (loc))
9140	    return 0;
9141
9142	  rtl = rtl_for_decl_location (loc);
9143	  if (rtl == NULL_RTX)
9144	    return 0;
9145
9146	  if (!MEM_P (rtl))
9147	    return 0;
9148	  rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
9149	  if (! CONSTANT_P (rtl))
9150	    return 0;
9151
9152	  ret = new_loc_descr (INTERNAL_DW_OP_tls_addr, 0, 0);
9153	  ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
9154	  ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr = rtl;
9155
9156	  ret1 = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address, 0, 0);
9157	  add_loc_descr (&ret, ret1);
9158
9159	  have_address = 1;
9160	  break;
9161	}
9162      /* FALLTHRU */
9163
9164    case PARM_DECL:
9165      if (DECL_HAS_VALUE_EXPR_P (loc))
9166	return loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (DECL_VALUE_EXPR (loc),
9167					   want_address);
9168      /* FALLTHRU */
9169
9170    case RESULT_DECL:
9171    case FUNCTION_DECL:
9172      {
9173	rtx rtl = rtl_for_decl_location (loc);
9174
9175	if (rtl == NULL_RTX)
9176	  return 0;
9177        else if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_INT)
9178	  {
9179	    HOST_WIDE_INT val = INTVAL (rtl);
9180	    if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc)))
9181	      val &= GET_MODE_MASK (DECL_MODE (loc));
9182	    ret = int_loc_descriptor (val);
9183	  }
9184	else if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_STRING)
9185	  return 0;
9186	else if (CONSTANT_P (rtl))
9187	  {
9188	    ret = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_addr, 0, 0);
9189	    ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
9190	    ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr = rtl;
9191	  }
9192	else
9193	  {
9194	    enum machine_mode mode;
9195
9196	    /* Certain constructs can only be represented at top-level.  */
9197	    if (want_address == 2)
9198	      return loc_descriptor (rtl);
9199
9200	    mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
9201	    if (MEM_P (rtl))
9202	      {
9203		rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
9204		have_address = 1;
9205	      }
9206	    ret = mem_loc_descriptor (rtl, mode);
9207	  }
9208      }
9209      break;
9210
9211    case INDIRECT_REF:
9212      ret = loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
9213      have_address = 1;
9214      break;
9215
9216    case COMPOUND_EXPR:
9217      return loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), want_address);
9218
9219    case NOP_EXPR:
9220    case CONVERT_EXPR:
9221    case NON_LVALUE_EXPR:
9222    case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
9223    case SAVE_EXPR:
9224    case MODIFY_EXPR:
9225      return loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), want_address);
9226
9227    case COMPONENT_REF:
9228    case BIT_FIELD_REF:
9229    case ARRAY_REF:
9230    case ARRAY_RANGE_REF:
9231      {
9232	tree obj, offset;
9233	HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, bitpos, bytepos;
9234	enum machine_mode mode;
9235	int volatilep;
9236	int unsignedp = TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc));
9237
9238	obj = get_inner_reference (loc, &bitsize, &bitpos, &offset, &mode,
9239				   &unsignedp, &volatilep, false);
9240
9241	if (obj == loc)
9242	  return 0;
9243
9244	ret = loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (obj, 1);
9245	if (ret == 0
9246	    || bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT != 0 || bitsize % BITS_PER_UNIT != 0)
9247	  return 0;
9248
9249	if (offset != NULL_TREE)
9250	  {
9251	    /* Variable offset.  */
9252	    add_loc_descr (&ret, loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (offset, 0));
9253	    add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
9254	  }
9255
9256	bytepos = bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT;
9257	if (bytepos > 0)
9258	  add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, bytepos, 0));
9259	else if (bytepos < 0)
9260	  {
9261	    add_loc_descr (&ret, int_loc_descriptor (bytepos));
9262	    add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
9263	  }
9264
9265	have_address = 1;
9266	break;
9267      }
9268
9269    case INTEGER_CST:
9270      if (host_integerp (loc, 0))
9271	ret = int_loc_descriptor (tree_low_cst (loc, 0));
9272      else
9273	return 0;
9274      break;
9275
9276    case CONSTRUCTOR:
9277      {
9278	/* Get an RTL for this, if something has been emitted.  */
9279	rtx rtl = lookup_constant_def (loc);
9280	enum machine_mode mode;
9281
9282	if (!rtl || !MEM_P (rtl))
9283	  return 0;
9284	mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
9285	rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
9286	ret = mem_loc_descriptor (rtl, mode);
9287	have_address = 1;
9288	break;
9289      }
9290
9291    case TRUTH_AND_EXPR:
9292    case TRUTH_ANDIF_EXPR:
9293    case BIT_AND_EXPR:
9294      op = DW_OP_and;
9295      goto do_binop;
9296
9297    case TRUTH_XOR_EXPR:
9298    case BIT_XOR_EXPR:
9299      op = DW_OP_xor;
9300      goto do_binop;
9301
9302    case TRUTH_OR_EXPR:
9303    case TRUTH_ORIF_EXPR:
9304    case BIT_IOR_EXPR:
9305      op = DW_OP_or;
9306      goto do_binop;
9307
9308    case FLOOR_DIV_EXPR:
9309    case CEIL_DIV_EXPR:
9310    case ROUND_DIV_EXPR:
9311    case TRUNC_DIV_EXPR:
9312      op = DW_OP_div;
9313      goto do_binop;
9314
9315    case MINUS_EXPR:
9316      op = DW_OP_minus;
9317      goto do_binop;
9318
9319    case FLOOR_MOD_EXPR:
9320    case CEIL_MOD_EXPR:
9321    case ROUND_MOD_EXPR:
9322    case TRUNC_MOD_EXPR:
9323      op = DW_OP_mod;
9324      goto do_binop;
9325
9326    case MULT_EXPR:
9327      op = DW_OP_mul;
9328      goto do_binop;
9329
9330    case LSHIFT_EXPR:
9331      op = DW_OP_shl;
9332      goto do_binop;
9333
9334    case RSHIFT_EXPR:
9335      op = (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc)) ? DW_OP_shr : DW_OP_shra);
9336      goto do_binop;
9337
9338    case PLUS_EXPR:
9339      if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1)) == INTEGER_CST
9340	  && host_integerp (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0))
9341	{
9342	  ret = loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
9343	  if (ret == 0)
9344	    return 0;
9345
9346	  add_loc_descr (&ret,
9347			 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst,
9348					tree_low_cst (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1),
9349						      0),
9350					0));
9351	  break;
9352	}
9353
9354      op = DW_OP_plus;
9355      goto do_binop;
9356
9357    case LE_EXPR:
9358      if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))))
9359	return 0;
9360
9361      op = DW_OP_le;
9362      goto do_binop;
9363
9364    case GE_EXPR:
9365      if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))))
9366	return 0;
9367
9368      op = DW_OP_ge;
9369      goto do_binop;
9370
9371    case LT_EXPR:
9372      if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))))
9373	return 0;
9374
9375      op = DW_OP_lt;
9376      goto do_binop;
9377
9378    case GT_EXPR:
9379      if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))))
9380	return 0;
9381
9382      op = DW_OP_gt;
9383      goto do_binop;
9384
9385    case EQ_EXPR:
9386      op = DW_OP_eq;
9387      goto do_binop;
9388
9389    case NE_EXPR:
9390      op = DW_OP_ne;
9391      goto do_binop;
9392
9393    do_binop:
9394      ret = loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
9395      ret1 = loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0);
9396      if (ret == 0 || ret1 == 0)
9397	return 0;
9398
9399      add_loc_descr (&ret, ret1);
9400      add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
9401      break;
9402
9403    case TRUTH_NOT_EXPR:
9404    case BIT_NOT_EXPR:
9405      op = DW_OP_not;
9406      goto do_unop;
9407
9408    case ABS_EXPR:
9409      op = DW_OP_abs;
9410      goto do_unop;
9411
9412    case NEGATE_EXPR:
9413      op = DW_OP_neg;
9414      goto do_unop;
9415
9416    do_unop:
9417      ret = loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
9418      if (ret == 0)
9419	return 0;
9420
9421      add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
9422      break;
9423
9424    case MIN_EXPR:
9425    case MAX_EXPR:
9426      {
9427        const enum tree_code code =
9428          TREE_CODE (loc) == MIN_EXPR ? GT_EXPR : LT_EXPR;
9429
9430        loc = build3 (COND_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (loc),
9431		      build2 (code, integer_type_node,
9432			      TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1)),
9433                      TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0));
9434      }
9435
9436      /* ... fall through ...  */
9437
9438    case COND_EXPR:
9439      {
9440	dw_loc_descr_ref lhs
9441	  = loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0);
9442	dw_loc_descr_ref rhs
9443	  = loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 2), 0);
9444	dw_loc_descr_ref bra_node, jump_node, tmp;
9445
9446	ret = loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
9447	if (ret == 0 || lhs == 0 || rhs == 0)
9448	  return 0;
9449
9450	bra_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
9451	add_loc_descr (&ret, bra_node);
9452
9453	add_loc_descr (&ret, rhs);
9454	jump_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_skip, 0, 0);
9455	add_loc_descr (&ret, jump_node);
9456
9457	add_loc_descr (&ret, lhs);
9458	bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
9459	bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = lhs;
9460
9461	/* ??? Need a node to point the skip at.  Use a nop.  */
9462	tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_nop, 0, 0);
9463	add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
9464	jump_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
9465	jump_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = tmp;
9466      }
9467      break;
9468
9469    case FIX_TRUNC_EXPR:
9470    case FIX_CEIL_EXPR:
9471    case FIX_FLOOR_EXPR:
9472    case FIX_ROUND_EXPR:
9473      return 0;
9474
9475    default:
9476      /* Leave front-end specific codes as simply unknown.  This comes
9477	 up, for instance, with the C STMT_EXPR.  */
9478      if ((unsigned int) TREE_CODE (loc)
9479          >= (unsigned int) LAST_AND_UNUSED_TREE_CODE)
9480	return 0;
9481
9482#ifdef ENABLE_CHECKING
9483      /* Otherwise this is a generic code; we should just lists all of
9484	 these explicitly.  We forgot one.  */
9485      gcc_unreachable ();
9486#else
9487      /* In a release build, we want to degrade gracefully: better to
9488	 generate incomplete debugging information than to crash.  */
9489      return NULL;
9490#endif
9491    }
9492
9493  /* Show if we can't fill the request for an address.  */
9494  if (want_address && !have_address)
9495    return 0;
9496
9497  /* If we've got an address and don't want one, dereference.  */
9498  if (!want_address && have_address && ret)
9499    {
9500      HOST_WIDE_INT size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc));
9501
9502      if (size > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE || size == -1)
9503	return 0;
9504      else if (size == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
9505	op = DW_OP_deref;
9506      else
9507	op = DW_OP_deref_size;
9508
9509      add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (op, size, 0));
9510    }
9511
9512  return ret;
9513}
9514
9515static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
9516loc_descriptor_from_tree (tree loc)
9517{
9518  return loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (loc, 2);
9519}
9520
9521/* Given a value, round it up to the lowest multiple of `boundary'
9522   which is not less than the value itself.  */
9523
9524static inline HOST_WIDE_INT
9525ceiling (HOST_WIDE_INT value, unsigned int boundary)
9526{
9527  return (((value + boundary - 1) / boundary) * boundary);
9528}
9529
9530/* Given a pointer to what is assumed to be a FIELD_DECL node, return a
9531   pointer to the declared type for the relevant field variable, or return
9532   `integer_type_node' if the given node turns out to be an
9533   ERROR_MARK node.  */
9534
9535static inline tree
9536field_type (tree decl)
9537{
9538  tree type;
9539
9540  if (TREE_CODE (decl) == ERROR_MARK)
9541    return integer_type_node;
9542
9543  type = DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl);
9544  if (type == NULL_TREE)
9545    type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
9546
9547  return type;
9548}
9549
9550/* Given a pointer to a tree node, return the alignment in bits for
9551   it, or else return BITS_PER_WORD if the node actually turns out to
9552   be an ERROR_MARK node.  */
9553
9554static inline unsigned
9555simple_type_align_in_bits (tree type)
9556{
9557  return (TREE_CODE (type) != ERROR_MARK) ? TYPE_ALIGN (type) : BITS_PER_WORD;
9558}
9559
9560static inline unsigned
9561simple_decl_align_in_bits (tree decl)
9562{
9563  return (TREE_CODE (decl) != ERROR_MARK) ? DECL_ALIGN (decl) : BITS_PER_WORD;
9564}
9565
9566/* Given a pointer to a FIELD_DECL, compute and return the byte offset of the
9567   lowest addressed byte of the "containing object" for the given FIELD_DECL,
9568   or return 0 if we are unable to determine what that offset is, either
9569   because the argument turns out to be a pointer to an ERROR_MARK node, or
9570   because the offset is actually variable.  (We can't handle the latter case
9571   just yet).  */
9572
9573static HOST_WIDE_INT
9574field_byte_offset (tree decl)
9575{
9576  unsigned int type_align_in_bits;
9577  unsigned int decl_align_in_bits;
9578  unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT type_size_in_bits;
9579  HOST_WIDE_INT object_offset_in_bits;
9580  tree type;
9581  tree field_size_tree;
9582  HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos_int;
9583  HOST_WIDE_INT deepest_bitpos;
9584  unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT field_size_in_bits;
9585
9586  if (TREE_CODE (decl) == ERROR_MARK)
9587    return 0;
9588
9589  gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL);
9590
9591  type = field_type (decl);
9592  field_size_tree = DECL_SIZE (decl);
9593
9594  /* The size could be unspecified if there was an error, or for
9595     a flexible array member.  */
9596  if (! field_size_tree)
9597    field_size_tree = bitsize_zero_node;
9598
9599  /* We cannot yet cope with fields whose positions are variable, so
9600     for now, when we see such things, we simply return 0.  Someday, we may
9601     be able to handle such cases, but it will be damn difficult.  */
9602  if (! host_integerp (bit_position (decl), 0))
9603    return 0;
9604
9605  bitpos_int = int_bit_position (decl);
9606
9607  /* If we don't know the size of the field, pretend it's a full word.  */
9608  if (host_integerp (field_size_tree, 1))
9609    field_size_in_bits = tree_low_cst (field_size_tree, 1);
9610  else
9611    field_size_in_bits = BITS_PER_WORD;
9612
9613  type_size_in_bits = simple_type_size_in_bits (type);
9614  type_align_in_bits = simple_type_align_in_bits (type);
9615  decl_align_in_bits = simple_decl_align_in_bits (decl);
9616
9617  /* The GCC front-end doesn't make any attempt to keep track of the starting
9618     bit offset (relative to the start of the containing structure type) of the
9619     hypothetical "containing object" for a bit-field.  Thus, when computing
9620     the byte offset value for the start of the "containing object" of a
9621     bit-field, we must deduce this information on our own. This can be rather
9622     tricky to do in some cases.  For example, handling the following structure
9623     type definition when compiling for an i386/i486 target (which only aligns
9624     long long's to 32-bit boundaries) can be very tricky:
9625
9626	 struct S { int field1; long long field2:31; };
9627
9628     Fortunately, there is a simple rule-of-thumb which can be used in such
9629     cases.  When compiling for an i386/i486, GCC will allocate 8 bytes for the
9630     structure shown above.  It decides to do this based upon one simple rule
9631     for bit-field allocation.  GCC allocates each "containing object" for each
9632     bit-field at the first (i.e. lowest addressed) legitimate alignment
9633     boundary (based upon the required minimum alignment for the declared type
9634     of the field) which it can possibly use, subject to the condition that
9635     there is still enough available space remaining in the containing object
9636     (when allocated at the selected point) to fully accommodate all of the
9637     bits of the bit-field itself.
9638
9639     This simple rule makes it obvious why GCC allocates 8 bytes for each
9640     object of the structure type shown above.  When looking for a place to
9641     allocate the "containing object" for `field2', the compiler simply tries
9642     to allocate a 64-bit "containing object" at each successive 32-bit
9643     boundary (starting at zero) until it finds a place to allocate that 64-
9644     bit field such that at least 31 contiguous (and previously unallocated)
9645     bits remain within that selected 64 bit field.  (As it turns out, for the
9646     example above, the compiler finds it is OK to allocate the "containing
9647     object" 64-bit field at bit-offset zero within the structure type.)
9648
9649     Here we attempt to work backwards from the limited set of facts we're
9650     given, and we try to deduce from those facts, where GCC must have believed
9651     that the containing object started (within the structure type). The value
9652     we deduce is then used (by the callers of this routine) to generate
9653     DW_AT_location and DW_AT_bit_offset attributes for fields (both bit-fields
9654     and, in the case of DW_AT_location, regular fields as well).  */
9655
9656  /* Figure out the bit-distance from the start of the structure to the
9657     "deepest" bit of the bit-field.  */
9658  deepest_bitpos = bitpos_int + field_size_in_bits;
9659
9660  /* This is the tricky part.  Use some fancy footwork to deduce where the
9661     lowest addressed bit of the containing object must be.  */
9662  object_offset_in_bits = deepest_bitpos - type_size_in_bits;
9663
9664  /* Round up to type_align by default.  This works best for bitfields.  */
9665  object_offset_in_bits += type_align_in_bits - 1;
9666  object_offset_in_bits /= type_align_in_bits;
9667  object_offset_in_bits *= type_align_in_bits;
9668
9669  if (object_offset_in_bits > bitpos_int)
9670    {
9671      /* Sigh, the decl must be packed.  */
9672      object_offset_in_bits = deepest_bitpos - type_size_in_bits;
9673
9674      /* Round up to decl_align instead.  */
9675      object_offset_in_bits += decl_align_in_bits - 1;
9676      object_offset_in_bits /= decl_align_in_bits;
9677      object_offset_in_bits *= decl_align_in_bits;
9678    }
9679
9680  return object_offset_in_bits / BITS_PER_UNIT;
9681}
9682
9683/* The following routines define various Dwarf attributes and any data
9684   associated with them.  */
9685
9686/* Add a location description attribute value to a DIE.
9687
9688   This emits location attributes suitable for whole variables and
9689   whole parameters.  Note that the location attributes for struct fields are
9690   generated by the routine `data_member_location_attribute' below.  */
9691
9692static inline void
9693add_AT_location_description (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
9694			     dw_loc_descr_ref descr)
9695{
9696  if (descr != 0)
9697    add_AT_loc (die, attr_kind, descr);
9698}
9699
9700/* Attach the specialized form of location attribute used for data members of
9701   struct and union types.  In the special case of a FIELD_DECL node which
9702   represents a bit-field, the "offset" part of this special location
9703   descriptor must indicate the distance in bytes from the lowest-addressed
9704   byte of the containing struct or union type to the lowest-addressed byte of
9705   the "containing object" for the bit-field.  (See the `field_byte_offset'
9706   function above).
9707
9708   For any given bit-field, the "containing object" is a hypothetical object
9709   (of some integral or enum type) within which the given bit-field lives.  The
9710   type of this hypothetical "containing object" is always the same as the
9711   declared type of the individual bit-field itself (for GCC anyway... the
9712   DWARF spec doesn't actually mandate this).  Note that it is the size (in
9713   bytes) of the hypothetical "containing object" which will be given in the
9714   DW_AT_byte_size attribute for this bit-field.  (See the
9715   `byte_size_attribute' function below.)  It is also used when calculating the
9716   value of the DW_AT_bit_offset attribute.  (See the `bit_offset_attribute'
9717   function below.)  */
9718
9719static void
9720add_data_member_location_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
9721{
9722  HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
9723  dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descr = 0;
9724
9725  if (TREE_CODE (decl) == TREE_BINFO)
9726    {
9727      /* We're working on the TAG_inheritance for a base class.  */
9728      if (BINFO_VIRTUAL_P (decl) && is_cxx ())
9729	{
9730	  /* For C++ virtual bases we can't just use BINFO_OFFSET, as they
9731	     aren't at a fixed offset from all (sub)objects of the same
9732	     type.  We need to extract the appropriate offset from our
9733	     vtable.  The following dwarf expression means
9734
9735	       BaseAddr = ObAddr + *((*ObAddr) - Offset)
9736
9737	     This is specific to the V3 ABI, of course.  */
9738
9739	  dw_loc_descr_ref tmp;
9740
9741	  /* Make a copy of the object address.  */
9742	  tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_dup, 0, 0);
9743	  add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
9744
9745	  /* Extract the vtable address.  */
9746	  tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
9747	  add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
9748
9749	  /* Calculate the address of the offset.  */
9750	  offset = tree_low_cst (BINFO_VPTR_FIELD (decl), 0);
9751	  gcc_assert (offset < 0);
9752
9753	  tmp = int_loc_descriptor (-offset);
9754	  add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
9755	  tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_minus, 0, 0);
9756	  add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
9757
9758	  /* Extract the offset.  */
9759	  tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
9760	  add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
9761
9762	  /* Add it to the object address.  */
9763	  tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0);
9764	  add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
9765	}
9766      else
9767	offset = tree_low_cst (BINFO_OFFSET (decl), 0);
9768    }
9769  else
9770    offset = field_byte_offset (decl);
9771
9772  if (! loc_descr)
9773    {
9774      enum dwarf_location_atom op;
9775
9776      /* The DWARF2 standard says that we should assume that the structure
9777	 address is already on the stack, so we can specify a structure field
9778	 address by using DW_OP_plus_uconst.  */
9779
9780#ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
9781      /* ??? The SGI dwarf reader does not handle the DW_OP_plus_uconst
9782	 operator correctly.  It works only if we leave the offset on the
9783	 stack.  */
9784      op = DW_OP_constu;
9785#else
9786      op = DW_OP_plus_uconst;
9787#endif
9788
9789      loc_descr = new_loc_descr (op, offset, 0);
9790    }
9791
9792  add_AT_loc (die, DW_AT_data_member_location, loc_descr);
9793}
9794
9795/* Writes integer values to dw_vec_const array.  */
9796
9797static void
9798insert_int (HOST_WIDE_INT val, unsigned int size, unsigned char *dest)
9799{
9800  while (size != 0)
9801    {
9802      *dest++ = val & 0xff;
9803      val >>= 8;
9804      --size;
9805    }
9806}
9807
9808/* Reads integers from dw_vec_const array.  Inverse of insert_int.  */
9809
9810static HOST_WIDE_INT
9811extract_int (const unsigned char *src, unsigned int size)
9812{
9813  HOST_WIDE_INT val = 0;
9814
9815  src += size;
9816  while (size != 0)
9817    {
9818      val <<= 8;
9819      val |= *--src & 0xff;
9820      --size;
9821    }
9822  return val;
9823}
9824
9825/* Writes floating point values to dw_vec_const array.  */
9826
9827static void
9828insert_float (rtx rtl, unsigned char *array)
9829{
9830  REAL_VALUE_TYPE rv;
9831  long val[4];
9832  int i;
9833
9834  REAL_VALUE_FROM_CONST_DOUBLE (rv, rtl);
9835  real_to_target (val, &rv, GET_MODE (rtl));
9836
9837  /* real_to_target puts 32-bit pieces in each long.  Pack them.  */
9838  for (i = 0; i < GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl)) / 4; i++)
9839    {
9840      insert_int (val[i], 4, array);
9841      array += 4;
9842    }
9843}
9844
9845/* Attach a DW_AT_const_value attribute for a variable or a parameter which
9846   does not have a "location" either in memory or in a register.  These
9847   things can arise in GNU C when a constant is passed as an actual parameter
9848   to an inlined function.  They can also arise in C++ where declared
9849   constants do not necessarily get memory "homes".  */
9850
9851static void
9852add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref die, rtx rtl)
9853{
9854  switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
9855    {
9856    case CONST_INT:
9857      {
9858	HOST_WIDE_INT val = INTVAL (rtl);
9859
9860	if (val < 0)
9861	  add_AT_int (die, DW_AT_const_value, val);
9862	else
9863	  add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_const_value, (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) val);
9864      }
9865      break;
9866
9867    case CONST_DOUBLE:
9868      /* Note that a CONST_DOUBLE rtx could represent either an integer or a
9869	 floating-point constant.  A CONST_DOUBLE is used whenever the
9870	 constant requires more than one word in order to be adequately
9871	 represented.  We output CONST_DOUBLEs as blocks.  */
9872      {
9873	enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
9874
9875	if (SCALAR_FLOAT_MODE_P (mode))
9876	  {
9877	    unsigned int length = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
9878	    unsigned char *array = ggc_alloc (length);
9879
9880	    insert_float (rtl, array);
9881	    add_AT_vec (die, DW_AT_const_value, length / 4, 4, array);
9882	  }
9883	else
9884	  {
9885	    /* ??? We really should be using HOST_WIDE_INT throughout.  */
9886	    gcc_assert (HOST_BITS_PER_LONG == HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT);
9887
9888	    add_AT_long_long (die, DW_AT_const_value,
9889			      CONST_DOUBLE_HIGH (rtl), CONST_DOUBLE_LOW (rtl));
9890	  }
9891      }
9892      break;
9893
9894    case CONST_VECTOR:
9895      {
9896	enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
9897	unsigned int elt_size = GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (mode);
9898	unsigned int length = CONST_VECTOR_NUNITS (rtl);
9899	unsigned char *array = ggc_alloc (length * elt_size);
9900	unsigned int i;
9901	unsigned char *p;
9902
9903	switch (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode))
9904	  {
9905	  case MODE_VECTOR_INT:
9906	    for (i = 0, p = array; i < length; i++, p += elt_size)
9907	      {
9908		rtx elt = CONST_VECTOR_ELT (rtl, i);
9909		HOST_WIDE_INT lo, hi;
9910
9911		switch (GET_CODE (elt))
9912		  {
9913		  case CONST_INT:
9914		    lo = INTVAL (elt);
9915		    hi = -(lo < 0);
9916		    break;
9917
9918		  case CONST_DOUBLE:
9919		    lo = CONST_DOUBLE_LOW (elt);
9920		    hi = CONST_DOUBLE_HIGH (elt);
9921		    break;
9922
9923		  default:
9924		    gcc_unreachable ();
9925		  }
9926
9927		if (elt_size <= sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT))
9928		  insert_int (lo, elt_size, p);
9929		else
9930		  {
9931		    unsigned char *p0 = p;
9932		    unsigned char *p1 = p + sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT);
9933
9934		    gcc_assert (elt_size == 2 * sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT));
9935		    if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
9936		      {
9937			p0 = p1;
9938			p1 = p;
9939		      }
9940		    insert_int (lo, sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT), p0);
9941		    insert_int (hi, sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT), p1);
9942		  }
9943	      }
9944	    break;
9945
9946	  case MODE_VECTOR_FLOAT:
9947	    for (i = 0, p = array; i < length; i++, p += elt_size)
9948	      {
9949		rtx elt = CONST_VECTOR_ELT (rtl, i);
9950		insert_float (elt, p);
9951	      }
9952	    break;
9953
9954	  default:
9955	    gcc_unreachable ();
9956	  }
9957
9958	add_AT_vec (die, DW_AT_const_value, length, elt_size, array);
9959      }
9960      break;
9961
9962    case CONST_STRING:
9963      add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_const_value, XSTR (rtl, 0));
9964      break;
9965
9966    case SYMBOL_REF:
9967    case LABEL_REF:
9968    case CONST:
9969      add_AT_addr (die, DW_AT_const_value, rtl);
9970      VEC_safe_push (rtx, gc, used_rtx_array, rtl);
9971      break;
9972
9973    case PLUS:
9974      /* In cases where an inlined instance of an inline function is passed
9975	 the address of an `auto' variable (which is local to the caller) we
9976	 can get a situation where the DECL_RTL of the artificial local
9977	 variable (for the inlining) which acts as a stand-in for the
9978	 corresponding formal parameter (of the inline function) will look
9979	 like (plus:SI (reg:SI FRAME_PTR) (const_int ...)).  This is not
9980	 exactly a compile-time constant expression, but it isn't the address
9981	 of the (artificial) local variable either.  Rather, it represents the
9982	 *value* which the artificial local variable always has during its
9983	 lifetime.  We currently have no way to represent such quasi-constant
9984	 values in Dwarf, so for now we just punt and generate nothing.  */
9985      break;
9986
9987    default:
9988      /* No other kinds of rtx should be possible here.  */
9989      gcc_unreachable ();
9990    }
9991
9992}
9993
9994/* Determine whether the evaluation of EXPR references any variables
9995   or functions which aren't otherwise used (and therefore may not be
9996   output).  */
9997static tree
9998reference_to_unused (tree * tp, int * walk_subtrees,
9999		     void * data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
10000{
10001  if (! EXPR_P (*tp) && ! CONSTANT_CLASS_P (*tp))
10002    *walk_subtrees = 0;
10003
10004  if (DECL_P (*tp) && ! TREE_PUBLIC (*tp) && ! TREE_USED (*tp)
10005      && ! TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (*tp))
10006    return *tp;
10007  else if (!flag_unit_at_a_time)
10008    return NULL_TREE;
10009  else if (!cgraph_global_info_ready
10010	   && (TREE_CODE (*tp) == VAR_DECL || TREE_CODE (*tp) == FUNCTION_DECL))
10011    return *tp;
10012  else if (DECL_P (*tp) && TREE_CODE (*tp) == VAR_DECL)
10013    {
10014      struct cgraph_varpool_node *node = cgraph_varpool_node (*tp);
10015      if (!node->needed)
10016	return *tp;
10017    }
10018   else if (DECL_P (*tp) && TREE_CODE (*tp) == FUNCTION_DECL
10019	    && (!DECL_EXTERNAL (*tp) || DECL_DECLARED_INLINE_P (*tp)))
10020    {
10021      struct cgraph_node *node = cgraph_node (*tp);
10022      if (!node->output)
10023        return *tp;
10024    }
10025
10026  return NULL_TREE;
10027}
10028
10029/* Generate an RTL constant from a decl initializer INIT with decl type TYPE,
10030   for use in a later add_const_value_attribute call.  */
10031
10032static rtx
10033rtl_for_decl_init (tree init, tree type)
10034{
10035  rtx rtl = NULL_RTX;
10036
10037  /* If a variable is initialized with a string constant without embedded
10038     zeros, build CONST_STRING.  */
10039  if (TREE_CODE (init) == STRING_CST && TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
10040    {
10041      tree enttype = TREE_TYPE (type);
10042      tree domain = TYPE_DOMAIN (type);
10043      enum machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (enttype);
10044
10045      if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == 1
10046	  && domain
10047	  && integer_zerop (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain))
10048	  && compare_tree_int (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain),
10049			       TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init) - 1) == 0
10050	  && ((size_t) TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init)
10051	      == strlen (TREE_STRING_POINTER (init)) + 1))
10052	rtl = gen_rtx_CONST_STRING (VOIDmode,
10053				    ggc_strdup (TREE_STRING_POINTER (init)));
10054    }
10055  /* Other aggregates, and complex values, could be represented using
10056     CONCAT: FIXME!  */
10057  else if (AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (type) || TREE_CODE (type) == COMPLEX_TYPE)
10058    ;
10059  /* Vectors only work if their mode is supported by the target.
10060     FIXME: generic vectors ought to work too.  */
10061  else if (TREE_CODE (type) == VECTOR_TYPE && TYPE_MODE (type) == BLKmode)
10062    ;
10063  /* If the initializer is something that we know will expand into an
10064     immediate RTL constant, expand it now.  We must be careful not to
10065     reference variables which won't be output.  */
10066  else if (initializer_constant_valid_p (init, type)
10067	   && ! walk_tree (&init, reference_to_unused, NULL, NULL))
10068    {
10069      /* Convert vector CONSTRUCTOR initializers to VECTOR_CST if
10070	 possible.  */
10071      if (TREE_CODE (type) == VECTOR_TYPE)
10072	switch (TREE_CODE (init))
10073	  {
10074	  case VECTOR_CST:
10075	    break;
10076	  case CONSTRUCTOR:
10077	    if (TREE_CONSTANT (init))
10078	      {
10079		VEC(constructor_elt,gc) *elts = CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (init);
10080		bool constant_p = true;
10081		tree value;
10082		unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT ix;
10083
10084		/* Even when ctor is constant, it might contain non-*_CST
10085		   elements (e.g. { 1.0/0.0 - 1.0/0.0, 0.0 }) and those don't
10086		   belong into VECTOR_CST nodes.  */
10087		FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_VALUE (elts, ix, value)
10088		  if (!CONSTANT_CLASS_P (value))
10089		    {
10090		      constant_p = false;
10091		      break;
10092		    }
10093
10094		if (constant_p)
10095		  {
10096		    init = build_vector_from_ctor (type, elts);
10097		    break;
10098		  }
10099	      }
10100	    /* FALLTHRU */
10101
10102	  default:
10103	    return NULL;
10104	  }
10105
10106      rtl = expand_expr (init, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_INITIALIZER);
10107
10108      /* If expand_expr returns a MEM, it wasn't immediate.  */
10109      gcc_assert (!rtl || !MEM_P (rtl));
10110    }
10111
10112  return rtl;
10113}
10114
10115/* Generate RTL for the variable DECL to represent its location.  */
10116
10117static rtx
10118rtl_for_decl_location (tree decl)
10119{
10120  rtx rtl;
10121
10122  /* Here we have to decide where we are going to say the parameter "lives"
10123     (as far as the debugger is concerned).  We only have a couple of
10124     choices.  GCC provides us with DECL_RTL and with DECL_INCOMING_RTL.
10125
10126     DECL_RTL normally indicates where the parameter lives during most of the
10127     activation of the function.  If optimization is enabled however, this
10128     could be either NULL or else a pseudo-reg.  Both of those cases indicate
10129     that the parameter doesn't really live anywhere (as far as the code
10130     generation parts of GCC are concerned) during most of the function's
10131     activation.  That will happen (for example) if the parameter is never
10132     referenced within the function.
10133
10134     We could just generate a location descriptor here for all non-NULL
10135     non-pseudo values of DECL_RTL and ignore all of the rest, but we can be
10136     a little nicer than that if we also consider DECL_INCOMING_RTL in cases
10137     where DECL_RTL is NULL or is a pseudo-reg.
10138
10139     Note however that we can only get away with using DECL_INCOMING_RTL as
10140     a backup substitute for DECL_RTL in certain limited cases.  In cases
10141     where DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) indicates the same type as TREE_TYPE (decl),
10142     we can be sure that the parameter was passed using the same type as it is
10143     declared to have within the function, and that its DECL_INCOMING_RTL
10144     points us to a place where a value of that type is passed.
10145
10146     In cases where DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) and TREE_TYPE (decl) are different,
10147     we cannot (in general) use DECL_INCOMING_RTL as a substitute for DECL_RTL
10148     because in these cases DECL_INCOMING_RTL points us to a value of some
10149     type which is *different* from the type of the parameter itself.  Thus,
10150     if we tried to use DECL_INCOMING_RTL to generate a location attribute in
10151     such cases, the debugger would end up (for example) trying to fetch a
10152     `float' from a place which actually contains the first part of a
10153     `double'.  That would lead to really incorrect and confusing
10154     output at debug-time.
10155
10156     So, in general, we *do not* use DECL_INCOMING_RTL as a backup for DECL_RTL
10157     in cases where DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) != TREE_TYPE (decl).  There
10158     are a couple of exceptions however.  On little-endian machines we can
10159     get away with using DECL_INCOMING_RTL even when DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) is
10160     not the same as TREE_TYPE (decl), but only when DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) is
10161     an integral type that is smaller than TREE_TYPE (decl). These cases arise
10162     when (on a little-endian machine) a non-prototyped function has a
10163     parameter declared to be of type `short' or `char'.  In such cases,
10164     TREE_TYPE (decl) will be `short' or `char', DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) will
10165     be `int', and DECL_INCOMING_RTL will point to the lowest-order byte of the
10166     passed `int' value.  If the debugger then uses that address to fetch
10167     a `short' or a `char' (on a little-endian machine) the result will be
10168     the correct data, so we allow for such exceptional cases below.
10169
10170     Note that our goal here is to describe the place where the given formal
10171     parameter lives during most of the function's activation (i.e. between the
10172     end of the prologue and the start of the epilogue).  We'll do that as best
10173     as we can. Note however that if the given formal parameter is modified
10174     sometime during the execution of the function, then a stack backtrace (at
10175     debug-time) will show the function as having been called with the *new*
10176     value rather than the value which was originally passed in.  This happens
10177     rarely enough that it is not a major problem, but it *is* a problem, and
10178     I'd like to fix it.
10179
10180     A future version of dwarf2out.c may generate two additional attributes for
10181     any given DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIE which will describe the "passed
10182     type" and the "passed location" for the given formal parameter in addition
10183     to the attributes we now generate to indicate the "declared type" and the
10184     "active location" for each parameter.  This additional set of attributes
10185     could be used by debuggers for stack backtraces. Separately, note that
10186     sometimes DECL_RTL can be NULL and DECL_INCOMING_RTL can be NULL also.
10187     This happens (for example) for inlined-instances of inline function formal
10188     parameters which are never referenced.  This really shouldn't be
10189     happening.  All PARM_DECL nodes should get valid non-NULL
10190     DECL_INCOMING_RTL values.  FIXME.  */
10191
10192  /* Use DECL_RTL as the "location" unless we find something better.  */
10193  rtl = DECL_RTL_IF_SET (decl);
10194
10195  /* When generating abstract instances, ignore everything except
10196     constants, symbols living in memory, and symbols living in
10197     fixed registers.  */
10198  if (! reload_completed)
10199    {
10200      if (rtl
10201	  && (CONSTANT_P (rtl)
10202	      || (MEM_P (rtl)
10203	          && CONSTANT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0)))
10204	      || (REG_P (rtl)
10205	          && TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL
10206		  && TREE_STATIC (decl))))
10207	{
10208	  rtl = targetm.delegitimize_address (rtl);
10209	  return rtl;
10210	}
10211      rtl = NULL_RTX;
10212    }
10213  else if (TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL)
10214    {
10215      if (rtl == NULL_RTX || is_pseudo_reg (rtl))
10216	{
10217	  tree declared_type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
10218	  tree passed_type = DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl);
10219	  enum machine_mode dmode = TYPE_MODE (declared_type);
10220	  enum machine_mode pmode = TYPE_MODE (passed_type);
10221
10222	  /* This decl represents a formal parameter which was optimized out.
10223	     Note that DECL_INCOMING_RTL may be NULL in here, but we handle
10224	     all cases where (rtl == NULL_RTX) just below.  */
10225	  if (dmode == pmode)
10226	    rtl = DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl);
10227	  else if (SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (dmode)
10228		   && GET_MODE_SIZE (dmode) <= GET_MODE_SIZE (pmode)
10229		   && DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl))
10230	    {
10231	      rtx inc = DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl);
10232	      if (REG_P (inc))
10233		rtl = inc;
10234	      else if (MEM_P (inc))
10235		{
10236		  if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
10237		    rtl = adjust_address_nv (inc, dmode,
10238					     GET_MODE_SIZE (pmode)
10239					     - GET_MODE_SIZE (dmode));
10240		  else
10241		    rtl = inc;
10242		}
10243	    }
10244	}
10245
10246      /* If the parm was passed in registers, but lives on the stack, then
10247	 make a big endian correction if the mode of the type of the
10248	 parameter is not the same as the mode of the rtl.  */
10249      /* ??? This is the same series of checks that are made in dbxout.c before
10250	 we reach the big endian correction code there.  It isn't clear if all
10251	 of these checks are necessary here, but keeping them all is the safe
10252	 thing to do.  */
10253      else if (MEM_P (rtl)
10254	       && XEXP (rtl, 0) != const0_rtx
10255	       && ! CONSTANT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
10256	       /* Not passed in memory.  */
10257	       && !MEM_P (DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl))
10258	       /* Not passed by invisible reference.  */
10259	       && (!REG_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
10260		   || REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
10261		   || REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
10262#if ARG_POINTER_REGNUM != HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
10263		   || REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
10264#endif
10265		     )
10266	       /* Big endian correction check.  */
10267	       && BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
10268	       && TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) != GET_MODE (rtl)
10269	       && (GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)))
10270		   < UNITS_PER_WORD))
10271	{
10272	  int offset = (UNITS_PER_WORD
10273			- GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl))));
10274
10275	  rtl = gen_rtx_MEM (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
10276			     plus_constant (XEXP (rtl, 0), offset));
10277	}
10278    }
10279  else if (TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL
10280	   && rtl
10281	   && MEM_P (rtl)
10282	   && GET_MODE (rtl) != TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl))
10283	   && BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
10284    {
10285      int rsize = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl));
10286      int dsize = GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)));
10287
10288      /* If a variable is declared "register" yet is smaller than
10289	 a register, then if we store the variable to memory, it
10290	 looks like we're storing a register-sized value, when in
10291	 fact we are not.  We need to adjust the offset of the
10292	 storage location to reflect the actual value's bytes,
10293	 else gdb will not be able to display it.  */
10294      if (rsize > dsize)
10295	rtl = gen_rtx_MEM (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
10296			   plus_constant (XEXP (rtl, 0), rsize-dsize));
10297    }
10298
10299  /* A variable with no DECL_RTL but a DECL_INITIAL is a compile-time constant,
10300     and will have been substituted directly into all expressions that use it.
10301     C does not have such a concept, but C++ and other languages do.  */
10302  if (!rtl && TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL && DECL_INITIAL (decl))
10303    rtl = rtl_for_decl_init (DECL_INITIAL (decl), TREE_TYPE (decl));
10304
10305  if (rtl)
10306    rtl = targetm.delegitimize_address (rtl);
10307
10308  /* If we don't look past the constant pool, we risk emitting a
10309     reference to a constant pool entry that isn't referenced from
10310     code, and thus is not emitted.  */
10311  if (rtl)
10312    rtl = avoid_constant_pool_reference (rtl);
10313
10314  return rtl;
10315}
10316
10317/* We need to figure out what section we should use as the base for the
10318   address ranges where a given location is valid.
10319   1. If this particular DECL has a section associated with it, use that.
10320   2. If this function has a section associated with it, use that.
10321   3. Otherwise, use the text section.
10322   XXX: If you split a variable across multiple sections, we won't notice.  */
10323
10324static const char *
10325secname_for_decl (tree decl)
10326{
10327  const char *secname;
10328
10329  if (VAR_OR_FUNCTION_DECL_P (decl) && DECL_SECTION_NAME (decl))
10330    {
10331      tree sectree = DECL_SECTION_NAME (decl);
10332      secname = TREE_STRING_POINTER (sectree);
10333    }
10334  else if (current_function_decl && DECL_SECTION_NAME (current_function_decl))
10335    {
10336      tree sectree = DECL_SECTION_NAME (current_function_decl);
10337      secname = TREE_STRING_POINTER (sectree);
10338    }
10339  else if (cfun && in_cold_section_p)
10340    secname = cfun->cold_section_label;
10341  else
10342    secname = text_section_label;
10343
10344  return secname;
10345}
10346
10347/* Generate *either* a DW_AT_location attribute or else a DW_AT_const_value
10348   data attribute for a variable or a parameter.  We generate the
10349   DW_AT_const_value attribute only in those cases where the given variable
10350   or parameter does not have a true "location" either in memory or in a
10351   register.  This can happen (for example) when a constant is passed as an
10352   actual argument in a call to an inline function.  (It's possible that
10353   these things can crop up in other ways also.)  Note that one type of
10354   constant value which can be passed into an inlined function is a constant
10355   pointer.  This can happen for example if an actual argument in an inlined
10356   function call evaluates to a compile-time constant address.  */
10357
10358static void
10359add_location_or_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl,
10360				       enum dwarf_attribute attr)
10361{
10362  rtx rtl;
10363  dw_loc_descr_ref descr;
10364  var_loc_list *loc_list;
10365  struct var_loc_node *node;
10366  if (TREE_CODE (decl) == ERROR_MARK)
10367    return;
10368
10369  gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL || TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL
10370	      || TREE_CODE (decl) == RESULT_DECL);
10371
10372  /* See if we possibly have multiple locations for this variable.  */
10373  loc_list = lookup_decl_loc (decl);
10374
10375  /* If it truly has multiple locations, the first and last node will
10376     differ.  */
10377  if (loc_list && loc_list->first != loc_list->last)
10378    {
10379      const char *endname, *secname;
10380      dw_loc_list_ref list;
10381      rtx varloc;
10382
10383      /* Now that we know what section we are using for a base,
10384         actually construct the list of locations.
10385	 The first location information is what is passed to the
10386	 function that creates the location list, and the remaining
10387	 locations just get added on to that list.
10388	 Note that we only know the start address for a location
10389	 (IE location changes), so to build the range, we use
10390	 the range [current location start, next location start].
10391	 This means we have to special case the last node, and generate
10392	 a range of [last location start, end of function label].  */
10393
10394      node = loc_list->first;
10395      varloc = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (node->var_loc_note);
10396      secname = secname_for_decl (decl);
10397
10398      list = new_loc_list (loc_descriptor (varloc),
10399			   node->label, node->next->label, secname, 1);
10400      node = node->next;
10401
10402      for (; node->next; node = node->next)
10403	if (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (node->var_loc_note) != NULL_RTX)
10404	  {
10405	    /* The variable has a location between NODE->LABEL and
10406	       NODE->NEXT->LABEL.  */
10407	    varloc = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (node->var_loc_note);
10408	    add_loc_descr_to_loc_list (&list, loc_descriptor (varloc),
10409				       node->label, node->next->label, secname);
10410	  }
10411
10412      /* If the variable has a location at the last label
10413	 it keeps its location until the end of function.  */
10414      if (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (node->var_loc_note) != NULL_RTX)
10415	{
10416	  char label_id[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
10417
10418	  varloc = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (node->var_loc_note);
10419	  if (!current_function_decl)
10420	    endname = text_end_label;
10421	  else
10422	    {
10423	      ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label_id, FUNC_END_LABEL,
10424					   current_function_funcdef_no);
10425	      endname = ggc_strdup (label_id);
10426	    }
10427	  add_loc_descr_to_loc_list (&list, loc_descriptor (varloc),
10428				     node->label, endname, secname);
10429	}
10430
10431      /* Finally, add the location list to the DIE, and we are done.  */
10432      add_AT_loc_list (die, attr, list);
10433      return;
10434    }
10435
10436  /* Try to get some constant RTL for this decl, and use that as the value of
10437     the location.  */
10438
10439  rtl = rtl_for_decl_location (decl);
10440  if (rtl && (CONSTANT_P (rtl) || GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_STRING))
10441    {
10442      add_const_value_attribute (die, rtl);
10443      return;
10444    }
10445
10446  /* If we have tried to generate the location otherwise, and it
10447     didn't work out (we wouldn't be here if we did), and we have a one entry
10448     location list, try generating a location from that.  */
10449  if (loc_list && loc_list->first)
10450    {
10451      node = loc_list->first;
10452      descr = loc_descriptor (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (node->var_loc_note));
10453      if (descr)
10454	{
10455	  add_AT_location_description (die, attr, descr);
10456	  return;
10457	}
10458    }
10459
10460  /* We couldn't get any rtl, so try directly generating the location
10461     description from the tree.  */
10462  descr = loc_descriptor_from_tree (decl);
10463  if (descr)
10464    {
10465      add_AT_location_description (die, attr, descr);
10466      return;
10467    }
10468  /* None of that worked, so it must not really have a location;
10469     try adding a constant value attribute from the DECL_INITIAL.  */
10470  tree_add_const_value_attribute (die, decl);
10471}
10472
10473/* If we don't have a copy of this variable in memory for some reason (such
10474   as a C++ member constant that doesn't have an out-of-line definition),
10475   we should tell the debugger about the constant value.  */
10476
10477static void
10478tree_add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref var_die, tree decl)
10479{
10480  tree init = DECL_INITIAL (decl);
10481  tree type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
10482  rtx rtl;
10483
10484  if (TREE_READONLY (decl) && ! TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl) && init)
10485    /* OK */;
10486  else
10487    return;
10488
10489  rtl = rtl_for_decl_init (init, type);
10490  if (rtl)
10491    add_const_value_attribute (var_die, rtl);
10492}
10493
10494/* Convert the CFI instructions for the current function into a
10495   location list.  This is used for DW_AT_frame_base when we targeting
10496   a dwarf2 consumer that does not support the dwarf3
10497   DW_OP_call_frame_cfa.  OFFSET is a constant to be added to all CFA
10498   expressions.  */
10499
10500static dw_loc_list_ref
10501convert_cfa_to_fb_loc_list (HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
10502{
10503  dw_fde_ref fde;
10504  dw_loc_list_ref list, *list_tail;
10505  dw_cfi_ref cfi;
10506  dw_cfa_location last_cfa, next_cfa;
10507  const char *start_label, *last_label, *section;
10508
10509  fde = &fde_table[fde_table_in_use - 1];
10510
10511  section = secname_for_decl (current_function_decl);
10512  list_tail = &list;
10513  list = NULL;
10514
10515  next_cfa.reg = INVALID_REGNUM;
10516  next_cfa.offset = 0;
10517  next_cfa.indirect = 0;
10518  next_cfa.base_offset = 0;
10519
10520  start_label = fde->dw_fde_begin;
10521
10522  /* ??? Bald assumption that the CIE opcode list does not contain
10523     advance opcodes.  */
10524  for (cfi = cie_cfi_head; cfi; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
10525    lookup_cfa_1 (cfi, &next_cfa);
10526
10527  last_cfa = next_cfa;
10528  last_label = start_label;
10529
10530  for (cfi = fde->dw_fde_cfi; cfi; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
10531    switch (cfi->dw_cfi_opc)
10532      {
10533      case DW_CFA_set_loc:
10534      case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
10535      case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
10536      case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
10537	if (!cfa_equal_p (&last_cfa, &next_cfa))
10538	  {
10539	    *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&last_cfa, offset),
10540				       start_label, last_label, section,
10541				       list == NULL);
10542
10543	    list_tail = &(*list_tail)->dw_loc_next;
10544	    last_cfa = next_cfa;
10545	    start_label = last_label;
10546	  }
10547	last_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
10548	break;
10549
10550      case DW_CFA_advance_loc:
10551	/* The encoding is complex enough that we should never emit this.  */
10552      case DW_CFA_remember_state:
10553      case DW_CFA_restore_state:
10554	/* We don't handle these two in this function.  It would be possible
10555	   if it were to be required.  */
10556	gcc_unreachable ();
10557
10558      default:
10559	lookup_cfa_1 (cfi, &next_cfa);
10560	break;
10561      }
10562
10563  if (!cfa_equal_p (&last_cfa, &next_cfa))
10564    {
10565      *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&last_cfa, offset),
10566				 start_label, last_label, section,
10567				 list == NULL);
10568      list_tail = &(*list_tail)->dw_loc_next;
10569      start_label = last_label;
10570    }
10571  *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&next_cfa, offset),
10572			     start_label, fde->dw_fde_end, section,
10573			     list == NULL);
10574
10575  return list;
10576}
10577
10578/* Compute a displacement from the "steady-state frame pointer" to the
10579   frame base (often the same as the CFA), and store it in
10580   frame_pointer_fb_offset.  OFFSET is added to the displacement
10581   before the latter is negated.  */
10582
10583static void
10584compute_frame_pointer_to_fb_displacement (HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
10585{
10586  rtx reg, elim;
10587
10588#ifdef FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET
10589  reg = frame_pointer_rtx;
10590  offset += FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (current_function_decl);
10591#else
10592  reg = arg_pointer_rtx;
10593  offset += ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (current_function_decl);
10594#endif
10595
10596  elim = eliminate_regs (reg, VOIDmode, NULL_RTX);
10597  if (GET_CODE (elim) == PLUS)
10598    {
10599      offset += INTVAL (XEXP (elim, 1));
10600      elim = XEXP (elim, 0);
10601    }
10602  gcc_assert (elim == (frame_pointer_needed ? hard_frame_pointer_rtx
10603		       : stack_pointer_rtx));
10604
10605  frame_pointer_fb_offset = -offset;
10606}
10607
10608/* Generate a DW_AT_name attribute given some string value to be included as
10609   the value of the attribute.  */
10610
10611static void
10612add_name_attribute (dw_die_ref die, const char *name_string)
10613{
10614  if (name_string != NULL && *name_string != 0)
10615    {
10616      if (demangle_name_func)
10617	name_string = (*demangle_name_func) (name_string);
10618
10619      add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_name, name_string);
10620    }
10621}
10622
10623/* Generate a DW_AT_comp_dir attribute for DIE.  */
10624
10625static void
10626add_comp_dir_attribute (dw_die_ref die)
10627{
10628  const char *wd = get_src_pwd ();
10629  if (wd != NULL)
10630    add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_comp_dir, wd);
10631}
10632
10633/* Given a tree node describing an array bound (either lower or upper) output
10634   a representation for that bound.  */
10635
10636static void
10637add_bound_info (dw_die_ref subrange_die, enum dwarf_attribute bound_attr, tree bound)
10638{
10639  switch (TREE_CODE (bound))
10640    {
10641    case ERROR_MARK:
10642      return;
10643
10644    /* All fixed-bounds are represented by INTEGER_CST nodes.  */
10645    case INTEGER_CST:
10646      if (! host_integerp (bound, 0)
10647	  || (bound_attr == DW_AT_lower_bound
10648	      && (((is_c_family () || is_java ()) &&  integer_zerop (bound))
10649		  || (is_fortran () && integer_onep (bound)))))
10650	/* Use the default.  */
10651	;
10652      else
10653	add_AT_unsigned (subrange_die, bound_attr, tree_low_cst (bound, 0));
10654      break;
10655
10656    case CONVERT_EXPR:
10657    case NOP_EXPR:
10658    case NON_LVALUE_EXPR:
10659    case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
10660      add_bound_info (subrange_die, bound_attr, TREE_OPERAND (bound, 0));
10661      break;
10662
10663    case SAVE_EXPR:
10664      break;
10665
10666    case VAR_DECL:
10667    case PARM_DECL:
10668    case RESULT_DECL:
10669      {
10670	dw_die_ref decl_die = lookup_decl_die (bound);
10671
10672	/* ??? Can this happen, or should the variable have been bound
10673	   first?  Probably it can, since I imagine that we try to create
10674	   the types of parameters in the order in which they exist in
10675	   the list, and won't have created a forward reference to a
10676	   later parameter.  */
10677	if (decl_die != NULL)
10678	  add_AT_die_ref (subrange_die, bound_attr, decl_die);
10679	break;
10680      }
10681
10682    default:
10683      {
10684	/* Otherwise try to create a stack operation procedure to
10685	   evaluate the value of the array bound.  */
10686
10687	dw_die_ref ctx, decl_die;
10688	dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
10689
10690	loc = loc_descriptor_from_tree (bound);
10691	if (loc == NULL)
10692	  break;
10693
10694	if (current_function_decl == 0)
10695	  ctx = comp_unit_die;
10696	else
10697	  ctx = lookup_decl_die (current_function_decl);
10698
10699	decl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_variable, ctx, bound);
10700	add_AT_flag (decl_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
10701	add_type_attribute (decl_die, TREE_TYPE (bound), 1, 0, ctx);
10702	add_AT_loc (decl_die, DW_AT_location, loc);
10703
10704	add_AT_die_ref (subrange_die, bound_attr, decl_die);
10705	break;
10706      }
10707    }
10708}
10709
10710/* Note that the block of subscript information for an array type also
10711   includes information about the element type of type given array type.  */
10712
10713static void
10714add_subscript_info (dw_die_ref type_die, tree type)
10715{
10716#ifndef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
10717  unsigned dimension_number;
10718#endif
10719  tree lower, upper;
10720  dw_die_ref subrange_die;
10721
10722  /* The GNU compilers represent multidimensional array types as sequences of
10723     one dimensional array types whose element types are themselves array
10724     types.  Here we squish that down, so that each multidimensional array
10725     type gets only one array_type DIE in the Dwarf debugging info. The draft
10726     Dwarf specification say that we are allowed to do this kind of
10727     compression in C (because there is no difference between an array or
10728     arrays and a multidimensional array in C) but for other source languages
10729     (e.g. Ada) we probably shouldn't do this.  */
10730
10731  /* ??? The SGI dwarf reader fails for multidimensional arrays with a
10732     const enum type.  E.g. const enum machine_mode insn_operand_mode[2][10].
10733     We work around this by disabling this feature.  See also
10734     gen_array_type_die.  */
10735#ifndef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
10736  for (dimension_number = 0;
10737       TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE;
10738       type = TREE_TYPE (type), dimension_number++)
10739#endif
10740    {
10741      tree domain = TYPE_DOMAIN (type);
10742
10743      /* Arrays come in three flavors: Unspecified bounds, fixed bounds,
10744	 and (in GNU C only) variable bounds.  Handle all three forms
10745	 here.  */
10746      subrange_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subrange_type, type_die, NULL);
10747      if (domain)
10748	{
10749	  /* We have an array type with specified bounds.  */
10750	  lower = TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain);
10751	  upper = TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain);
10752
10753	  /* Define the index type.  */
10754	  if (TREE_TYPE (domain))
10755	    {
10756	      /* ??? This is probably an Ada unnamed subrange type.  Ignore the
10757		 TREE_TYPE field.  We can't emit debug info for this
10758		 because it is an unnamed integral type.  */
10759	      if (TREE_CODE (domain) == INTEGER_TYPE
10760		  && TYPE_NAME (domain) == NULL_TREE
10761		  && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (domain)) == INTEGER_TYPE
10762		  && TYPE_NAME (TREE_TYPE (domain)) == NULL_TREE)
10763		;
10764	      else
10765		add_type_attribute (subrange_die, TREE_TYPE (domain), 0, 0,
10766				    type_die);
10767	    }
10768
10769	  /* ??? If upper is NULL, the array has unspecified length,
10770	     but it does have a lower bound.  This happens with Fortran
10771	       dimension arr(N:*)
10772	     Since the debugger is definitely going to need to know N
10773	     to produce useful results, go ahead and output the lower
10774	     bound solo, and hope the debugger can cope.  */
10775
10776	  add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_lower_bound, lower);
10777	  if (upper)
10778	    add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_upper_bound, upper);
10779	}
10780
10781      /* Otherwise we have an array type with an unspecified length.  The
10782	 DWARF-2 spec does not say how to handle this; let's just leave out the
10783	 bounds.  */
10784    }
10785}
10786
10787static void
10788add_byte_size_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree tree_node)
10789{
10790  unsigned size;
10791
10792  switch (TREE_CODE (tree_node))
10793    {
10794    case ERROR_MARK:
10795      size = 0;
10796      break;
10797    case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
10798    case RECORD_TYPE:
10799    case UNION_TYPE:
10800    case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
10801      size = int_size_in_bytes (tree_node);
10802      break;
10803    case FIELD_DECL:
10804      /* For a data member of a struct or union, the DW_AT_byte_size is
10805	 generally given as the number of bytes normally allocated for an
10806	 object of the *declared* type of the member itself.  This is true
10807	 even for bit-fields.  */
10808      size = simple_type_size_in_bits (field_type (tree_node)) / BITS_PER_UNIT;
10809      break;
10810    default:
10811      gcc_unreachable ();
10812    }
10813
10814  /* Note that `size' might be -1 when we get to this point.  If it is, that
10815     indicates that the byte size of the entity in question is variable.  We
10816     have no good way of expressing this fact in Dwarf at the present time.
10817     GCC/35998: Avoid passing negative sizes to Dtrace and gdb.  */
10818  add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_byte_size, (size != (unsigned)-1 ? size : 0));
10819}
10820
10821/* For a FIELD_DECL node which represents a bit-field, output an attribute
10822   which specifies the distance in bits from the highest order bit of the
10823   "containing object" for the bit-field to the highest order bit of the
10824   bit-field itself.
10825
10826   For any given bit-field, the "containing object" is a hypothetical object
10827   (of some integral or enum type) within which the given bit-field lives.  The
10828   type of this hypothetical "containing object" is always the same as the
10829   declared type of the individual bit-field itself.  The determination of the
10830   exact location of the "containing object" for a bit-field is rather
10831   complicated.  It's handled by the `field_byte_offset' function (above).
10832
10833   Note that it is the size (in bytes) of the hypothetical "containing object"
10834   which will be given in the DW_AT_byte_size attribute for this bit-field.
10835   (See `byte_size_attribute' above).  */
10836
10837static inline void
10838add_bit_offset_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
10839{
10840  HOST_WIDE_INT object_offset_in_bytes = field_byte_offset (decl);
10841  tree type = DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl);
10842  HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos_int;
10843  HOST_WIDE_INT highest_order_object_bit_offset;
10844  HOST_WIDE_INT highest_order_field_bit_offset;
10845  HOST_WIDE_INT unsigned bit_offset;
10846
10847  /* Must be a field and a bit field.  */
10848  gcc_assert (type && TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL);
10849
10850  /* We can't yet handle bit-fields whose offsets are variable, so if we
10851     encounter such things, just return without generating any attribute
10852     whatsoever.  Likewise for variable or too large size.  */
10853  if (! host_integerp (bit_position (decl), 0)
10854      || ! host_integerp (DECL_SIZE (decl), 1))
10855    return;
10856
10857  bitpos_int = int_bit_position (decl);
10858
10859  /* Note that the bit offset is always the distance (in bits) from the
10860     highest-order bit of the "containing object" to the highest-order bit of
10861     the bit-field itself.  Since the "high-order end" of any object or field
10862     is different on big-endian and little-endian machines, the computation
10863     below must take account of these differences.  */
10864  highest_order_object_bit_offset = object_offset_in_bytes * BITS_PER_UNIT;
10865  highest_order_field_bit_offset = bitpos_int;
10866
10867  if (! BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
10868    {
10869      highest_order_field_bit_offset += tree_low_cst (DECL_SIZE (decl), 0);
10870      highest_order_object_bit_offset += simple_type_size_in_bits (type);
10871    }
10872
10873  bit_offset
10874    = (! BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
10875       ? highest_order_object_bit_offset - highest_order_field_bit_offset
10876       : highest_order_field_bit_offset - highest_order_object_bit_offset);
10877
10878  add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_bit_offset, bit_offset);
10879}
10880
10881/* For a FIELD_DECL node which represents a bit field, output an attribute
10882   which specifies the length in bits of the given field.  */
10883
10884static inline void
10885add_bit_size_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
10886{
10887  /* Must be a field and a bit field.  */
10888  gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL
10889	      && DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl));
10890
10891  if (host_integerp (DECL_SIZE (decl), 1))
10892    add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_bit_size, tree_low_cst (DECL_SIZE (decl), 1));
10893}
10894
10895/* If the compiled language is ANSI C, then add a 'prototyped'
10896   attribute, if arg types are given for the parameters of a function.  */
10897
10898static inline void
10899add_prototyped_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree func_type)
10900{
10901  if (get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language) == DW_LANG_C89
10902      && TYPE_ARG_TYPES (func_type) != NULL)
10903    add_AT_flag (die, DW_AT_prototyped, 1);
10904}
10905
10906/* Add an 'abstract_origin' attribute below a given DIE.  The DIE is found
10907   by looking in either the type declaration or object declaration
10908   equate table.  */
10909
10910static inline void
10911add_abstract_origin_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree origin)
10912{
10913  dw_die_ref origin_die = NULL;
10914
10915  if (TREE_CODE (origin) != FUNCTION_DECL)
10916    {
10917      /* We may have gotten separated from the block for the inlined
10918	 function, if we're in an exception handler or some such; make
10919	 sure that the abstract function has been written out.
10920
10921	 Doing this for nested functions is wrong, however; functions are
10922	 distinct units, and our context might not even be inline.  */
10923      tree fn = origin;
10924
10925      if (TYPE_P (fn))
10926	fn = TYPE_STUB_DECL (fn);
10927
10928      fn = decl_function_context (fn);
10929      if (fn)
10930	dwarf2out_abstract_function (fn);
10931    }
10932
10933  if (DECL_P (origin))
10934    origin_die = lookup_decl_die (origin);
10935  else if (TYPE_P (origin))
10936    origin_die = lookup_type_die (origin);
10937
10938  /* XXX: Functions that are never lowered don't always have correct block
10939     trees (in the case of java, they simply have no block tree, in some other
10940     languages).  For these functions, there is nothing we can really do to
10941     output correct debug info for inlined functions in all cases.  Rather
10942     than die, we'll just produce deficient debug info now, in that we will
10943     have variables without a proper abstract origin.  In the future, when all
10944     functions are lowered, we should re-add a gcc_assert (origin_die)
10945     here.  */
10946
10947  if (origin_die)
10948      add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin, origin_die);
10949}
10950
10951/* We do not currently support the pure_virtual attribute.  */
10952
10953static inline void
10954add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree func_decl)
10955{
10956  if (DECL_VINDEX (func_decl))
10957    {
10958      add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_virtuality, DW_VIRTUALITY_virtual);
10959
10960      if (host_integerp (DECL_VINDEX (func_decl), 0))
10961	add_AT_loc (die, DW_AT_vtable_elem_location,
10962		    new_loc_descr (DW_OP_constu,
10963				   tree_low_cst (DECL_VINDEX (func_decl), 0),
10964				   0));
10965
10966      /* GNU extension: Record what type this method came from originally.  */
10967      if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
10968	add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_containing_type,
10969			lookup_type_die (DECL_CONTEXT (func_decl)));
10970    }
10971}
10972
10973/* Add source coordinate attributes for the given decl.  */
10974
10975static void
10976add_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
10977{
10978  expanded_location s = expand_location (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl));
10979
10980  add_AT_file (die, DW_AT_decl_file, lookup_filename (s.file));
10981  add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_decl_line, s.line);
10982}
10983
10984/* Add a DW_AT_name attribute and source coordinate attribute for the
10985   given decl, but only if it actually has a name.  */
10986
10987static void
10988add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
10989{
10990  tree decl_name;
10991
10992  decl_name = DECL_NAME (decl);
10993  if (decl_name != NULL && IDENTIFIER_POINTER (decl_name) != NULL)
10994    {
10995      add_name_attribute (die, dwarf2_name (decl, 0));
10996      if (! DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
10997	add_src_coords_attributes (die, decl);
10998
10999      if ((TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL || TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL)
11000	  && TREE_PUBLIC (decl)
11001	  && DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl) != DECL_NAME (decl)
11002	  && !DECL_ABSTRACT (decl)
11003	  && !(TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL && DECL_REGISTER (decl)))
11004	add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name,
11005		       IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl)));
11006    }
11007
11008#ifdef VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
11009  /* Get the function's name, as described by its RTL.  This may be different
11010     from the DECL_NAME name used in the source file.  */
11011  if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL && TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl))
11012    {
11013      add_AT_addr (die, DW_AT_VMS_rtnbeg_pd_address,
11014		   XEXP (DECL_RTL (decl), 0));
11015      VEC_safe_push (tree, gc, used_rtx_array, XEXP (DECL_RTL (decl), 0));
11016    }
11017#endif
11018}
11019
11020/* Push a new declaration scope.  */
11021
11022static void
11023push_decl_scope (tree scope)
11024{
11025  VEC_safe_push (tree, gc, decl_scope_table, scope);
11026}
11027
11028/* Pop a declaration scope.  */
11029
11030static inline void
11031pop_decl_scope (void)
11032{
11033  VEC_pop (tree, decl_scope_table);
11034}
11035
11036/* Return the DIE for the scope that immediately contains this type.
11037   Non-named types get global scope.  Named types nested in other
11038   types get their containing scope if it's open, or global scope
11039   otherwise.  All other types (i.e. function-local named types) get
11040   the current active scope.  */
11041
11042static dw_die_ref
11043scope_die_for (tree t, dw_die_ref context_die)
11044{
11045  dw_die_ref scope_die = NULL;
11046  tree containing_scope;
11047  int i;
11048
11049  /* Non-types always go in the current scope.  */
11050  gcc_assert (TYPE_P (t));
11051
11052  containing_scope = TYPE_CONTEXT (t);
11053
11054  /* Use the containing namespace if it was passed in (for a declaration).  */
11055  if (containing_scope && TREE_CODE (containing_scope) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
11056    {
11057      if (context_die == lookup_decl_die (containing_scope))
11058	/* OK */;
11059      else
11060	containing_scope = NULL_TREE;
11061    }
11062
11063  /* Ignore function type "scopes" from the C frontend.  They mean that
11064     a tagged type is local to a parmlist of a function declarator, but
11065     that isn't useful to DWARF.  */
11066  if (containing_scope && TREE_CODE (containing_scope) == FUNCTION_TYPE)
11067    containing_scope = NULL_TREE;
11068
11069  if (containing_scope == NULL_TREE)
11070    scope_die = comp_unit_die;
11071  else if (TYPE_P (containing_scope))
11072    {
11073      /* For types, we can just look up the appropriate DIE.  But
11074	 first we check to see if we're in the middle of emitting it
11075	 so we know where the new DIE should go.  */
11076      for (i = VEC_length (tree, decl_scope_table) - 1; i >= 0; --i)
11077	if (VEC_index (tree, decl_scope_table, i) == containing_scope)
11078	  break;
11079
11080      if (i < 0)
11081	{
11082	  gcc_assert (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE
11083		      || TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (containing_scope));
11084
11085	  /* If none of the current dies are suitable, we get file scope.  */
11086	  scope_die = comp_unit_die;
11087	}
11088      else
11089	scope_die = lookup_type_die (containing_scope);
11090    }
11091  else
11092    scope_die = context_die;
11093
11094  return scope_die;
11095}
11096
11097/* Returns nonzero if CONTEXT_DIE is internal to a function.  */
11098
11099static inline int
11100local_scope_p (dw_die_ref context_die)
11101{
11102  for (; context_die; context_die = context_die->die_parent)
11103    if (context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine
11104	|| context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram)
11105      return 1;
11106
11107  return 0;
11108}
11109
11110/* Returns nonzero if CONTEXT_DIE is a class or namespace, for deciding
11111   whether or not to treat a DIE in this context as a declaration.  */
11112
11113static inline int
11114class_or_namespace_scope_p (dw_die_ref context_die)
11115{
11116  return (context_die
11117	  && (context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_structure_type
11118	      || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_union_type
11119	      || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_namespace));
11120}
11121
11122/* Many forms of DIEs require a "type description" attribute.  This
11123   routine locates the proper "type descriptor" die for the type given
11124   by 'type', and adds a DW_AT_type attribute below the given die.  */
11125
11126static void
11127add_type_attribute (dw_die_ref object_die, tree type, int decl_const,
11128		    int decl_volatile, dw_die_ref context_die)
11129{
11130  enum tree_code code  = TREE_CODE (type);
11131  dw_die_ref type_die  = NULL;
11132
11133  /* ??? If this type is an unnamed subrange type of an integral or
11134     floating-point type, use the inner type.  This is because we have no
11135     support for unnamed types in base_type_die.  This can happen if this is
11136     an Ada subrange type.  Correct solution is emit a subrange type die.  */
11137  if ((code == INTEGER_TYPE || code == REAL_TYPE)
11138      && TREE_TYPE (type) != 0 && TYPE_NAME (type) == 0)
11139    type = TREE_TYPE (type), code = TREE_CODE (type);
11140
11141  if (code == ERROR_MARK
11142      /* Handle a special case.  For functions whose return type is void, we
11143	 generate *no* type attribute.  (Note that no object may have type
11144	 `void', so this only applies to function return types).  */
11145      || code == VOID_TYPE)
11146    return;
11147
11148  type_die = modified_type_die (type,
11149				decl_const || TYPE_READONLY (type),
11150				decl_volatile || TYPE_VOLATILE (type),
11151				context_die);
11152
11153  if (type_die != NULL)
11154    add_AT_die_ref (object_die, DW_AT_type, type_die);
11155}
11156
11157/* Given an object die, add the calling convention attribute for the
11158   function call type.  */
11159static void
11160add_calling_convention_attribute (dw_die_ref subr_die, tree type)
11161{
11162  enum dwarf_calling_convention value = DW_CC_normal;
11163
11164  value = targetm.dwarf_calling_convention (type);
11165
11166  /* Only add the attribute if the backend requests it, and
11167     is not DW_CC_normal.  */
11168  if (value && (value != DW_CC_normal))
11169    add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_calling_convention, value);
11170}
11171
11172/* Given a tree pointer to a struct, class, union, or enum type node, return
11173   a pointer to the (string) tag name for the given type, or zero if the type
11174   was declared without a tag.  */
11175
11176static const char *
11177type_tag (tree type)
11178{
11179  const char *name = 0;
11180
11181  if (TYPE_NAME (type) != 0)
11182    {
11183      tree t = 0;
11184
11185      /* Find the IDENTIFIER_NODE for the type name.  */
11186      if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == IDENTIFIER_NODE)
11187	t = TYPE_NAME (type);
11188
11189      /* The g++ front end makes the TYPE_NAME of *each* tagged type point to
11190	 a TYPE_DECL node, regardless of whether or not a `typedef' was
11191	 involved.  */
11192      else if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == TYPE_DECL
11193	       && ! DECL_IGNORED_P (TYPE_NAME (type)))
11194	t = DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (type));
11195
11196      /* Now get the name as a string, or invent one.  */
11197      if (t != 0)
11198	name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (t);
11199    }
11200
11201  return (name == 0 || *name == '\0') ? 0 : name;
11202}
11203
11204/* Return the type associated with a data member, make a special check
11205   for bit field types.  */
11206
11207static inline tree
11208member_declared_type (tree member)
11209{
11210  return (DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (member)
11211	  ? DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (member) : TREE_TYPE (member));
11212}
11213
11214/* Get the decl's label, as described by its RTL. This may be different
11215   from the DECL_NAME name used in the source file.  */
11216
11217#if 0
11218static const char *
11219decl_start_label (tree decl)
11220{
11221  rtx x;
11222  const char *fnname;
11223
11224  x = DECL_RTL (decl);
11225  gcc_assert (MEM_P (x));
11226
11227  x = XEXP (x, 0);
11228  gcc_assert (GET_CODE (x) == SYMBOL_REF);
11229
11230  fnname = XSTR (x, 0);
11231  return fnname;
11232}
11233#endif
11234
11235/* These routines generate the internal representation of the DIE's for
11236   the compilation unit.  Debugging information is collected by walking
11237   the declaration trees passed in from dwarf2out_decl().  */
11238
11239static void
11240gen_array_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
11241{
11242  dw_die_ref scope_die = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
11243  dw_die_ref array_die;
11244  tree element_type;
11245
11246  /* ??? The SGI dwarf reader fails for array of array of enum types unless
11247     the inner array type comes before the outer array type.  Thus we must
11248     call gen_type_die before we call new_die.  See below also.  */
11249#ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
11250  gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die);
11251#endif
11252
11253  array_die = new_die (DW_TAG_array_type, scope_die, type);
11254  add_name_attribute (array_die, type_tag (type));
11255  equate_type_number_to_die (type, array_die);
11256
11257  if (TREE_CODE (type) == VECTOR_TYPE)
11258    {
11259      /* The frontend feeds us a representation for the vector as a struct
11260	 containing an array.  Pull out the array type.  */
11261      type = TREE_TYPE (TYPE_FIELDS (TYPE_DEBUG_REPRESENTATION_TYPE (type)));
11262      add_AT_flag (array_die, DW_AT_GNU_vector, 1);
11263    }
11264
11265#if 0
11266  /* We default the array ordering.  SDB will probably do
11267     the right things even if DW_AT_ordering is not present.  It's not even
11268     an issue until we start to get into multidimensional arrays anyway.  If
11269     SDB is ever caught doing the Wrong Thing for multi-dimensional arrays,
11270     then we'll have to put the DW_AT_ordering attribute back in.  (But if
11271     and when we find out that we need to put these in, we will only do so
11272     for multidimensional arrays.  */
11273  add_AT_unsigned (array_die, DW_AT_ordering, DW_ORD_row_major);
11274#endif
11275
11276#ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
11277  /* The SGI compilers handle arrays of unknown bound by setting
11278     AT_declaration and not emitting any subrange DIEs.  */
11279  if (! TYPE_DOMAIN (type))
11280    add_AT_flag (array_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
11281  else
11282#endif
11283    add_subscript_info (array_die, type);
11284
11285  /* Add representation of the type of the elements of this array type.  */
11286  element_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
11287
11288  /* ??? The SGI dwarf reader fails for multidimensional arrays with a
11289     const enum type.  E.g. const enum machine_mode insn_operand_mode[2][10].
11290     We work around this by disabling this feature.  See also
11291     add_subscript_info.  */
11292#ifndef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
11293  while (TREE_CODE (element_type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
11294    element_type = TREE_TYPE (element_type);
11295
11296  gen_type_die (element_type, context_die);
11297#endif
11298
11299  add_type_attribute (array_die, element_type, 0, 0, context_die);
11300}
11301
11302#if 0
11303static void
11304gen_entry_point_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
11305{
11306  tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
11307  dw_die_ref decl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_entry_point, context_die, decl);
11308
11309  if (origin != NULL)
11310    add_abstract_origin_attribute (decl_die, origin);
11311  else
11312    {
11313      add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (decl_die, decl);
11314      add_type_attribute (decl_die, TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
11315			  0, 0, context_die);
11316    }
11317
11318  if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
11319    equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, decl_die);
11320  else
11321    add_AT_lbl_id (decl_die, DW_AT_low_pc, decl_start_label (decl));
11322}
11323#endif
11324
11325/* Walk through the list of incomplete types again, trying once more to
11326   emit full debugging info for them.  */
11327
11328static void
11329retry_incomplete_types (void)
11330{
11331  int i;
11332
11333  for (i = VEC_length (tree, incomplete_types) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
11334    gen_type_die (VEC_index (tree, incomplete_types, i), comp_unit_die);
11335}
11336
11337/* Generate a DIE to represent an inlined instance of an enumeration type.  */
11338
11339static void
11340gen_inlined_enumeration_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
11341{
11342  dw_die_ref type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_enumeration_type, context_die, type);
11343
11344  /* We do not check for TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) being set, as the type may
11345     be incomplete and such types are not marked.  */
11346  add_abstract_origin_attribute (type_die, type);
11347}
11348
11349/* Generate a DIE to represent an inlined instance of a structure type.  */
11350
11351static void
11352gen_inlined_structure_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
11353{
11354  dw_die_ref type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_structure_type, context_die, type);
11355
11356  /* We do not check for TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) being set, as the type may
11357     be incomplete and such types are not marked.  */
11358  add_abstract_origin_attribute (type_die, type);
11359}
11360
11361/* Generate a DIE to represent an inlined instance of a union type.  */
11362
11363static void
11364gen_inlined_union_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
11365{
11366  dw_die_ref type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_union_type, context_die, type);
11367
11368  /* We do not check for TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) being set, as the type may
11369     be incomplete and such types are not marked.  */
11370  add_abstract_origin_attribute (type_die, type);
11371}
11372
11373/* Generate a DIE to represent an enumeration type.  Note that these DIEs
11374   include all of the information about the enumeration values also. Each
11375   enumerated type name/value is listed as a child of the enumerated type
11376   DIE.  */
11377
11378static dw_die_ref
11379gen_enumeration_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
11380{
11381  dw_die_ref type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
11382
11383  if (type_die == NULL)
11384    {
11385      type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_enumeration_type,
11386			  scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
11387      equate_type_number_to_die (type, type_die);
11388      add_name_attribute (type_die, type_tag (type));
11389    }
11390  else if (! TYPE_SIZE (type))
11391    return type_die;
11392  else
11393    remove_AT (type_die, DW_AT_declaration);
11394
11395  /* Handle a GNU C/C++ extension, i.e. incomplete enum types.  If the
11396     given enum type is incomplete, do not generate the DW_AT_byte_size
11397     attribute or the DW_AT_element_list attribute.  */
11398  if (TYPE_SIZE (type))
11399    {
11400      tree link;
11401
11402      TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
11403      add_byte_size_attribute (type_die, type);
11404      if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type) != NULL_TREE)
11405	add_src_coords_attributes (type_die, TYPE_STUB_DECL (type));
11406
11407      /* If the first reference to this type was as the return type of an
11408	 inline function, then it may not have a parent.  Fix this now.  */
11409      if (type_die->die_parent == NULL)
11410	add_child_die (scope_die_for (type, context_die), type_die);
11411
11412      for (link = TYPE_VALUES (type);
11413	   link != NULL; link = TREE_CHAIN (link))
11414	{
11415	  dw_die_ref enum_die = new_die (DW_TAG_enumerator, type_die, link);
11416	  tree value = TREE_VALUE (link);
11417
11418	  add_name_attribute (enum_die,
11419			      IDENTIFIER_POINTER (TREE_PURPOSE (link)));
11420
11421	  if (host_integerp (value, TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (value))))
11422	    /* DWARF2 does not provide a way of indicating whether or
11423	       not enumeration constants are signed or unsigned.  GDB
11424	       always assumes the values are signed, so we output all
11425	       values as if they were signed.  That means that
11426	       enumeration constants with very large unsigned values
11427	       will appear to have negative values in the debugger.  */
11428	    add_AT_int (enum_die, DW_AT_const_value,
11429			tree_low_cst (value, tree_int_cst_sgn (value) > 0));
11430	}
11431    }
11432  else
11433    add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
11434
11435  return type_die;
11436}
11437
11438/* Generate a DIE to represent either a real live formal parameter decl or to
11439   represent just the type of some formal parameter position in some function
11440   type.
11441
11442   Note that this routine is a bit unusual because its argument may be a
11443   ..._DECL node (i.e. either a PARM_DECL or perhaps a VAR_DECL which
11444   represents an inlining of some PARM_DECL) or else some sort of a ..._TYPE
11445   node.  If it's the former then this function is being called to output a
11446   DIE to represent a formal parameter object (or some inlining thereof).  If
11447   it's the latter, then this function is only being called to output a
11448   DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIE to stand as a placeholder for some formal
11449   argument type of some subprogram type.  */
11450
11451static dw_die_ref
11452gen_formal_parameter_die (tree node, dw_die_ref context_die)
11453{
11454  dw_die_ref parm_die
11455    = new_die (DW_TAG_formal_parameter, context_die, node);
11456  tree origin;
11457
11458  switch (TREE_CODE_CLASS (TREE_CODE (node)))
11459    {
11460    case tcc_declaration:
11461      origin = decl_ultimate_origin (node);
11462      if (origin != NULL)
11463	add_abstract_origin_attribute (parm_die, origin);
11464      else
11465	{
11466	  add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (parm_die, node);
11467	  add_type_attribute (parm_die, TREE_TYPE (node),
11468			      TREE_READONLY (node),
11469			      TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (node),
11470			      context_die);
11471	  if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (node))
11472	    add_AT_flag (parm_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
11473	}
11474
11475      equate_decl_number_to_die (node, parm_die);
11476      if (! DECL_ABSTRACT (node))
11477	add_location_or_const_value_attribute (parm_die, node, DW_AT_location);
11478
11479      break;
11480
11481    case tcc_type:
11482      /* We were called with some kind of a ..._TYPE node.  */
11483      add_type_attribute (parm_die, node, 0, 0, context_die);
11484      break;
11485
11486    default:
11487      gcc_unreachable ();
11488    }
11489
11490  return parm_die;
11491}
11492
11493/* Generate a special type of DIE used as a stand-in for a trailing ellipsis
11494   at the end of an (ANSI prototyped) formal parameters list.  */
11495
11496static void
11497gen_unspecified_parameters_die (tree decl_or_type, dw_die_ref context_die)
11498{
11499  new_die (DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters, context_die, decl_or_type);
11500}
11501
11502/* Generate a list of nameless DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIEs (and perhaps a
11503   DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters DIE) to represent the types of the formal
11504   parameters as specified in some function type specification (except for
11505   those which appear as part of a function *definition*).  */
11506
11507static void
11508gen_formal_types_die (tree function_or_method_type, dw_die_ref context_die)
11509{
11510  tree link;
11511  tree formal_type = NULL;
11512  tree first_parm_type;
11513  tree arg;
11514
11515  if (TREE_CODE (function_or_method_type) == FUNCTION_DECL)
11516    {
11517      arg = DECL_ARGUMENTS (function_or_method_type);
11518      function_or_method_type = TREE_TYPE (function_or_method_type);
11519    }
11520  else
11521    arg = NULL_TREE;
11522
11523  first_parm_type = TYPE_ARG_TYPES (function_or_method_type);
11524
11525  /* Make our first pass over the list of formal parameter types and output a
11526     DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIE for each one.  */
11527  for (link = first_parm_type; link; )
11528    {
11529      dw_die_ref parm_die;
11530
11531      formal_type = TREE_VALUE (link);
11532      if (formal_type == void_type_node)
11533	break;
11534
11535      /* Output a (nameless) DIE to represent the formal parameter itself.  */
11536      parm_die = gen_formal_parameter_die (formal_type, context_die);
11537      if ((TREE_CODE (function_or_method_type) == METHOD_TYPE
11538	   && link == first_parm_type)
11539	  || (arg && DECL_ARTIFICIAL (arg)))
11540	add_AT_flag (parm_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
11541
11542      link = TREE_CHAIN (link);
11543      if (arg)
11544	arg = TREE_CHAIN (arg);
11545    }
11546
11547  /* If this function type has an ellipsis, add a
11548     DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters DIE to the end of the parameter list.  */
11549  if (formal_type != void_type_node)
11550    gen_unspecified_parameters_die (function_or_method_type, context_die);
11551
11552  /* Make our second (and final) pass over the list of formal parameter types
11553     and output DIEs to represent those types (as necessary).  */
11554  for (link = TYPE_ARG_TYPES (function_or_method_type);
11555       link && TREE_VALUE (link);
11556       link = TREE_CHAIN (link))
11557    gen_type_die (TREE_VALUE (link), context_die);
11558}
11559
11560/* We want to generate the DIE for TYPE so that we can generate the
11561   die for MEMBER, which has been defined; we will need to refer back
11562   to the member declaration nested within TYPE.  If we're trying to
11563   generate minimal debug info for TYPE, processing TYPE won't do the
11564   trick; we need to attach the member declaration by hand.  */
11565
11566static void
11567gen_type_die_for_member (tree type, tree member, dw_die_ref context_die)
11568{
11569  gen_type_die (type, context_die);
11570
11571  /* If we're trying to avoid duplicate debug info, we may not have
11572     emitted the member decl for this function.  Emit it now.  */
11573  if (TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type))
11574      && ! lookup_decl_die (member))
11575    {
11576      dw_die_ref type_die;
11577      gcc_assert (!decl_ultimate_origin (member));
11578
11579      push_decl_scope (type);
11580      type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
11581      if (TREE_CODE (member) == FUNCTION_DECL)
11582	gen_subprogram_die (member, type_die);
11583      else if (TREE_CODE (member) == FIELD_DECL)
11584	{
11585	  /* Ignore the nameless fields that are used to skip bits but handle
11586	     C++ anonymous unions and structs.  */
11587	  if (DECL_NAME (member) != NULL_TREE
11588	      || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (member)) == UNION_TYPE
11589	      || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (member)) == RECORD_TYPE)
11590	    {
11591	      gen_type_die (member_declared_type (member), type_die);
11592	      gen_field_die (member, type_die);
11593	    }
11594	}
11595      else
11596	gen_variable_die (member, type_die);
11597
11598      pop_decl_scope ();
11599    }
11600}
11601
11602/* Generate the DWARF2 info for the "abstract" instance of a function which we
11603   may later generate inlined and/or out-of-line instances of.  */
11604
11605static void
11606dwarf2out_abstract_function (tree decl)
11607{
11608  dw_die_ref old_die;
11609  tree save_fn;
11610  struct function *save_cfun;
11611  tree context;
11612  int was_abstract = DECL_ABSTRACT (decl);
11613
11614  /* Make sure we have the actual abstract inline, not a clone.  */
11615  decl = DECL_ORIGIN (decl);
11616
11617  old_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
11618  if (old_die && get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
11619    /* We've already generated the abstract instance.  */
11620    return;
11621
11622  /* Be sure we've emitted the in-class declaration DIE (if any) first, so
11623     we don't get confused by DECL_ABSTRACT.  */
11624  if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
11625    {
11626      context = decl_class_context (decl);
11627      if (context)
11628	gen_type_die_for_member
11629	  (context, decl, decl_function_context (decl) ? NULL : comp_unit_die);
11630    }
11631
11632  /* Pretend we've just finished compiling this function.  */
11633  save_fn = current_function_decl;
11634  save_cfun = cfun;
11635  current_function_decl = decl;
11636  cfun = DECL_STRUCT_FUNCTION (decl);
11637
11638  set_decl_abstract_flags (decl, 1);
11639  dwarf2out_decl (decl);
11640  if (! was_abstract)
11641    set_decl_abstract_flags (decl, 0);
11642
11643  current_function_decl = save_fn;
11644  cfun = save_cfun;
11645}
11646
11647/* Helper function of premark_used_types() which gets called through
11648   htab_traverse_resize().
11649
11650   Marks the DIE of a given type in *SLOT as perennial, so it never gets
11651   marked as unused by prune_unused_types.  */
11652static int
11653premark_used_types_helper (void **slot, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
11654{
11655  tree type;
11656  dw_die_ref die;
11657
11658  type = *slot;
11659  die = lookup_type_die (type);
11660  if (die != NULL)
11661    die->die_perennial_p = 1;
11662  return 1;
11663}
11664
11665/* Mark all members of used_types_hash as perennial.  */
11666static void
11667premark_used_types (void)
11668{
11669  if (cfun && cfun->used_types_hash)
11670    htab_traverse (cfun->used_types_hash, premark_used_types_helper, NULL);
11671}
11672
11673/* Generate a DIE to represent a declared function (either file-scope or
11674   block-local).  */
11675
11676static void
11677gen_subprogram_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
11678{
11679  char label_id[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
11680  tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
11681  dw_die_ref subr_die;
11682  tree fn_arg_types;
11683  tree outer_scope;
11684  dw_die_ref old_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
11685  int declaration = (current_function_decl != decl
11686		     || class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die));
11687
11688  premark_used_types ();
11689
11690  /* It is possible to have both DECL_ABSTRACT and DECLARATION be true if we
11691     started to generate the abstract instance of an inline, decided to output
11692     its containing class, and proceeded to emit the declaration of the inline
11693     from the member list for the class.  If so, DECLARATION takes priority;
11694     we'll get back to the abstract instance when done with the class.  */
11695
11696  /* The class-scope declaration DIE must be the primary DIE.  */
11697  if (origin && declaration && class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die))
11698    {
11699      origin = NULL;
11700      gcc_assert (!old_die);
11701    }
11702
11703  /* Now that the C++ front end lazily declares artificial member fns, we
11704     might need to retrofit the declaration into its class.  */
11705  if (!declaration && !origin && !old_die
11706      && DECL_CONTEXT (decl) && TYPE_P (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))
11707      && !class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die)
11708      && debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
11709    old_die = force_decl_die (decl);
11710
11711  if (origin != NULL)
11712    {
11713      gcc_assert (!declaration || local_scope_p (context_die));
11714
11715      /* Fixup die_parent for the abstract instance of a nested
11716	 inline function.  */
11717      if (old_die && old_die->die_parent == NULL)
11718	add_child_die (context_die, old_die);
11719
11720      subr_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, context_die, decl);
11721      add_abstract_origin_attribute (subr_die, origin);
11722    }
11723  else if (old_die)
11724    {
11725      expanded_location s = expand_location (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl));
11726      struct dwarf_file_data * file_index = lookup_filename (s.file);
11727
11728      if (!get_AT_flag (old_die, DW_AT_declaration)
11729	  /* We can have a normal definition following an inline one in the
11730	     case of redefinition of GNU C extern inlines.
11731	     It seems reasonable to use AT_specification in this case.  */
11732	  && !get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
11733	{
11734	  /* Detect and ignore this case, where we are trying to output
11735	     something we have already output.  */
11736	  return;
11737	}
11738
11739      /* If the definition comes from the same place as the declaration,
11740	 maybe use the old DIE.  We always want the DIE for this function
11741	 that has the *_pc attributes to be under comp_unit_die so the
11742	 debugger can find it.  We also need to do this for abstract
11743	 instances of inlines, since the spec requires the out-of-line copy
11744	 to have the same parent.  For local class methods, this doesn't
11745	 apply; we just use the old DIE.  */
11746      if ((old_die->die_parent == comp_unit_die || context_die == NULL)
11747	  && (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl)
11748	      || (get_AT_file (old_die, DW_AT_decl_file) == file_index
11749		  && (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_line)
11750		      == (unsigned) s.line))))
11751	{
11752	  subr_die = old_die;
11753
11754	  /* Clear out the declaration attribute and the formal parameters.
11755	     Do not remove all children, because it is possible that this
11756	     declaration die was forced using force_decl_die(). In such
11757	     cases die that forced declaration die (e.g. TAG_imported_module)
11758	     is one of the children that we do not want to remove.  */
11759	  remove_AT (subr_die, DW_AT_declaration);
11760	  remove_child_TAG (subr_die, DW_TAG_formal_parameter);
11761	}
11762      else
11763	{
11764	  subr_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, context_die, decl);
11765	  add_AT_specification (subr_die, old_die);
11766	  if (get_AT_file (old_die, DW_AT_decl_file) != file_index)
11767	    add_AT_file (subr_die, DW_AT_decl_file, file_index);
11768	  if (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_line) != (unsigned) s.line)
11769	    add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_decl_line, s.line);
11770	}
11771    }
11772  else
11773    {
11774      subr_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, context_die, decl);
11775
11776      if (TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
11777	add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
11778
11779      add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (subr_die, decl);
11780      if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
11781	{
11782	  add_prototyped_attribute (subr_die, TREE_TYPE (decl));
11783	  add_type_attribute (subr_die, TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
11784			      0, 0, context_die);
11785	}
11786
11787      add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (subr_die, decl);
11788      if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
11789	add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
11790
11791      if (TREE_PROTECTED (decl))
11792	add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_protected);
11793      else if (TREE_PRIVATE (decl))
11794	add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_private);
11795    }
11796
11797  if (declaration)
11798    {
11799      if (!old_die || !get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
11800	{
11801	  add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
11802
11803	  /* The first time we see a member function, it is in the context of
11804	     the class to which it belongs.  We make sure of this by emitting
11805	     the class first.  The next time is the definition, which is
11806	     handled above.  The two may come from the same source text.
11807
11808	     Note that force_decl_die() forces function declaration die. It is
11809	     later reused to represent definition.  */
11810	  equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, subr_die);
11811	}
11812    }
11813  else if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
11814    {
11815      if (DECL_DECLARED_INLINE_P (decl))
11816	{
11817          if (cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p (decl))
11818	    add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_declared_inlined);
11819	  else
11820	    add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_declared_not_inlined);
11821	}
11822      else
11823	{
11824	  if (cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p (decl))
11825            add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_inlined);
11826	  else
11827            add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_not_inlined);
11828	}
11829
11830      equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, subr_die);
11831    }
11832  else if (!DECL_EXTERNAL (decl))
11833    {
11834      HOST_WIDE_INT cfa_fb_offset;
11835
11836      if (!old_die || !get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
11837	equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, subr_die);
11838
11839      if (!flag_reorder_blocks_and_partition)
11840	{
11841	  ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label_id, FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL,
11842				       current_function_funcdef_no);
11843	  add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_low_pc, label_id);
11844	  ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label_id, FUNC_END_LABEL,
11845				       current_function_funcdef_no);
11846	  add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_high_pc, label_id);
11847
11848	  add_pubname (decl, subr_die);
11849	  add_arange (decl, subr_die);
11850	}
11851      else
11852	{  /* Do nothing for now; maybe need to duplicate die, one for
11853	      hot section and ond for cold section, then use the hot/cold
11854	      section begin/end labels to generate the aranges...  */
11855	  /*
11856	    add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_low_pc, hot_section_label);
11857	    add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_high_pc, hot_section_end_label);
11858	    add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_lo_user, unlikely_section_label);
11859	    add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_hi_user, cold_section_end_label);
11860
11861	    add_pubname (decl, subr_die);
11862	    add_arange (decl, subr_die);
11863	    add_arange (decl, subr_die);
11864	   */
11865	}
11866
11867#ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
11868      /* Add a reference to the FDE for this routine.  */
11869      add_AT_fde_ref (subr_die, DW_AT_MIPS_fde, current_funcdef_fde);
11870#endif
11871
11872      cfa_fb_offset = CFA_FRAME_BASE_OFFSET (decl);
11873
11874      /* We define the "frame base" as the function's CFA.  This is more
11875	 convenient for several reasons: (1) It's stable across the prologue
11876	 and epilogue, which makes it better than just a frame pointer,
11877	 (2) With dwarf3, there exists a one-byte encoding that allows us
11878	 to reference the .debug_frame data by proxy, but failing that,
11879	 (3) We can at least reuse the code inspection and interpretation
11880	 code that determines the CFA position at various points in the
11881	 function.  */
11882      /* ??? Use some command-line or configury switch to enable the use
11883	 of dwarf3 DW_OP_call_frame_cfa.  At present there are no dwarf
11884	 consumers that understand it; fall back to "pure" dwarf2 and
11885	 convert the CFA data into a location list.  */
11886      {
11887	dw_loc_list_ref list = convert_cfa_to_fb_loc_list (cfa_fb_offset);
11888	if (list->dw_loc_next)
11889	  add_AT_loc_list (subr_die, DW_AT_frame_base, list);
11890	else
11891	  add_AT_loc (subr_die, DW_AT_frame_base, list->expr);
11892      }
11893
11894      /* Compute a displacement from the "steady-state frame pointer" to
11895	 the CFA.  The former is what all stack slots and argument slots
11896	 will reference in the rtl; the later is what we've told the
11897	 debugger about.  We'll need to adjust all frame_base references
11898	 by this displacement.  */
11899      compute_frame_pointer_to_fb_displacement (cfa_fb_offset);
11900
11901      if (cfun->static_chain_decl)
11902	add_AT_location_description (subr_die, DW_AT_static_link,
11903		 loc_descriptor_from_tree (cfun->static_chain_decl));
11904    }
11905
11906  /* Now output descriptions of the arguments for this function. This gets
11907     (unnecessarily?) complex because of the fact that the DECL_ARGUMENT list
11908     for a FUNCTION_DECL doesn't indicate cases where there was a trailing
11909     `...' at the end of the formal parameter list.  In order to find out if
11910     there was a trailing ellipsis or not, we must instead look at the type
11911     associated with the FUNCTION_DECL.  This will be a node of type
11912     FUNCTION_TYPE. If the chain of type nodes hanging off of this
11913     FUNCTION_TYPE node ends with a void_type_node then there should *not* be
11914     an ellipsis at the end.  */
11915
11916  /* In the case where we are describing a mere function declaration, all we
11917     need to do here (and all we *can* do here) is to describe the *types* of
11918     its formal parameters.  */
11919  if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
11920    ;
11921  else if (declaration)
11922    gen_formal_types_die (decl, subr_die);
11923  else
11924    {
11925      /* Generate DIEs to represent all known formal parameters.  */
11926      tree arg_decls = DECL_ARGUMENTS (decl);
11927      tree parm;
11928
11929      /* When generating DIEs, generate the unspecified_parameters DIE
11930	 instead if we come across the arg "__builtin_va_alist" */
11931      for (parm = arg_decls; parm; parm = TREE_CHAIN (parm))
11932	if (TREE_CODE (parm) == PARM_DECL)
11933	  {
11934	    if (DECL_NAME (parm)
11935		&& !strcmp (IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_NAME (parm)),
11936			    "__builtin_va_alist"))
11937	      gen_unspecified_parameters_die (parm, subr_die);
11938	    else
11939	      gen_decl_die (parm, subr_die);
11940	  }
11941
11942      /* Decide whether we need an unspecified_parameters DIE at the end.
11943	 There are 2 more cases to do this for: 1) the ansi ... declaration -
11944	 this is detectable when the end of the arg list is not a
11945	 void_type_node 2) an unprototyped function declaration (not a
11946	 definition).  This just means that we have no info about the
11947	 parameters at all.  */
11948      fn_arg_types = TYPE_ARG_TYPES (TREE_TYPE (decl));
11949      if (fn_arg_types != NULL)
11950	{
11951	  /* This is the prototyped case, check for....  */
11952	  if (TREE_VALUE (tree_last (fn_arg_types)) != void_type_node)
11953	    gen_unspecified_parameters_die (decl, subr_die);
11954	}
11955      else if (DECL_INITIAL (decl) == NULL_TREE)
11956	gen_unspecified_parameters_die (decl, subr_die);
11957    }
11958
11959  /* Output Dwarf info for all of the stuff within the body of the function
11960     (if it has one - it may be just a declaration).  */
11961  outer_scope = DECL_INITIAL (decl);
11962
11963  /* OUTER_SCOPE is a pointer to the outermost BLOCK node created to represent
11964     a function.  This BLOCK actually represents the outermost binding contour
11965     for the function, i.e. the contour in which the function's formal
11966     parameters and labels get declared. Curiously, it appears that the front
11967     end doesn't actually put the PARM_DECL nodes for the current function onto
11968     the BLOCK_VARS list for this outer scope, but are strung off of the
11969     DECL_ARGUMENTS list for the function instead.
11970
11971     The BLOCK_VARS list for the `outer_scope' does provide us with a list of
11972     the LABEL_DECL nodes for the function however, and we output DWARF info
11973     for those in decls_for_scope.  Just within the `outer_scope' there will be
11974     a BLOCK node representing the function's outermost pair of curly braces,
11975     and any blocks used for the base and member initializers of a C++
11976     constructor function.  */
11977  if (! declaration && TREE_CODE (outer_scope) != ERROR_MARK)
11978    {
11979      /* Emit a DW_TAG_variable DIE for a named return value.  */
11980      if (DECL_NAME (DECL_RESULT (decl)))
11981	gen_decl_die (DECL_RESULT (decl), subr_die);
11982
11983      current_function_has_inlines = 0;
11984      decls_for_scope (outer_scope, subr_die, 0);
11985
11986#if 0 && defined (MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO)
11987      if (current_function_has_inlines)
11988	{
11989	  add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_MIPS_has_inlines, 1);
11990	  if (! comp_unit_has_inlines)
11991	    {
11992	      add_AT_flag (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_MIPS_has_inlines, 1);
11993	      comp_unit_has_inlines = 1;
11994	    }
11995	}
11996#endif
11997    }
11998  /* Add the calling convention attribute if requested.  */
11999  add_calling_convention_attribute (subr_die, TREE_TYPE (decl));
12000
12001}
12002
12003/* Generate a DIE to represent a declared data object.  */
12004
12005static void
12006gen_variable_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
12007{
12008  tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
12009  dw_die_ref var_die = new_die (DW_TAG_variable, context_die, decl);
12010
12011  dw_die_ref old_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
12012  int declaration = (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl)
12013		     /* If DECL is COMDAT and has not actually been
12014			emitted, we cannot take its address; there
12015			might end up being no definition anywhere in
12016			the program.  For example, consider the C++
12017			test case:
12018
12019                          template <class T>
12020                          struct S { static const int i = 7; };
12021
12022                          template <class T>
12023                          const int S<T>::i;
12024
12025                          int f() { return S<int>::i; }
12026
12027			Here, S<int>::i is not DECL_EXTERNAL, but no
12028			definition is required, so the compiler will
12029			not emit a definition.  */
12030		     || (TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL
12031			 && DECL_COMDAT (decl) && !TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl))
12032		     || class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die));
12033
12034  if (origin != NULL)
12035    add_abstract_origin_attribute (var_die, origin);
12036
12037  /* Loop unrolling can create multiple blocks that refer to the same
12038     static variable, so we must test for the DW_AT_declaration flag.
12039
12040     ??? Loop unrolling/reorder_blocks should perhaps be rewritten to
12041     copy decls and set the DECL_ABSTRACT flag on them instead of
12042     sharing them.
12043
12044     ??? Duplicated blocks have been rewritten to use .debug_ranges.
12045
12046     ??? The declare_in_namespace support causes us to get two DIEs for one
12047     variable, both of which are declarations.  We want to avoid considering
12048     one to be a specification, so we must test that this DIE is not a
12049     declaration.  */
12050  else if (old_die && TREE_STATIC (decl) && ! declaration
12051	   && get_AT_flag (old_die, DW_AT_declaration) == 1)
12052    {
12053      /* This is a definition of a C++ class level static.  */
12054      add_AT_specification (var_die, old_die);
12055      if (DECL_NAME (decl))
12056	{
12057	  expanded_location s = expand_location (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl));
12058	  struct dwarf_file_data * file_index = lookup_filename (s.file);
12059
12060	  if (get_AT_file (old_die, DW_AT_decl_file) != file_index)
12061	    add_AT_file (var_die, DW_AT_decl_file, file_index);
12062
12063	  if (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_line) != (unsigned) s.line)
12064
12065	    add_AT_unsigned (var_die, DW_AT_decl_line, s.line);
12066	}
12067    }
12068  else
12069    {
12070      add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (var_die, decl);
12071      add_type_attribute (var_die, TREE_TYPE (decl), TREE_READONLY (decl),
12072			  TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl), context_die);
12073
12074      if (TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
12075	add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
12076
12077      if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
12078	add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
12079
12080      if (TREE_PROTECTED (decl))
12081	add_AT_unsigned (var_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_protected);
12082      else if (TREE_PRIVATE (decl))
12083	add_AT_unsigned (var_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_private);
12084    }
12085
12086  if (declaration)
12087    add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
12088
12089  if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl) || declaration)
12090    equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, var_die);
12091
12092  if (! declaration && ! DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
12093    {
12094      add_location_or_const_value_attribute (var_die, decl, DW_AT_location);
12095      add_pubname (decl, var_die);
12096    }
12097  else
12098    tree_add_const_value_attribute (var_die, decl);
12099}
12100
12101/* Generate a DIE to represent a label identifier.  */
12102
12103static void
12104gen_label_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
12105{
12106  tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
12107  dw_die_ref lbl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_label, context_die, decl);
12108  rtx insn;
12109  char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
12110
12111  if (origin != NULL)
12112    add_abstract_origin_attribute (lbl_die, origin);
12113  else
12114    add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (lbl_die, decl);
12115
12116  if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
12117    equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, lbl_die);
12118  else
12119    {
12120      insn = DECL_RTL_IF_SET (decl);
12121
12122      /* Deleted labels are programmer specified labels which have been
12123	 eliminated because of various optimizations.  We still emit them
12124	 here so that it is possible to put breakpoints on them.  */
12125      if (insn
12126	  && (LABEL_P (insn)
12127	      || ((NOTE_P (insn)
12128	           && NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (insn) == NOTE_INSN_DELETED_LABEL))))
12129	{
12130	  /* When optimization is enabled (via -O) some parts of the compiler
12131	     (e.g. jump.c and cse.c) may try to delete CODE_LABEL insns which
12132	     represent source-level labels which were explicitly declared by
12133	     the user.  This really shouldn't be happening though, so catch
12134	     it if it ever does happen.  */
12135	  gcc_assert (!INSN_DELETED_P (insn));
12136
12137	  ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "L", CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (insn));
12138	  add_AT_lbl_id (lbl_die, DW_AT_low_pc, label);
12139	}
12140    }
12141}
12142
12143/* A helper function for gen_inlined_subroutine_die.  Add source coordinate
12144   attributes to the DIE for a block STMT, to describe where the inlined
12145   function was called from.  This is similar to add_src_coords_attributes.  */
12146
12147static inline void
12148add_call_src_coords_attributes (tree stmt, dw_die_ref die)
12149{
12150  expanded_location s = expand_location (BLOCK_SOURCE_LOCATION (stmt));
12151
12152  add_AT_file (die, DW_AT_call_file, lookup_filename (s.file));
12153  add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_call_line, s.line);
12154}
12155
12156/* A helper function for gen_lexical_block_die and gen_inlined_subroutine_die.
12157   Add low_pc and high_pc attributes to the DIE for a block STMT.  */
12158
12159static inline void
12160add_high_low_attributes (tree stmt, dw_die_ref die)
12161{
12162  char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
12163
12164  if (BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (stmt))
12165    {
12166      tree chain;
12167
12168      add_AT_range_list (die, DW_AT_ranges, add_ranges (stmt));
12169
12170      chain = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (stmt);
12171      do
12172	{
12173	  add_ranges (chain);
12174	  chain = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (chain);
12175	}
12176      while (chain);
12177      add_ranges (NULL);
12178    }
12179  else
12180    {
12181      ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL,
12182				   BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt));
12183      add_AT_lbl_id (die, DW_AT_low_pc, label);
12184      ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, BLOCK_END_LABEL,
12185				   BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt));
12186      add_AT_lbl_id (die, DW_AT_high_pc, label);
12187    }
12188}
12189
12190/* Generate a DIE for a lexical block.  */
12191
12192static void
12193gen_lexical_block_die (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die, int depth)
12194{
12195  dw_die_ref stmt_die = new_die (DW_TAG_lexical_block, context_die, stmt);
12196
12197  if (! BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt))
12198    add_high_low_attributes (stmt, stmt_die);
12199
12200  decls_for_scope (stmt, stmt_die, depth);
12201}
12202
12203/* Generate a DIE for an inlined subprogram.  */
12204
12205static void
12206gen_inlined_subroutine_die (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die, int depth)
12207{
12208  tree decl = block_ultimate_origin (stmt);
12209
12210  /* Emit info for the abstract instance first, if we haven't yet.  We
12211     must emit this even if the block is abstract, otherwise when we
12212     emit the block below (or elsewhere), we may end up trying to emit
12213     a die whose origin die hasn't been emitted, and crashing.  */
12214  dwarf2out_abstract_function (decl);
12215
12216  if (! BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt))
12217    {
12218      dw_die_ref subr_die
12219	= new_die (DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine, context_die, stmt);
12220
12221      add_abstract_origin_attribute (subr_die, decl);
12222      add_high_low_attributes (stmt, subr_die);
12223      add_call_src_coords_attributes (stmt, subr_die);
12224
12225      decls_for_scope (stmt, subr_die, depth);
12226      current_function_has_inlines = 1;
12227    }
12228  else
12229    /* We may get here if we're the outer block of function A that was
12230       inlined into function B that was inlined into function C.  When
12231       generating debugging info for C, dwarf2out_abstract_function(B)
12232       would mark all inlined blocks as abstract, including this one.
12233       So, we wouldn't (and shouldn't) expect labels to be generated
12234       for this one.  Instead, just emit debugging info for
12235       declarations within the block.  This is particularly important
12236       in the case of initializers of arguments passed from B to us:
12237       if they're statement expressions containing declarations, we
12238       wouldn't generate dies for their abstract variables, and then,
12239       when generating dies for the real variables, we'd die (pun
12240       intended :-)  */
12241    gen_lexical_block_die (stmt, context_die, depth);
12242}
12243
12244/* Generate a DIE for a field in a record, or structure.  */
12245
12246static void
12247gen_field_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
12248{
12249  dw_die_ref decl_die;
12250
12251  if (TREE_TYPE (decl) == error_mark_node)
12252    return;
12253
12254  decl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_member, context_die, decl);
12255  add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (decl_die, decl);
12256  add_type_attribute (decl_die, member_declared_type (decl),
12257		      TREE_READONLY (decl), TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl),
12258		      context_die);
12259
12260  if (DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl))
12261    {
12262      add_byte_size_attribute (decl_die, decl);
12263      add_bit_size_attribute (decl_die, decl);
12264      add_bit_offset_attribute (decl_die, decl);
12265    }
12266
12267  if (TREE_CODE (DECL_FIELD_CONTEXT (decl)) != UNION_TYPE)
12268    add_data_member_location_attribute (decl_die, decl);
12269
12270  if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
12271    add_AT_flag (decl_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
12272
12273  if (TREE_PROTECTED (decl))
12274    add_AT_unsigned (decl_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_protected);
12275  else if (TREE_PRIVATE (decl))
12276    add_AT_unsigned (decl_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_private);
12277
12278  /* Equate decl number to die, so that we can look up this decl later on.  */
12279  equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, decl_die);
12280}
12281
12282#if 0
12283/* Don't generate either pointer_type DIEs or reference_type DIEs here.
12284   Use modified_type_die instead.
12285   We keep this code here just in case these types of DIEs may be needed to
12286   represent certain things in other languages (e.g. Pascal) someday.  */
12287
12288static void
12289gen_pointer_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
12290{
12291  dw_die_ref ptr_die
12292    = new_die (DW_TAG_pointer_type, scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
12293
12294  equate_type_number_to_die (type, ptr_die);
12295  add_type_attribute (ptr_die, TREE_TYPE (type), 0, 0, context_die);
12296  add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size, PTR_SIZE);
12297}
12298
12299/* Don't generate either pointer_type DIEs or reference_type DIEs here.
12300   Use modified_type_die instead.
12301   We keep this code here just in case these types of DIEs may be needed to
12302   represent certain things in other languages (e.g. Pascal) someday.  */
12303
12304static void
12305gen_reference_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
12306{
12307  dw_die_ref ref_die
12308    = new_die (DW_TAG_reference_type, scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
12309
12310  equate_type_number_to_die (type, ref_die);
12311  add_type_attribute (ref_die, TREE_TYPE (type), 0, 0, context_die);
12312  add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size, PTR_SIZE);
12313}
12314#endif
12315
12316/* Generate a DIE for a pointer to a member type.  */
12317
12318static void
12319gen_ptr_to_mbr_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
12320{
12321  dw_die_ref ptr_die
12322    = new_die (DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type,
12323	       scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
12324
12325  equate_type_number_to_die (type, ptr_die);
12326  add_AT_die_ref (ptr_die, DW_AT_containing_type,
12327		  lookup_type_die (TYPE_OFFSET_BASETYPE (type)));
12328  add_type_attribute (ptr_die, TREE_TYPE (type), 0, 0, context_die);
12329}
12330
12331/* Generate the DIE for the compilation unit.  */
12332
12333static dw_die_ref
12334gen_compile_unit_die (const char *filename)
12335{
12336  dw_die_ref die;
12337  char producer[250];
12338  const char *language_string = lang_hooks.name;
12339  int language;
12340
12341  die = new_die (DW_TAG_compile_unit, NULL, NULL);
12342
12343  if (filename)
12344    {
12345      add_name_attribute (die, filename);
12346      /* Don't add cwd for <built-in>.  */
12347      if (filename[0] != DIR_SEPARATOR && filename[0] != '<')
12348	add_comp_dir_attribute (die);
12349    }
12350
12351  sprintf (producer, "%s %s", language_string, version_string);
12352
12353#ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
12354  /* The MIPS/SGI compilers place the 'cc' command line options in the producer
12355     string.  The SGI debugger looks for -g, -g1, -g2, or -g3; if they do
12356     not appear in the producer string, the debugger reaches the conclusion
12357     that the object file is stripped and has no debugging information.
12358     To get the MIPS/SGI debugger to believe that there is debugging
12359     information in the object file, we add a -g to the producer string.  */
12360  if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
12361    strcat (producer, " -g");
12362#endif
12363
12364  add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_producer, producer);
12365
12366  if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU C++") == 0)
12367    language = DW_LANG_C_plus_plus;
12368  else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Ada") == 0)
12369    language = DW_LANG_Ada95;
12370  else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU F77") == 0)
12371    language = DW_LANG_Fortran77;
12372  else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU F95") == 0)
12373    language = DW_LANG_Fortran95;
12374  else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Pascal") == 0)
12375    language = DW_LANG_Pascal83;
12376  else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Java") == 0)
12377    language = DW_LANG_Java;
12378  else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Objective-C") == 0)
12379    language = DW_LANG_ObjC;
12380  else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Objective-C++") == 0)
12381    language = DW_LANG_ObjC_plus_plus;
12382  else
12383    language = DW_LANG_C89;
12384
12385  add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_language, language);
12386  return die;
12387}
12388
12389/* Generate the DIE for a base class.  */
12390
12391static void
12392gen_inheritance_die (tree binfo, tree access, dw_die_ref context_die)
12393{
12394  dw_die_ref die = new_die (DW_TAG_inheritance, context_die, binfo);
12395
12396  add_type_attribute (die, BINFO_TYPE (binfo), 0, 0, context_die);
12397  add_data_member_location_attribute (die, binfo);
12398
12399  if (BINFO_VIRTUAL_P (binfo))
12400    add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_virtuality, DW_VIRTUALITY_virtual);
12401
12402  if (access == access_public_node)
12403    add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_public);
12404  else if (access == access_protected_node)
12405    add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_protected);
12406}
12407
12408/* Generate a DIE for a class member.  */
12409
12410static void
12411gen_member_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
12412{
12413  tree member;
12414  tree binfo = TYPE_BINFO (type);
12415  dw_die_ref child;
12416
12417  /* If this is not an incomplete type, output descriptions of each of its
12418     members. Note that as we output the DIEs necessary to represent the
12419     members of this record or union type, we will also be trying to output
12420     DIEs to represent the *types* of those members. However the `type'
12421     function (above) will specifically avoid generating type DIEs for member
12422     types *within* the list of member DIEs for this (containing) type except
12423     for those types (of members) which are explicitly marked as also being
12424     members of this (containing) type themselves.  The g++ front- end can
12425     force any given type to be treated as a member of some other (containing)
12426     type by setting the TYPE_CONTEXT of the given (member) type to point to
12427     the TREE node representing the appropriate (containing) type.  */
12428
12429  /* First output info about the base classes.  */
12430  if (binfo)
12431    {
12432      VEC(tree,gc) *accesses = BINFO_BASE_ACCESSES (binfo);
12433      int i;
12434      tree base;
12435
12436      for (i = 0; BINFO_BASE_ITERATE (binfo, i, base); i++)
12437	gen_inheritance_die (base,
12438			     (accesses ? VEC_index (tree, accesses, i)
12439			      : access_public_node), context_die);
12440    }
12441
12442  /* Now output info about the data members and type members.  */
12443  for (member = TYPE_FIELDS (type); member; member = TREE_CHAIN (member))
12444    {
12445      /* If we thought we were generating minimal debug info for TYPE
12446	 and then changed our minds, some of the member declarations
12447	 may have already been defined.  Don't define them again, but
12448	 do put them in the right order.  */
12449
12450      child = lookup_decl_die (member);
12451      if (child)
12452	splice_child_die (context_die, child);
12453      else
12454	gen_decl_die (member, context_die);
12455    }
12456
12457  /* Now output info about the function members (if any).  */
12458  for (member = TYPE_METHODS (type); member; member = TREE_CHAIN (member))
12459    {
12460      /* Don't include clones in the member list.  */
12461      if (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (member))
12462	continue;
12463
12464      child = lookup_decl_die (member);
12465      if (child)
12466	splice_child_die (context_die, child);
12467      else
12468	gen_decl_die (member, context_die);
12469    }
12470}
12471
12472/* Generate a DIE for a structure or union type.  If TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG
12473   is set, we pretend that the type was never defined, so we only get the
12474   member DIEs needed by later specification DIEs.  */
12475
12476static void
12477gen_struct_or_union_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die,
12478				enum debug_info_usage usage)
12479{
12480  dw_die_ref type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
12481  dw_die_ref scope_die = 0;
12482  int nested = 0;
12483  int complete = (TYPE_SIZE (type)
12484		  && (! TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)
12485		      || ! TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type))));
12486  int ns_decl = (context_die && context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_namespace);
12487  complete = complete && should_emit_struct_debug (type, usage);
12488
12489  if (type_die && ! complete)
12490    return;
12491
12492  if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type) != NULL_TREE
12493      && (AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type))
12494	  || TREE_CODE (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)) == NAMESPACE_DECL))
12495    nested = 1;
12496
12497  scope_die = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
12498
12499  if (! type_die || (nested && scope_die == comp_unit_die))
12500    /* First occurrence of type or toplevel definition of nested class.  */
12501    {
12502      dw_die_ref old_die = type_die;
12503
12504      type_die = new_die (TREE_CODE (type) == RECORD_TYPE
12505			  ? DW_TAG_structure_type : DW_TAG_union_type,
12506			  scope_die, type);
12507      equate_type_number_to_die (type, type_die);
12508      if (old_die)
12509	add_AT_specification (type_die, old_die);
12510      else
12511	add_name_attribute (type_die, type_tag (type));
12512    }
12513  else
12514    remove_AT (type_die, DW_AT_declaration);
12515
12516  /* If this type has been completed, then give it a byte_size attribute and
12517     then give a list of members.  */
12518  if (complete && !ns_decl)
12519    {
12520      /* Prevent infinite recursion in cases where the type of some member of
12521	 this type is expressed in terms of this type itself.  */
12522      TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
12523      add_byte_size_attribute (type_die, type);
12524      if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type) != NULL_TREE)
12525	add_src_coords_attributes (type_die, TYPE_STUB_DECL (type));
12526
12527      /* If the first reference to this type was as the return type of an
12528	 inline function, then it may not have a parent.  Fix this now.  */
12529      if (type_die->die_parent == NULL)
12530	add_child_die (scope_die, type_die);
12531
12532      push_decl_scope (type);
12533      gen_member_die (type, type_die);
12534      pop_decl_scope ();
12535
12536      /* GNU extension: Record what type our vtable lives in.  */
12537      if (TYPE_VFIELD (type))
12538	{
12539	  tree vtype = DECL_FCONTEXT (TYPE_VFIELD (type));
12540
12541	  gen_type_die (vtype, context_die);
12542	  add_AT_die_ref (type_die, DW_AT_containing_type,
12543			  lookup_type_die (vtype));
12544	}
12545    }
12546  else
12547    {
12548      add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
12549
12550      /* We don't need to do this for function-local types.  */
12551      if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)
12552	  && ! decl_function_context (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)))
12553	VEC_safe_push (tree, gc, incomplete_types, type);
12554    }
12555}
12556
12557/* Generate a DIE for a subroutine _type_.  */
12558
12559static void
12560gen_subroutine_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
12561{
12562  tree return_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
12563  dw_die_ref subr_die
12564    = new_die (DW_TAG_subroutine_type,
12565	       scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
12566
12567  equate_type_number_to_die (type, subr_die);
12568  add_prototyped_attribute (subr_die, type);
12569  add_type_attribute (subr_die, return_type, 0, 0, context_die);
12570  gen_formal_types_die (type, subr_die);
12571}
12572
12573/* Generate a DIE for a type definition.  */
12574
12575static void
12576gen_typedef_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
12577{
12578  dw_die_ref type_die;
12579  tree origin;
12580
12581  if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl))
12582    return;
12583
12584  TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl) = 1;
12585  type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_typedef, context_die, decl);
12586  origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
12587  if (origin != NULL)
12588    add_abstract_origin_attribute (type_die, origin);
12589  else
12590    {
12591      tree type;
12592
12593      add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (type_die, decl);
12594      if (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (decl))
12595	{
12596	  type = DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (decl);
12597
12598	  gcc_assert (type != TREE_TYPE (decl));
12599	  equate_type_number_to_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), type_die);
12600	}
12601      else
12602	type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
12603
12604      add_type_attribute (type_die, type, TREE_READONLY (decl),
12605			  TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl), context_die);
12606    }
12607
12608  if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
12609    equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, type_die);
12610}
12611
12612/* Generate a type description DIE.  */
12613
12614static void
12615gen_type_die_with_usage (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die,
12616				enum debug_info_usage usage)
12617{
12618  int need_pop;
12619
12620  if (type == NULL_TREE || type == error_mark_node)
12621    return;
12622
12623  if (TYPE_NAME (type) && TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == TYPE_DECL
12624      && DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (TYPE_NAME (type)))
12625    {
12626      if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
12627	return;
12628
12629      /* Prevent broken recursion; we can't hand off to the same type.  */
12630      gcc_assert (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (TYPE_NAME (type)) != type);
12631
12632      TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
12633      gen_decl_die (TYPE_NAME (type), context_die);
12634      return;
12635    }
12636
12637  /* We are going to output a DIE to represent the unqualified version
12638     of this type (i.e. without any const or volatile qualifiers) so
12639     get the main variant (i.e. the unqualified version) of this type
12640     now.  (Vectors are special because the debugging info is in the
12641     cloned type itself).  */
12642  if (TREE_CODE (type) != VECTOR_TYPE)
12643    type = type_main_variant (type);
12644
12645  if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
12646    return;
12647
12648  switch (TREE_CODE (type))
12649    {
12650    case ERROR_MARK:
12651      break;
12652
12653    case POINTER_TYPE:
12654    case REFERENCE_TYPE:
12655      /* We must set TREE_ASM_WRITTEN in case this is a recursive type.  This
12656	 ensures that the gen_type_die recursion will terminate even if the
12657	 type is recursive.  Recursive types are possible in Ada.  */
12658      /* ??? We could perhaps do this for all types before the switch
12659	 statement.  */
12660      TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
12661
12662      /* For these types, all that is required is that we output a DIE (or a
12663	 set of DIEs) to represent the "basis" type.  */
12664      gen_type_die_with_usage (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die,
12665				DINFO_USAGE_IND_USE);
12666      break;
12667
12668    case OFFSET_TYPE:
12669      /* This code is used for C++ pointer-to-data-member types.
12670	 Output a description of the relevant class type.  */
12671      gen_type_die_with_usage (TYPE_OFFSET_BASETYPE (type), context_die,
12672					DINFO_USAGE_IND_USE);
12673
12674      /* Output a description of the type of the object pointed to.  */
12675      gen_type_die_with_usage (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die,
12676					DINFO_USAGE_IND_USE);
12677
12678      /* Now output a DIE to represent this pointer-to-data-member type
12679	 itself.  */
12680      gen_ptr_to_mbr_type_die (type, context_die);
12681      break;
12682
12683    case FUNCTION_TYPE:
12684      /* Force out return type (in case it wasn't forced out already).  */
12685      gen_type_die_with_usage (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die,
12686					DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE);
12687      gen_subroutine_type_die (type, context_die);
12688      break;
12689
12690    case METHOD_TYPE:
12691      /* Force out return type (in case it wasn't forced out already).  */
12692      gen_type_die_with_usage (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die,
12693					DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE);
12694      gen_subroutine_type_die (type, context_die);
12695      break;
12696
12697    case ARRAY_TYPE:
12698      gen_array_type_die (type, context_die);
12699      break;
12700
12701    case VECTOR_TYPE:
12702      gen_array_type_die (type, context_die);
12703      break;
12704
12705    case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
12706    case RECORD_TYPE:
12707    case UNION_TYPE:
12708    case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
12709      /* If this is a nested type whose containing class hasn't been written
12710	 out yet, writing it out will cover this one, too.  This does not apply
12711	 to instantiations of member class templates; they need to be added to
12712	 the containing class as they are generated.  FIXME: This hurts the
12713	 idea of combining type decls from multiple TUs, since we can't predict
12714	 what set of template instantiations we'll get.  */
12715      if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)
12716	  && AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type))
12717	  && ! TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)))
12718	{
12719	  gen_type_die_with_usage (TYPE_CONTEXT (type), context_die, usage);
12720
12721	  if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
12722	    return;
12723
12724	  /* If that failed, attach ourselves to the stub.  */
12725	  push_decl_scope (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
12726	  context_die = lookup_type_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
12727	  need_pop = 1;
12728	}
12729      else
12730	{
12731	  declare_in_namespace (type, context_die);
12732	  need_pop = 0;
12733	}
12734
12735      if (TREE_CODE (type) == ENUMERAL_TYPE)
12736	{
12737	  /* This might have been written out by the call to
12738	     declare_in_namespace.  */
12739	  if (!TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
12740	    gen_enumeration_type_die (type, context_die);
12741	}
12742      else
12743	gen_struct_or_union_type_die (type, context_die, usage);
12744
12745      if (need_pop)
12746	pop_decl_scope ();
12747
12748      /* Don't set TREE_ASM_WRITTEN on an incomplete struct; we want to fix
12749	 it up if it is ever completed.  gen_*_type_die will set it for us
12750	 when appropriate.  */
12751      return;
12752
12753    case VOID_TYPE:
12754    case INTEGER_TYPE:
12755    case REAL_TYPE:
12756    case COMPLEX_TYPE:
12757    case BOOLEAN_TYPE:
12758      /* No DIEs needed for fundamental types.  */
12759      break;
12760
12761    case LANG_TYPE:
12762      /* No Dwarf representation currently defined.  */
12763      break;
12764
12765    default:
12766      gcc_unreachable ();
12767    }
12768
12769  TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
12770}
12771
12772static void
12773gen_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
12774{
12775  gen_type_die_with_usage (type, context_die, DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE);
12776}
12777
12778/* Generate a DIE for a tagged type instantiation.  */
12779
12780static void
12781gen_tagged_type_instantiation_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
12782{
12783  if (type == NULL_TREE || type == error_mark_node)
12784    return;
12785
12786  /* We are going to output a DIE to represent the unqualified version of
12787     this type (i.e. without any const or volatile qualifiers) so make sure
12788     that we have the main variant (i.e. the unqualified version) of this
12789     type now.  */
12790  gcc_assert (type == type_main_variant (type));
12791
12792  /* Do not check TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) as it may not be set if this is
12793     an instance of an unresolved type.  */
12794
12795  switch (TREE_CODE (type))
12796    {
12797    case ERROR_MARK:
12798      break;
12799
12800    case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
12801      gen_inlined_enumeration_type_die (type, context_die);
12802      break;
12803
12804    case RECORD_TYPE:
12805      gen_inlined_structure_type_die (type, context_die);
12806      break;
12807
12808    case UNION_TYPE:
12809    case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
12810      gen_inlined_union_type_die (type, context_die);
12811      break;
12812
12813    default:
12814      gcc_unreachable ();
12815    }
12816}
12817
12818/* Generate a DW_TAG_lexical_block DIE followed by DIEs to represent all of the
12819   things which are local to the given block.  */
12820
12821static void
12822gen_block_die (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die, int depth)
12823{
12824  int must_output_die = 0;
12825  tree origin;
12826  tree decl;
12827  enum tree_code origin_code;
12828
12829  /* Ignore blocks that are NULL.  */
12830  if (stmt == NULL_TREE)
12831    return;
12832
12833  /* If the block is one fragment of a non-contiguous block, do not
12834     process the variables, since they will have been done by the
12835     origin block.  Do process subblocks.  */
12836  if (BLOCK_FRAGMENT_ORIGIN (stmt))
12837    {
12838      tree sub;
12839
12840      for (sub = BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (stmt); sub; sub = BLOCK_CHAIN (sub))
12841	gen_block_die (sub, context_die, depth + 1);
12842
12843      return;
12844    }
12845
12846  /* Determine the "ultimate origin" of this block.  This block may be an
12847     inlined instance of an inlined instance of inline function, so we have
12848     to trace all of the way back through the origin chain to find out what
12849     sort of node actually served as the original seed for the creation of
12850     the current block.  */
12851  origin = block_ultimate_origin (stmt);
12852  origin_code = (origin != NULL) ? TREE_CODE (origin) : ERROR_MARK;
12853
12854  /* Determine if we need to output any Dwarf DIEs at all to represent this
12855     block.  */
12856  if (origin_code == FUNCTION_DECL)
12857    /* The outer scopes for inlinings *must* always be represented.  We
12858       generate DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine DIEs for them.  (See below.) */
12859    must_output_die = 1;
12860  else
12861    {
12862      /* In the case where the current block represents an inlining of the
12863	 "body block" of an inline function, we must *NOT* output any DIE for
12864	 this block because we have already output a DIE to represent the whole
12865	 inlined function scope and the "body block" of any function doesn't
12866	 really represent a different scope according to ANSI C rules.  So we
12867	 check here to make sure that this block does not represent a "body
12868	 block inlining" before trying to set the MUST_OUTPUT_DIE flag.  */
12869      if (! is_body_block (origin ? origin : stmt))
12870	{
12871	  /* Determine if this block directly contains any "significant"
12872	     local declarations which we will need to output DIEs for.  */
12873	  if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
12874	    /* We are not in terse mode so *any* local declaration counts
12875	       as being a "significant" one.  */
12876	    must_output_die = (BLOCK_VARS (stmt) != NULL
12877			       && (TREE_USED (stmt)
12878				   || TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (stmt)
12879				   || BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt)));
12880	  else
12881	    /* We are in terse mode, so only local (nested) function
12882	       definitions count as "significant" local declarations.  */
12883	    for (decl = BLOCK_VARS (stmt);
12884		 decl != NULL; decl = TREE_CHAIN (decl))
12885	      if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL
12886		  && DECL_INITIAL (decl))
12887		{
12888		  must_output_die = 1;
12889		  break;
12890		}
12891	}
12892    }
12893
12894  /* It would be a waste of space to generate a Dwarf DW_TAG_lexical_block
12895     DIE for any block which contains no significant local declarations at
12896     all.  Rather, in such cases we just call `decls_for_scope' so that any
12897     needed Dwarf info for any sub-blocks will get properly generated. Note
12898     that in terse mode, our definition of what constitutes a "significant"
12899     local declaration gets restricted to include only inlined function
12900     instances and local (nested) function definitions.  */
12901  if (must_output_die)
12902    {
12903      if (origin_code == FUNCTION_DECL)
12904	gen_inlined_subroutine_die (stmt, context_die, depth);
12905      else
12906	gen_lexical_block_die (stmt, context_die, depth);
12907    }
12908  else
12909    decls_for_scope (stmt, context_die, depth);
12910}
12911
12912/* Generate all of the decls declared within a given scope and (recursively)
12913   all of its sub-blocks.  */
12914
12915static void
12916decls_for_scope (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die, int depth)
12917{
12918  tree decl;
12919  tree subblocks;
12920
12921  /* Ignore NULL blocks.  */
12922  if (stmt == NULL_TREE)
12923    return;
12924
12925  if (TREE_USED (stmt))
12926    {
12927      /* Output the DIEs to represent all of the data objects and typedefs
12928	 declared directly within this block but not within any nested
12929	 sub-blocks.  Also, nested function and tag DIEs have been
12930	 generated with a parent of NULL; fix that up now.  */
12931      for (decl = BLOCK_VARS (stmt); decl != NULL; decl = TREE_CHAIN (decl))
12932	{
12933	  dw_die_ref die;
12934
12935	  if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL)
12936	    die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
12937	  else if (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL && TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl))
12938	    die = lookup_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl));
12939	  else
12940	    die = NULL;
12941
12942	  if (die != NULL && die->die_parent == NULL)
12943	    add_child_die (context_die, die);
12944	  /* Do not produce debug information for static variables since
12945	     these might be optimized out.  We are called for these later
12946	     in cgraph_varpool_analyze_pending_decls. */
12947	  if (TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL && TREE_STATIC (decl))
12948	    ;
12949	  else
12950	    gen_decl_die (decl, context_die);
12951	}
12952    }
12953
12954  /* If we're at -g1, we're not interested in subblocks.  */
12955  if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
12956    return;
12957
12958  /* Output the DIEs to represent all sub-blocks (and the items declared
12959     therein) of this block.  */
12960  for (subblocks = BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (stmt);
12961       subblocks != NULL;
12962       subblocks = BLOCK_CHAIN (subblocks))
12963    gen_block_die (subblocks, context_die, depth + 1);
12964}
12965
12966/* Is this a typedef we can avoid emitting?  */
12967
12968static inline int
12969is_redundant_typedef (tree decl)
12970{
12971  if (TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl))
12972    return 1;
12973
12974  if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl)
12975      && DECL_CONTEXT (decl)
12976      && is_tagged_type (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))
12977      && TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))) == TYPE_DECL
12978      && DECL_NAME (decl) == DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))))
12979    /* Also ignore the artificial member typedef for the class name.  */
12980    return 1;
12981
12982  return 0;
12983}
12984
12985/* Returns the DIE for decl.  A DIE will always be returned.  */
12986
12987static dw_die_ref
12988force_decl_die (tree decl)
12989{
12990  dw_die_ref decl_die;
12991  unsigned saved_external_flag;
12992  tree save_fn = NULL_TREE;
12993  decl_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
12994  if (!decl_die)
12995    {
12996      dw_die_ref context_die;
12997      tree decl_context = DECL_CONTEXT (decl);
12998      if (decl_context)
12999	{
13000	  /* Find die that represents this context.  */
13001	  if (TYPE_P (decl_context))
13002	    context_die = force_type_die (decl_context);
13003	  else
13004	    context_die = force_decl_die (decl_context);
13005	}
13006      else
13007	context_die = comp_unit_die;
13008
13009      decl_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
13010      if (decl_die)
13011	return decl_die;
13012
13013      switch (TREE_CODE (decl))
13014	{
13015	case FUNCTION_DECL:
13016	  /* Clear current_function_decl, so that gen_subprogram_die thinks
13017	     that this is a declaration. At this point, we just want to force
13018	     declaration die.  */
13019	  save_fn = current_function_decl;
13020	  current_function_decl = NULL_TREE;
13021	  gen_subprogram_die (decl, context_die);
13022	  current_function_decl = save_fn;
13023	  break;
13024
13025	case VAR_DECL:
13026	  /* Set external flag to force declaration die. Restore it after
13027	   gen_decl_die() call.  */
13028	  saved_external_flag = DECL_EXTERNAL (decl);
13029	  DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) = 1;
13030	  gen_decl_die (decl, context_die);
13031	  DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) = saved_external_flag;
13032	  break;
13033
13034	case NAMESPACE_DECL:
13035	  dwarf2out_decl (decl);
13036	  break;
13037
13038	default:
13039	  gcc_unreachable ();
13040	}
13041
13042      /* We should be able to find the DIE now.  */
13043      if (!decl_die)
13044	decl_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
13045      gcc_assert (decl_die);
13046    }
13047
13048  return decl_die;
13049}
13050
13051/* Returns the DIE for TYPE, that must not be a base type.  A DIE is
13052   always returned.  */
13053
13054static dw_die_ref
13055force_type_die (tree type)
13056{
13057  dw_die_ref type_die;
13058
13059  type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
13060  if (!type_die)
13061    {
13062      dw_die_ref context_die;
13063      if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type))
13064	{
13065	  if (TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)))
13066	    context_die = force_type_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
13067	  else
13068	    context_die = force_decl_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
13069	}
13070      else
13071	context_die = comp_unit_die;
13072
13073      type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
13074      if (type_die)
13075	return type_die;
13076      gen_type_die (type, context_die);
13077      type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
13078      gcc_assert (type_die);
13079    }
13080  return type_die;
13081}
13082
13083/* Force out any required namespaces to be able to output DECL,
13084   and return the new context_die for it, if it's changed.  */
13085
13086static dw_die_ref
13087setup_namespace_context (tree thing, dw_die_ref context_die)
13088{
13089  tree context = (DECL_P (thing)
13090		  ? DECL_CONTEXT (thing) : TYPE_CONTEXT (thing));
13091  if (context && TREE_CODE (context) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
13092    /* Force out the namespace.  */
13093    context_die = force_decl_die (context);
13094
13095  return context_die;
13096}
13097
13098/* Emit a declaration DIE for THING (which is either a DECL or a tagged
13099   type) within its namespace, if appropriate.
13100
13101   For compatibility with older debuggers, namespace DIEs only contain
13102   declarations; all definitions are emitted at CU scope.  */
13103
13104static void
13105declare_in_namespace (tree thing, dw_die_ref context_die)
13106{
13107  dw_die_ref ns_context;
13108
13109  if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
13110    return;
13111
13112  /* If this decl is from an inlined function, then don't try to emit it in its
13113     namespace, as we will get confused.  It would have already been emitted
13114     when the abstract instance of the inline function was emitted anyways.  */
13115  if (DECL_P (thing) && DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (thing))
13116    return;
13117
13118  ns_context = setup_namespace_context (thing, context_die);
13119
13120  if (ns_context != context_die)
13121    {
13122      if (DECL_P (thing))
13123	gen_decl_die (thing, ns_context);
13124      else
13125	gen_type_die (thing, ns_context);
13126    }
13127}
13128
13129/* Generate a DIE for a namespace or namespace alias.  */
13130
13131static void
13132gen_namespace_die (tree decl)
13133{
13134  dw_die_ref context_die = setup_namespace_context (decl, comp_unit_die);
13135
13136  /* Namespace aliases have a DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN of the namespace
13137     they are an alias of.  */
13138  if (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) == NULL)
13139    {
13140      /* Output a real namespace.  */
13141      dw_die_ref namespace_die
13142	= new_die (DW_TAG_namespace, context_die, decl);
13143      add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (namespace_die, decl);
13144      equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, namespace_die);
13145    }
13146  else
13147    {
13148      /* Output a namespace alias.  */
13149
13150      /* Force out the namespace we are an alias of, if necessary.  */
13151      dw_die_ref origin_die
13152	= force_decl_die (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl));
13153
13154      /* Now create the namespace alias DIE.  */
13155      dw_die_ref namespace_die
13156	= new_die (DW_TAG_imported_declaration, context_die, decl);
13157      add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (namespace_die, decl);
13158      add_AT_die_ref (namespace_die, DW_AT_import, origin_die);
13159      equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, namespace_die);
13160    }
13161}
13162
13163/* Generate Dwarf debug information for a decl described by DECL.  */
13164
13165static void
13166gen_decl_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
13167{
13168  tree origin;
13169
13170  if (DECL_P (decl) && DECL_IGNORED_P (decl))
13171    return;
13172
13173  switch (TREE_CODE (decl))
13174    {
13175    case ERROR_MARK:
13176      break;
13177
13178    case CONST_DECL:
13179      /* The individual enumerators of an enum type get output when we output
13180	 the Dwarf representation of the relevant enum type itself.  */
13181      break;
13182
13183    case FUNCTION_DECL:
13184      /* Don't output any DIEs to represent mere function declarations,
13185	 unless they are class members or explicit block externs.  */
13186      if (DECL_INITIAL (decl) == NULL_TREE && DECL_CONTEXT (decl) == NULL_TREE
13187	  && (current_function_decl == NULL_TREE || DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl)))
13188	break;
13189
13190#if 0
13191      /* FIXME */
13192      /* This doesn't work because the C frontend sets DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN
13193	 on local redeclarations of global functions.  That seems broken.  */
13194      if (current_function_decl != decl)
13195	/* This is only a declaration.  */;
13196#endif
13197
13198      /* If we're emitting a clone, emit info for the abstract instance.  */
13199      if (DECL_ORIGIN (decl) != decl)
13200	dwarf2out_abstract_function (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl));
13201
13202      /* If we're emitting an out-of-line copy of an inline function,
13203	 emit info for the abstract instance and set up to refer to it.  */
13204      else if (cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p (decl)
13205	       && ! DECL_ABSTRACT (decl)
13206	       && ! class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die)
13207	       /* dwarf2out_abstract_function won't emit a die if this is just
13208		  a declaration.  We must avoid setting DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN in
13209		  that case, because that works only if we have a die.  */
13210	       && DECL_INITIAL (decl) != NULL_TREE)
13211	{
13212	  dwarf2out_abstract_function (decl);
13213	  set_decl_origin_self (decl);
13214	}
13215
13216      /* Otherwise we're emitting the primary DIE for this decl.  */
13217      else if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
13218	{
13219	  /* Before we describe the FUNCTION_DECL itself, make sure that we
13220	     have described its return type.  */
13221	  gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)), context_die);
13222
13223	  /* And its virtual context.  */
13224	  if (DECL_VINDEX (decl) != NULL_TREE)
13225	    gen_type_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl), context_die);
13226
13227	  /* And its containing type.  */
13228	  origin = decl_class_context (decl);
13229	  if (origin != NULL_TREE)
13230	    gen_type_die_for_member (origin, decl, context_die);
13231
13232	  /* And its containing namespace.  */
13233	  declare_in_namespace (decl, context_die);
13234	}
13235
13236      /* Now output a DIE to represent the function itself.  */
13237      gen_subprogram_die (decl, context_die);
13238      break;
13239
13240    case TYPE_DECL:
13241      /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs to represent any
13242	 actual typedefs.  */
13243      if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
13244	break;
13245
13246      /* In the special case of a TYPE_DECL node representing the declaration
13247	 of some type tag, if the given TYPE_DECL is marked as having been
13248	 instantiated from some other (original) TYPE_DECL node (e.g. one which
13249	 was generated within the original definition of an inline function) we
13250	 have to generate a special (abbreviated) DW_TAG_structure_type,
13251	 DW_TAG_union_type, or DW_TAG_enumeration_type DIE here.  */
13252      if (TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl) && decl_ultimate_origin (decl) != NULL_TREE
13253	  && is_tagged_type (TREE_TYPE (decl)))
13254	{
13255	  gen_tagged_type_instantiation_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), context_die);
13256	  break;
13257	}
13258
13259      if (is_redundant_typedef (decl))
13260	gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), context_die);
13261      else
13262	/* Output a DIE to represent the typedef itself.  */
13263	gen_typedef_die (decl, context_die);
13264      break;
13265
13266    case LABEL_DECL:
13267      if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_NORMAL)
13268	gen_label_die (decl, context_die);
13269      break;
13270
13271    case VAR_DECL:
13272    case RESULT_DECL:
13273      /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs to represent any
13274	 variable declarations or definitions.  */
13275      if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
13276	break;
13277
13278      /* Output any DIEs that are needed to specify the type of this data
13279	 object.  */
13280      gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), context_die);
13281
13282      /* And its containing type.  */
13283      origin = decl_class_context (decl);
13284      if (origin != NULL_TREE)
13285	gen_type_die_for_member (origin, decl, context_die);
13286
13287      /* And its containing namespace.  */
13288      declare_in_namespace (decl, context_die);
13289
13290      /* Now output the DIE to represent the data object itself.  This gets
13291	 complicated because of the possibility that the VAR_DECL really
13292	 represents an inlined instance of a formal parameter for an inline
13293	 function.  */
13294      origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
13295      if (origin != NULL_TREE && TREE_CODE (origin) == PARM_DECL)
13296	gen_formal_parameter_die (decl, context_die);
13297      else
13298	gen_variable_die (decl, context_die);
13299      break;
13300
13301    case FIELD_DECL:
13302      /* Ignore the nameless fields that are used to skip bits but handle C++
13303	 anonymous unions and structs.  */
13304      if (DECL_NAME (decl) != NULL_TREE
13305	  || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == UNION_TYPE
13306	  || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == RECORD_TYPE)
13307	{
13308	  gen_type_die (member_declared_type (decl), context_die);
13309	  gen_field_die (decl, context_die);
13310	}
13311      break;
13312
13313    case PARM_DECL:
13314      gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), context_die);
13315      gen_formal_parameter_die (decl, context_die);
13316      break;
13317
13318    case NAMESPACE_DECL:
13319      gen_namespace_die (decl);
13320      break;
13321
13322    default:
13323      /* Probably some frontend-internal decl.  Assume we don't care.  */
13324      gcc_assert ((int)TREE_CODE (decl) > NUM_TREE_CODES);
13325      break;
13326    }
13327}
13328
13329/* Output debug information for global decl DECL.  Called from toplev.c after
13330   compilation proper has finished.  */
13331
13332static void
13333dwarf2out_global_decl (tree decl)
13334{
13335  /* Output DWARF2 information for file-scope tentative data object
13336     declarations, file-scope (extern) function declarations (which had no
13337     corresponding body) and file-scope tagged type declarations and
13338     definitions which have not yet been forced out.  */
13339  if (TREE_CODE (decl) != FUNCTION_DECL || !DECL_INITIAL (decl))
13340    dwarf2out_decl (decl);
13341}
13342
13343/* Output debug information for type decl DECL.  Called from toplev.c
13344   and from language front ends (to record built-in types).  */
13345static void
13346dwarf2out_type_decl (tree decl, int local)
13347{
13348  if (!local)
13349    dwarf2out_decl (decl);
13350}
13351
13352/* Output debug information for imported module or decl.  */
13353
13354static void
13355dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl (tree decl, tree context)
13356{
13357  dw_die_ref imported_die, at_import_die;
13358  dw_die_ref scope_die;
13359  expanded_location xloc;
13360
13361  if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
13362    return;
13363
13364  gcc_assert (decl);
13365
13366  /* To emit DW_TAG_imported_module or DW_TAG_imported_decl, we need two DIEs.
13367     We need decl DIE for reference and scope die. First, get DIE for the decl
13368     itself.  */
13369
13370  /* Get the scope die for decl context. Use comp_unit_die for global module
13371     or decl. If die is not found for non globals, force new die.  */
13372  if (!context)
13373    scope_die = comp_unit_die;
13374  else if (TYPE_P (context))
13375    {
13376      if (!should_emit_struct_debug (context, DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE))
13377	return;
13378    scope_die = force_type_die (context);
13379    }
13380  else
13381    scope_die = force_decl_die (context);
13382
13383  /* For TYPE_DECL or CONST_DECL, lookup TREE_TYPE.  */
13384  if (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL || TREE_CODE (decl) == CONST_DECL)
13385    {
13386      if (is_base_type (TREE_TYPE (decl)))
13387	at_import_die = base_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl));
13388      else
13389	at_import_die = force_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl));
13390    }
13391  else
13392    {
13393      at_import_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
13394      if (!at_import_die)
13395	{
13396	  /* If we're trying to avoid duplicate debug info, we may not have
13397	     emitted the member decl for this field.  Emit it now.  */
13398	  if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL)
13399	    {
13400	      tree type = DECL_CONTEXT (decl);
13401	      dw_die_ref type_context_die;
13402
13403	      if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type))
13404		if (TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)))
13405		  {
13406		    if (!should_emit_struct_debug (TYPE_CONTEXT (type),
13407						   DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE))
13408		      return;
13409		  type_context_die = force_type_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
13410		  }
13411	      else
13412		type_context_die = force_decl_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
13413	      else
13414		type_context_die = comp_unit_die;
13415	      gen_type_die_for_member (type, decl, type_context_die);
13416	    }
13417	  at_import_die = force_decl_die (decl);
13418	}
13419    }
13420
13421  /* OK, now we have DIEs for decl as well as scope. Emit imported die.  */
13422  if (TREE_CODE (decl) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
13423    imported_die = new_die (DW_TAG_imported_module, scope_die, context);
13424  else
13425    imported_die = new_die (DW_TAG_imported_declaration, scope_die, context);
13426
13427  xloc = expand_location (input_location);
13428  add_AT_file (imported_die, DW_AT_decl_file, lookup_filename (xloc.file));
13429  add_AT_unsigned (imported_die, DW_AT_decl_line, xloc.line);
13430  add_AT_die_ref (imported_die, DW_AT_import, at_import_die);
13431}
13432
13433/* Write the debugging output for DECL.  */
13434
13435void
13436dwarf2out_decl (tree decl)
13437{
13438  dw_die_ref context_die = comp_unit_die;
13439
13440  switch (TREE_CODE (decl))
13441    {
13442    case ERROR_MARK:
13443      return;
13444
13445    case FUNCTION_DECL:
13446      /* What we would really like to do here is to filter out all mere
13447	 file-scope declarations of file-scope functions which are never
13448	 referenced later within this translation unit (and keep all of ones
13449	 that *are* referenced later on) but we aren't clairvoyant, so we have
13450	 no idea which functions will be referenced in the future (i.e. later
13451	 on within the current translation unit). So here we just ignore all
13452	 file-scope function declarations which are not also definitions.  If
13453	 and when the debugger needs to know something about these functions,
13454	 it will have to hunt around and find the DWARF information associated
13455	 with the definition of the function.
13456
13457	 We can't just check DECL_EXTERNAL to find out which FUNCTION_DECL
13458	 nodes represent definitions and which ones represent mere
13459	 declarations.  We have to check DECL_INITIAL instead. That's because
13460	 the C front-end supports some weird semantics for "extern inline"
13461	 function definitions.  These can get inlined within the current
13462	 translation unit (and thus, we need to generate Dwarf info for their
13463	 abstract instances so that the Dwarf info for the concrete inlined
13464	 instances can have something to refer to) but the compiler never
13465	 generates any out-of-lines instances of such things (despite the fact
13466	 that they *are* definitions).
13467
13468	 The important point is that the C front-end marks these "extern
13469	 inline" functions as DECL_EXTERNAL, but we need to generate DWARF for
13470	 them anyway. Note that the C++ front-end also plays some similar games
13471	 for inline function definitions appearing within include files which
13472	 also contain `#pragma interface' pragmas.  */
13473      if (DECL_INITIAL (decl) == NULL_TREE)
13474	return;
13475
13476      /* If we're a nested function, initially use a parent of NULL; if we're
13477	 a plain function, this will be fixed up in decls_for_scope.  If
13478	 we're a method, it will be ignored, since we already have a DIE.  */
13479      if (decl_function_context (decl)
13480	  /* But if we're in terse mode, we don't care about scope.  */
13481	  && debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
13482	context_die = NULL;
13483      break;
13484
13485    case VAR_DECL:
13486      /* Ignore this VAR_DECL if it refers to a file-scope extern data object
13487	 declaration and if the declaration was never even referenced from
13488	 within this entire compilation unit.  We suppress these DIEs in
13489	 order to save space in the .debug section (by eliminating entries
13490	 which are probably useless).  Note that we must not suppress
13491	 block-local extern declarations (whether used or not) because that
13492	 would screw-up the debugger's name lookup mechanism and cause it to
13493	 miss things which really ought to be in scope at a given point.  */
13494      if (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) && !TREE_USED (decl))
13495	return;
13496
13497      /* For local statics lookup proper context die.  */
13498      if (TREE_STATIC (decl) && decl_function_context (decl))
13499	context_die = lookup_decl_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl));
13500
13501      /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs to represent any
13502	 variable declarations or definitions.  */
13503      if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
13504	return;
13505      break;
13506
13507    case NAMESPACE_DECL:
13508      if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
13509	return;
13510      if (lookup_decl_die (decl) != NULL)
13511        return;
13512      break;
13513
13514    case TYPE_DECL:
13515      /* Don't emit stubs for types unless they are needed by other DIEs.  */
13516      if (TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG (decl))
13517	return;
13518
13519      /* Don't bother trying to generate any DIEs to represent any of the
13520	 normal built-in types for the language we are compiling.  */
13521      if (DECL_IS_BUILTIN (decl))
13522	{
13523	  /* OK, we need to generate one for `bool' so GDB knows what type
13524	     comparisons have.  */
13525	  if (is_cxx ()
13526	      && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == BOOLEAN_TYPE
13527	      && ! DECL_IGNORED_P (decl))
13528	    modified_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), 0, 0, NULL);
13529
13530	  return;
13531	}
13532
13533      /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs for types.  */
13534      if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
13535	return;
13536
13537      /* If we're a function-scope tag, initially use a parent of NULL;
13538	 this will be fixed up in decls_for_scope.  */
13539      if (decl_function_context (decl))
13540	context_die = NULL;
13541
13542      break;
13543
13544    default:
13545      return;
13546    }
13547
13548  gen_decl_die (decl, context_die);
13549}
13550
13551/* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the beginning of the generated code for
13552   a lexical block.  */
13553
13554static void
13555dwarf2out_begin_block (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
13556		       unsigned int blocknum)
13557{
13558  switch_to_section (current_function_section ());
13559  ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL, blocknum);
13560}
13561
13562/* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the end of the generated code for a
13563   lexical block.  */
13564
13565static void
13566dwarf2out_end_block (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, unsigned int blocknum)
13567{
13568  switch_to_section (current_function_section ());
13569  ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, BLOCK_END_LABEL, blocknum);
13570}
13571
13572/* Returns nonzero if it is appropriate not to emit any debugging
13573   information for BLOCK, because it doesn't contain any instructions.
13574
13575   Don't allow this for blocks with nested functions or local classes
13576   as we would end up with orphans, and in the presence of scheduling
13577   we may end up calling them anyway.  */
13578
13579static bool
13580dwarf2out_ignore_block (tree block)
13581{
13582  tree decl;
13583
13584  for (decl = BLOCK_VARS (block); decl; decl = TREE_CHAIN (decl))
13585    if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL
13586	|| (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL && TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl)))
13587      return 0;
13588
13589  return 1;
13590}
13591
13592/* Hash table routines for file_hash.  */
13593
13594static int
13595file_table_eq (const void *p1_p, const void *p2_p)
13596{
13597  const struct dwarf_file_data * p1 = p1_p;
13598  const char * p2 = p2_p;
13599  return strcmp (p1->filename, p2) == 0;
13600}
13601
13602static hashval_t
13603file_table_hash (const void *p_p)
13604{
13605  const struct dwarf_file_data * p = p_p;
13606  return htab_hash_string (p->filename);
13607}
13608
13609/* Lookup FILE_NAME (in the list of filenames that we know about here in
13610   dwarf2out.c) and return its "index".  The index of each (known) filename is
13611   just a unique number which is associated with only that one filename.  We
13612   need such numbers for the sake of generating labels (in the .debug_sfnames
13613   section) and references to those files numbers (in the .debug_srcinfo
13614   and.debug_macinfo sections).  If the filename given as an argument is not
13615   found in our current list, add it to the list and assign it the next
13616   available unique index number.  In order to speed up searches, we remember
13617   the index of the filename was looked up last.  This handles the majority of
13618   all searches.  */
13619
13620static struct dwarf_file_data *
13621lookup_filename (const char *file_name)
13622{
13623  void ** slot;
13624  struct dwarf_file_data * created;
13625
13626  /* Check to see if the file name that was searched on the previous
13627     call matches this file name.  If so, return the index.  */
13628  if (file_table_last_lookup
13629      && (file_name == file_table_last_lookup->filename
13630	  || strcmp (file_table_last_lookup->filename, file_name) == 0))
13631    return file_table_last_lookup;
13632
13633  /* Didn't match the previous lookup, search the table.  */
13634  slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (file_table, file_name,
13635				   htab_hash_string (file_name), INSERT);
13636  if (*slot)
13637    return *slot;
13638
13639  created = ggc_alloc (sizeof (struct dwarf_file_data));
13640  created->filename = file_name;
13641  created->emitted_number = 0;
13642  *slot = created;
13643  return created;
13644}
13645
13646/* If the assembler will construct the file table, then translate the compiler
13647   internal file table number into the assembler file table number, and emit
13648   a .file directive if we haven't already emitted one yet.  The file table
13649   numbers are different because we prune debug info for unused variables and
13650   types, which may include filenames.  */
13651
13652static int
13653maybe_emit_file (struct dwarf_file_data * fd)
13654{
13655  if (! fd->emitted_number)
13656    {
13657      if (last_emitted_file)
13658	fd->emitted_number = last_emitted_file->emitted_number + 1;
13659      else
13660	fd->emitted_number = 1;
13661      last_emitted_file = fd;
13662
13663      if (DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
13664	{
13665	  fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.file %u ", fd->emitted_number);
13666	  output_quoted_string (asm_out_file, fd->filename);
13667	  fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
13668	}
13669    }
13670
13671  return fd->emitted_number;
13672}
13673
13674/* Called by the final INSN scan whenever we see a var location.  We
13675   use it to drop labels in the right places, and throw the location in
13676   our lookup table.  */
13677
13678static void
13679dwarf2out_var_location (rtx loc_note)
13680{
13681  char loclabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
13682  struct var_loc_node *newloc;
13683  rtx prev_insn;
13684  static rtx last_insn;
13685  static const char *last_label;
13686  tree decl;
13687
13688  if (!DECL_P (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_DECL (loc_note)))
13689    return;
13690  prev_insn = PREV_INSN (loc_note);
13691
13692  newloc = ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (struct var_loc_node));
13693  /* If the insn we processed last time is the previous insn
13694     and it is also a var location note, use the label we emitted
13695     last time.  */
13696  if (last_insn != NULL_RTX
13697      && last_insn == prev_insn
13698      && NOTE_P (prev_insn)
13699      && NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (prev_insn) == NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION)
13700    {
13701      newloc->label = last_label;
13702    }
13703  else
13704    {
13705      ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (loclabel, "LVL", loclabel_num);
13706      ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, "LVL", loclabel_num);
13707      loclabel_num++;
13708      newloc->label = ggc_strdup (loclabel);
13709    }
13710  newloc->var_loc_note = loc_note;
13711  newloc->next = NULL;
13712
13713  if (cfun && in_cold_section_p)
13714    newloc->section_label = cfun->cold_section_label;
13715  else
13716    newloc->section_label = text_section_label;
13717
13718  last_insn = loc_note;
13719  last_label = newloc->label;
13720  decl = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_DECL (loc_note);
13721  add_var_loc_to_decl (decl, newloc);
13722}
13723
13724/* We need to reset the locations at the beginning of each
13725   function. We can't do this in the end_function hook, because the
13726   declarations that use the locations won't have been output when
13727   that hook is called.  Also compute have_multiple_function_sections here.  */
13728
13729static void
13730dwarf2out_begin_function (tree fun)
13731{
13732  htab_empty (decl_loc_table);
13733
13734  if (function_section (fun) != text_section)
13735    have_multiple_function_sections = true;
13736}
13737
13738/* Output a label to mark the beginning of a source code line entry
13739   and record information relating to this source line, in
13740   'line_info_table' for later output of the .debug_line section.  */
13741
13742static void
13743dwarf2out_source_line (unsigned int line, const char *filename)
13744{
13745  if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_NORMAL
13746      && line != 0)
13747    {
13748      int file_num = maybe_emit_file (lookup_filename (filename));
13749
13750      switch_to_section (current_function_section ());
13751
13752      /* If requested, emit something human-readable.  */
13753      if (flag_debug_asm)
13754	fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t%s %s:%d\n", ASM_COMMENT_START,
13755		 filename, line);
13756
13757      if (DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
13758	{
13759	  /* Emit the .loc directive understood by GNU as.  */
13760	  fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.loc %d %d 0\n", file_num, line);
13761
13762	  /* Indicate that line number info exists.  */
13763	  line_info_table_in_use++;
13764	}
13765      else if (function_section (current_function_decl) != text_section)
13766	{
13767	  dw_separate_line_info_ref line_info;
13768	  targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file,
13769					  SEPARATE_LINE_CODE_LABEL,
13770					  separate_line_info_table_in_use);
13771
13772	  /* Expand the line info table if necessary.  */
13773	  if (separate_line_info_table_in_use
13774	      == separate_line_info_table_allocated)
13775	    {
13776	      separate_line_info_table_allocated += LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT;
13777	      separate_line_info_table
13778		= ggc_realloc (separate_line_info_table,
13779			       separate_line_info_table_allocated
13780			       * sizeof (dw_separate_line_info_entry));
13781	      memset (separate_line_info_table
13782		       + separate_line_info_table_in_use,
13783		      0,
13784		      (LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT
13785		       * sizeof (dw_separate_line_info_entry)));
13786	    }
13787
13788	  /* Add the new entry at the end of the line_info_table.  */
13789	  line_info
13790	    = &separate_line_info_table[separate_line_info_table_in_use++];
13791	  line_info->dw_file_num = file_num;
13792	  line_info->dw_line_num = line;
13793	  line_info->function = current_function_funcdef_no;
13794	}
13795      else
13796	{
13797	  dw_line_info_ref line_info;
13798
13799	  targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, LINE_CODE_LABEL,
13800				     line_info_table_in_use);
13801
13802	  /* Expand the line info table if necessary.  */
13803	  if (line_info_table_in_use == line_info_table_allocated)
13804	    {
13805	      line_info_table_allocated += LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT;
13806	      line_info_table
13807		= ggc_realloc (line_info_table,
13808			       (line_info_table_allocated
13809				* sizeof (dw_line_info_entry)));
13810	      memset (line_info_table + line_info_table_in_use, 0,
13811		      LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT * sizeof (dw_line_info_entry));
13812	    }
13813
13814	  /* Add the new entry at the end of the line_info_table.  */
13815	  line_info = &line_info_table[line_info_table_in_use++];
13816	  line_info->dw_file_num = file_num;
13817	  line_info->dw_line_num = line;
13818	}
13819    }
13820}
13821
13822/* Record the beginning of a new source file.  */
13823
13824static void
13825dwarf2out_start_source_file (unsigned int lineno, const char *filename)
13826{
13827  if (flag_eliminate_dwarf2_dups)
13828    {
13829      /* Record the beginning of the file for break_out_includes.  */
13830      dw_die_ref bincl_die;
13831
13832      bincl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL, comp_unit_die, NULL);
13833      add_AT_string (bincl_die, DW_AT_name, filename);
13834    }
13835
13836  if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
13837    {
13838      int file_num = maybe_emit_file (lookup_filename (filename));
13839
13840      switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section);
13841      dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_start_file, "Start new file");
13842      dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (lineno, "Included from line number %d",
13843				   lineno);
13844
13845      dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (file_num, "file %s", filename);
13846    }
13847}
13848
13849/* Record the end of a source file.  */
13850
13851static void
13852dwarf2out_end_source_file (unsigned int lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
13853{
13854  if (flag_eliminate_dwarf2_dups)
13855    /* Record the end of the file for break_out_includes.  */
13856    new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL, comp_unit_die, NULL);
13857
13858  if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
13859    {
13860      switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section);
13861      dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_end_file, "End file");
13862    }
13863}
13864
13865/* Called from debug_define in toplev.c.  The `buffer' parameter contains
13866   the tail part of the directive line, i.e. the part which is past the
13867   initial whitespace, #, whitespace, directive-name, whitespace part.  */
13868
13869static void
13870dwarf2out_define (unsigned int lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
13871		  const char *buffer ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
13872{
13873  if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
13874    {
13875      switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section);
13876      dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_define, "Define macro");
13877      dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (lineno, "At line number %d", lineno);
13878      dw2_asm_output_nstring (buffer, -1, "The macro");
13879    }
13880}
13881
13882/* Called from debug_undef in toplev.c.  The `buffer' parameter contains
13883   the tail part of the directive line, i.e. the part which is past the
13884   initial whitespace, #, whitespace, directive-name, whitespace part.  */
13885
13886static void
13887dwarf2out_undef (unsigned int lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
13888		 const char *buffer ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
13889{
13890  if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
13891    {
13892      switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section);
13893      dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_undef, "Undefine macro");
13894      dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (lineno, "At line number %d", lineno);
13895      dw2_asm_output_nstring (buffer, -1, "The macro");
13896    }
13897}
13898
13899/* Set up for Dwarf output at the start of compilation.  */
13900
13901static void
13902dwarf2out_init (const char *filename ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
13903{
13904  /* Allocate the file_table.  */
13905  file_table = htab_create_ggc (50, file_table_hash,
13906				file_table_eq, NULL);
13907
13908  /* Allocate the decl_die_table.  */
13909  decl_die_table = htab_create_ggc (10, decl_die_table_hash,
13910				    decl_die_table_eq, NULL);
13911
13912  /* Allocate the decl_loc_table.  */
13913  decl_loc_table = htab_create_ggc (10, decl_loc_table_hash,
13914				    decl_loc_table_eq, NULL);
13915
13916  /* Allocate the initial hunk of the decl_scope_table.  */
13917  decl_scope_table = VEC_alloc (tree, gc, 256);
13918
13919  /* Allocate the initial hunk of the abbrev_die_table.  */
13920  abbrev_die_table = ggc_alloc_cleared (ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT
13921					* sizeof (dw_die_ref));
13922  abbrev_die_table_allocated = ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
13923  /* Zero-th entry is allocated, but unused.  */
13924  abbrev_die_table_in_use = 1;
13925
13926  /* Allocate the initial hunk of the line_info_table.  */
13927  line_info_table = ggc_alloc_cleared (LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT
13928				       * sizeof (dw_line_info_entry));
13929  line_info_table_allocated = LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT;
13930
13931  /* Zero-th entry is allocated, but unused.  */
13932  line_info_table_in_use = 1;
13933
13934  /* Generate the initial DIE for the .debug section.  Note that the (string)
13935     value given in the DW_AT_name attribute of the DW_TAG_compile_unit DIE
13936     will (typically) be a relative pathname and that this pathname should be
13937     taken as being relative to the directory from which the compiler was
13938     invoked when the given (base) source file was compiled.  We will fill
13939     in this value in dwarf2out_finish.  */
13940  comp_unit_die = gen_compile_unit_die (NULL);
13941
13942  incomplete_types = VEC_alloc (tree, gc, 64);
13943
13944  used_rtx_array = VEC_alloc (rtx, gc, 32);
13945
13946  debug_info_section = get_section (DEBUG_INFO_SECTION,
13947				    SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
13948  debug_abbrev_section = get_section (DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION,
13949				      SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
13950  debug_aranges_section = get_section (DEBUG_ARANGES_SECTION,
13951				       SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
13952  debug_macinfo_section = get_section (DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION,
13953				       SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
13954  debug_line_section = get_section (DEBUG_LINE_SECTION,
13955				    SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
13956  debug_loc_section = get_section (DEBUG_LOC_SECTION,
13957				   SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
13958  debug_pubnames_section = get_section (DEBUG_PUBNAMES_SECTION,
13959					SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
13960  debug_str_section = get_section (DEBUG_STR_SECTION,
13961				   DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS, NULL);
13962  debug_ranges_section = get_section (DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION,
13963				      SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
13964  debug_frame_section = get_section (DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION,
13965				     SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
13966
13967  ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (text_end_label, TEXT_END_LABEL, 0);
13968  ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (abbrev_section_label,
13969			       DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
13970  ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (text_section_label, TEXT_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
13971  ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (cold_text_section_label,
13972			       COLD_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
13973  ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (cold_end_label, COLD_END_LABEL, 0);
13974
13975  ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_info_section_label,
13976			       DEBUG_INFO_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
13977  ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_line_section_label,
13978			       DEBUG_LINE_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
13979  ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (ranges_section_label,
13980			       DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
13981  switch_to_section (debug_abbrev_section);
13982  ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, abbrev_section_label);
13983  switch_to_section (debug_info_section);
13984  ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, debug_info_section_label);
13985  switch_to_section (debug_line_section);
13986  ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, debug_line_section_label);
13987
13988  if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
13989    {
13990      switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section);
13991      ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (macinfo_section_label,
13992				   DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
13993      ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, macinfo_section_label);
13994    }
13995
13996  switch_to_section (text_section);
13997  ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, text_section_label);
13998  if (flag_reorder_blocks_and_partition)
13999    {
14000      switch_to_section (unlikely_text_section ());
14001      ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, cold_text_section_label);
14002    }
14003}
14004
14005/* A helper function for dwarf2out_finish called through
14006   ht_forall.  Emit one queued .debug_str string.  */
14007
14008static int
14009output_indirect_string (void **h, void *v ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
14010{
14011  struct indirect_string_node *node = (struct indirect_string_node *) *h;
14012
14013  if (node->form == DW_FORM_strp)
14014    {
14015      switch_to_section (debug_str_section);
14016      ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, node->label);
14017      assemble_string (node->str, strlen (node->str) + 1);
14018    }
14019
14020  return 1;
14021}
14022
14023#if ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING
14024/* Verify that all marks are clear.  */
14025
14026static void
14027verify_marks_clear (dw_die_ref die)
14028{
14029  dw_die_ref c;
14030
14031  gcc_assert (! die->die_mark);
14032  FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, verify_marks_clear (c));
14033}
14034#endif /* ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING */
14035
14036/* Clear the marks for a die and its children.
14037   Be cool if the mark isn't set.  */
14038
14039static void
14040prune_unmark_dies (dw_die_ref die)
14041{
14042  dw_die_ref c;
14043
14044  if (die->die_mark)
14045    die->die_mark = 0;
14046  FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unmark_dies (c));
14047}
14048
14049/* Given DIE that we're marking as used, find any other dies
14050   it references as attributes and mark them as used.  */
14051
14052static void
14053prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (dw_die_ref die)
14054{
14055  dw_attr_ref a;
14056  unsigned ix;
14057
14058  for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
14059    {
14060      if (a->dw_attr_val.val_class == dw_val_class_die_ref)
14061	{
14062	  /* A reference to another DIE.
14063	     Make sure that it will get emitted.  */
14064	  prune_unused_types_mark (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die, 1);
14065	}
14066      /* Set the string's refcount to 0 so that prune_unused_types_mark
14067	 accounts properly for it.  */
14068      if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str)
14069	a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->refcount = 0;
14070    }
14071}
14072
14073
14074/* Mark DIE as being used.  If DOKIDS is true, then walk down
14075   to DIE's children.  */
14076
14077static void
14078prune_unused_types_mark (dw_die_ref die, int dokids)
14079{
14080  dw_die_ref c;
14081
14082  if (die->die_mark == 0)
14083    {
14084      /* We haven't done this node yet.  Mark it as used.  */
14085      die->die_mark = 1;
14086
14087      /* We also have to mark its parents as used.
14088	 (But we don't want to mark our parents' kids due to this.)  */
14089      if (die->die_parent)
14090	prune_unused_types_mark (die->die_parent, 0);
14091
14092      /* Mark any referenced nodes.  */
14093      prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (die);
14094
14095      /* If this node is a specification,
14096         also mark the definition, if it exists.  */
14097      if (get_AT_flag (die, DW_AT_declaration) && die->die_definition)
14098        prune_unused_types_mark (die->die_definition, 1);
14099    }
14100
14101  if (dokids && die->die_mark != 2)
14102    {
14103      /* We need to walk the children, but haven't done so yet.
14104	 Remember that we've walked the kids.  */
14105      die->die_mark = 2;
14106
14107      /* If this is an array type, we need to make sure our
14108	 kids get marked, even if they're types.  */
14109      if (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_array_type)
14110	FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unused_types_mark (c, 1));
14111      else
14112	FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unused_types_walk (c));
14113    }
14114}
14115
14116
14117/* Walk the tree DIE and mark types that we actually use.  */
14118
14119static void
14120prune_unused_types_walk (dw_die_ref die)
14121{
14122  dw_die_ref c;
14123
14124  /* Don't do anything if this node is already marked.  */
14125  if (die->die_mark)
14126    return;
14127
14128  switch (die->die_tag) {
14129  case DW_TAG_const_type:
14130  case DW_TAG_packed_type:
14131  case DW_TAG_pointer_type:
14132  case DW_TAG_reference_type:
14133  case DW_TAG_volatile_type:
14134  case DW_TAG_typedef:
14135  case DW_TAG_array_type:
14136  case DW_TAG_structure_type:
14137  case DW_TAG_union_type:
14138  case DW_TAG_class_type:
14139  case DW_TAG_friend:
14140  case DW_TAG_variant_part:
14141  case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
14142  case DW_TAG_subroutine_type:
14143  case DW_TAG_string_type:
14144  case DW_TAG_set_type:
14145  case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
14146  case DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type:
14147  case DW_TAG_file_type:
14148    if (die->die_perennial_p)
14149      break;
14150
14151    /* It's a type node --- don't mark it.  */
14152    return;
14153
14154  default:
14155    /* Mark everything else.  */
14156    break;
14157  }
14158
14159  die->die_mark = 1;
14160
14161  /* Now, mark any dies referenced from here.  */
14162  prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (die);
14163
14164  /* Mark children.  */
14165  FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unused_types_walk (c));
14166}
14167
14168/* Increment the string counts on strings referred to from DIE's
14169   attributes.  */
14170
14171static void
14172prune_unused_types_update_strings (dw_die_ref die)
14173{
14174  dw_attr_ref a;
14175  unsigned ix;
14176
14177  for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
14178    if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str)
14179      {
14180	struct indirect_string_node *s = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str;
14181	s->refcount++;
14182	/* Avoid unnecessarily putting strings that are used less than
14183	   twice in the hash table.  */
14184	if (s->refcount
14185	    == ((DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS & SECTION_MERGE) ? 1 : 2))
14186	  {
14187	    void ** slot;
14188	    slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (debug_str_hash, s->str,
14189					     htab_hash_string (s->str),
14190					     INSERT);
14191	    gcc_assert (*slot == NULL);
14192	    *slot = s;
14193	  }
14194      }
14195}
14196
14197/* Remove from the tree DIE any dies that aren't marked.  */
14198
14199static void
14200prune_unused_types_prune (dw_die_ref die)
14201{
14202  dw_die_ref c;
14203
14204  gcc_assert (die->die_mark);
14205  prune_unused_types_update_strings (die);
14206
14207  if (! die->die_child)
14208    return;
14209
14210  c = die->die_child;
14211  do {
14212    dw_die_ref prev = c;
14213    for (c = c->die_sib; ! c->die_mark; c = c->die_sib)
14214      if (c == die->die_child)
14215	{
14216	  /* No marked children between 'prev' and the end of the list.  */
14217	  if (prev == c)
14218	    /* No marked children at all.  */
14219	    die->die_child = NULL;
14220	  else
14221	    {
14222	      prev->die_sib = c->die_sib;
14223	      die->die_child = prev;
14224	    }
14225	  return;
14226	}
14227
14228    if (c != prev->die_sib)
14229      prev->die_sib = c;
14230    prune_unused_types_prune (c);
14231  } while (c != die->die_child);
14232}
14233
14234
14235/* Remove dies representing declarations that we never use.  */
14236
14237static void
14238prune_unused_types (void)
14239{
14240  unsigned int i;
14241  limbo_die_node *node;
14242
14243#if ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING
14244  /* All the marks should already be clear.  */
14245  verify_marks_clear (comp_unit_die);
14246  for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
14247    verify_marks_clear (node->die);
14248#endif /* ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING */
14249
14250  /* Set the mark on nodes that are actually used.  */
14251  prune_unused_types_walk (comp_unit_die);
14252  for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
14253    prune_unused_types_walk (node->die);
14254
14255  /* Also set the mark on nodes referenced from the
14256     pubname_table or arange_table.  */
14257  for (i = 0; i < pubname_table_in_use; i++)
14258    prune_unused_types_mark (pubname_table[i].die, 1);
14259  for (i = 0; i < arange_table_in_use; i++)
14260    prune_unused_types_mark (arange_table[i], 1);
14261
14262  /* Get rid of nodes that aren't marked; and update the string counts.  */
14263  if (debug_str_hash)
14264    htab_empty (debug_str_hash);
14265  prune_unused_types_prune (comp_unit_die);
14266  for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
14267    prune_unused_types_prune (node->die);
14268
14269  /* Leave the marks clear.  */
14270  prune_unmark_dies (comp_unit_die);
14271  for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
14272    prune_unmark_dies (node->die);
14273}
14274
14275/* Set the parameter to true if there are any relative pathnames in
14276   the file table.  */
14277static int
14278file_table_relative_p (void ** slot, void *param)
14279{
14280  bool *p = param;
14281  struct dwarf_file_data *d = *slot;
14282  if (d->emitted_number && d->filename[0] != DIR_SEPARATOR)
14283    {
14284      *p = true;
14285      return 0;
14286    }
14287  return 1;
14288}
14289
14290/* Output stuff that dwarf requires at the end of every file,
14291   and generate the DWARF-2 debugging info.  */
14292
14293static void
14294dwarf2out_finish (const char *filename)
14295{
14296  limbo_die_node *node, *next_node;
14297  dw_die_ref die = 0;
14298
14299  /* Add the name for the main input file now.  We delayed this from
14300     dwarf2out_init to avoid complications with PCH.  */
14301  add_name_attribute (comp_unit_die, filename);
14302  if (filename[0] != DIR_SEPARATOR)
14303    add_comp_dir_attribute (comp_unit_die);
14304  else if (get_AT (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_comp_dir) == NULL)
14305    {
14306      bool p = false;
14307      htab_traverse (file_table, file_table_relative_p, &p);
14308      if (p)
14309	add_comp_dir_attribute (comp_unit_die);
14310    }
14311
14312  /* Traverse the limbo die list, and add parent/child links.  The only
14313     dies without parents that should be here are concrete instances of
14314     inline functions, and the comp_unit_die.  We can ignore the comp_unit_die.
14315     For concrete instances, we can get the parent die from the abstract
14316     instance.  */
14317  for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = next_node)
14318    {
14319      next_node = node->next;
14320      die = node->die;
14321
14322      if (die->die_parent == NULL)
14323	{
14324	  dw_die_ref origin = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin);
14325
14326	  if (origin)
14327	    add_child_die (origin->die_parent, die);
14328	  else if (die == comp_unit_die)
14329	    ;
14330	  else if (errorcount > 0 || sorrycount > 0)
14331	    /* It's OK to be confused by errors in the input.  */
14332	    add_child_die (comp_unit_die, die);
14333	  else
14334	    {
14335	      /* In certain situations, the lexical block containing a
14336		 nested function can be optimized away, which results
14337		 in the nested function die being orphaned.  Likewise
14338		 with the return type of that nested function.  Force
14339		 this to be a child of the containing function.
14340
14341		 It may happen that even the containing function got fully
14342		 inlined and optimized out.  In that case we are lost and
14343		 assign the empty child.  This should not be big issue as
14344		 the function is likely unreachable too.  */
14345	      tree context = NULL_TREE;
14346
14347	      gcc_assert (node->created_for);
14348
14349	      if (DECL_P (node->created_for))
14350		context = DECL_CONTEXT (node->created_for);
14351	      else if (TYPE_P (node->created_for))
14352		context = TYPE_CONTEXT (node->created_for);
14353
14354	      gcc_assert (context
14355			  && (TREE_CODE (context) == FUNCTION_DECL
14356			      || TREE_CODE (context) == NAMESPACE_DECL));
14357
14358	      origin = lookup_decl_die (context);
14359	      if (origin)
14360	        add_child_die (origin, die);
14361	      else
14362	        add_child_die (comp_unit_die, die);
14363	    }
14364	}
14365    }
14366
14367  limbo_die_list = NULL;
14368
14369  /* Walk through the list of incomplete types again, trying once more to
14370     emit full debugging info for them.  */
14371  retry_incomplete_types ();
14372
14373  if (flag_eliminate_unused_debug_types)
14374    prune_unused_types ();
14375
14376  /* Generate separate CUs for each of the include files we've seen.
14377     They will go into limbo_die_list.  */
14378  if (flag_eliminate_dwarf2_dups)
14379    break_out_includes (comp_unit_die);
14380
14381  /* Traverse the DIE's and add add sibling attributes to those DIE's
14382     that have children.  */
14383  add_sibling_attributes (comp_unit_die);
14384  for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
14385    add_sibling_attributes (node->die);
14386
14387  /* Output a terminator label for the .text section.  */
14388  switch_to_section (text_section);
14389  targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, TEXT_END_LABEL, 0);
14390  if (flag_reorder_blocks_and_partition)
14391    {
14392      switch_to_section (unlikely_text_section ());
14393      targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, COLD_END_LABEL, 0);
14394    }
14395
14396  /* We can only use the low/high_pc attributes if all of the code was
14397     in .text.  */
14398  if (!have_multiple_function_sections)
14399    {
14400      add_AT_lbl_id (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_low_pc, text_section_label);
14401      add_AT_lbl_id (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_high_pc, text_end_label);
14402    }
14403
14404  /* If it wasn't, we need to give .debug_loc and .debug_ranges an appropriate
14405     "base address".  Use zero so that these addresses become absolute.  */
14406  else if (have_location_lists || ranges_table_in_use)
14407    add_AT_addr (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_entry_pc, const0_rtx);
14408
14409  /* Output location list section if necessary.  */
14410  if (have_location_lists)
14411    {
14412      /* Output the location lists info.  */
14413      switch_to_section (debug_loc_section);
14414      ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (loc_section_label,
14415				   DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
14416      ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, loc_section_label);
14417      output_location_lists (die);
14418    }
14419
14420  if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_NORMAL)
14421    add_AT_lineptr (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_stmt_list,
14422		    debug_line_section_label);
14423
14424  if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
14425    add_AT_macptr (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_macro_info, macinfo_section_label);
14426
14427  /* Output all of the compilation units.  We put the main one last so that
14428     the offsets are available to output_pubnames.  */
14429  for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
14430    output_comp_unit (node->die, 0);
14431
14432  output_comp_unit (comp_unit_die, 0);
14433
14434  /* Output the abbreviation table.  */
14435  switch_to_section (debug_abbrev_section);
14436  output_abbrev_section ();
14437
14438  /* Output public names table if necessary.  */
14439  if (pubname_table_in_use)
14440    {
14441      switch_to_section (debug_pubnames_section);
14442      output_pubnames ();
14443    }
14444
14445  /* Output the address range information.  We only put functions in the arange
14446     table, so don't write it out if we don't have any.  */
14447  if (fde_table_in_use)
14448    {
14449      switch_to_section (debug_aranges_section);
14450      output_aranges ();
14451    }
14452
14453  /* Output ranges section if necessary.  */
14454  if (ranges_table_in_use)
14455    {
14456      switch_to_section (debug_ranges_section);
14457      ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, ranges_section_label);
14458      output_ranges ();
14459    }
14460
14461  /* Output the source line correspondence table.  We must do this
14462     even if there is no line information.  Otherwise, on an empty
14463     translation unit, we will generate a present, but empty,
14464     .debug_info section.  IRIX 6.5 `nm' will then complain when
14465     examining the file.  This is done late so that any filenames
14466     used by the debug_info section are marked as 'used'.  */
14467  if (! DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
14468    {
14469      switch_to_section (debug_line_section);
14470      output_line_info ();
14471    }
14472
14473  /* Have to end the macro section.  */
14474  if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
14475    {
14476      switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section);
14477      dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End compilation unit");
14478    }
14479
14480  /* If we emitted any DW_FORM_strp form attribute, output the string
14481     table too.  */
14482  if (debug_str_hash)
14483    htab_traverse (debug_str_hash, output_indirect_string, NULL);
14484}
14485#else
14486
14487/* This should never be used, but its address is needed for comparisons.  */
14488const struct gcc_debug_hooks dwarf2_debug_hooks;
14489
14490#endif /* DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO */
14491
14492#include "gt-dwarf2out.h"
14493